d2161r5-ATAATAPI Command Set - 3 PDF
d2161r5-ATAATAPI Command Set - 3 PDF
Information technology -
ATA/ATAPI Command Set - 3 (ACS-3)
This is a draft proposed American National Standard of Accredited Standards Committee INCITS. As such this is
not a completed standard. The T13 Technical Committee may modify this document as a result of comments
received during public review and its approval as a standard. Use of the information contained here in is at your
own risk.
Permission is granted to members of INCITS, its technical committees, and their associated task groups to
reproduce this document for the purposes of INCITS standardization activities without further permission,
provided this notice is included. All other rights are reserved. Any commercial or for-profit replication or
republication is prohibited.
T13 Technical Editor: Ralph O. Weber
Western Digital Technologies, Inc.
18484 Preston Road, Suite 102, PMB 178
Dallas, TX 75252
USA
Telephone: 214-912-1373
Email: [email protected]
Reference number
ISO/IEC xxxx-xxx:200x
ANSI INCITS 522-201x
T13/2161-D Revision 5 October 28, 2013
Points of Contact
INCITS Secretariat
INCITS Secretariat Tel: 202-737-8888
1101 K Street NW Suite 610 Fax: 202-638-4922
Washington, DC 20005
Email: [email protected]
T13 Reflector
http://www.t13.org
Document Distribution
or
Global Engineering http://global.ihs.com
15 Inverness Way East Telephone: 1-303-792-2181
Englewood, CO 80112-5704 or 1-800-854-7179
Facsimile: 1-303-792-2192
American National Standard
for Information Technology
Draft
Secretariat
Information Technology Industry Council
Approved mm.dd.yy
American National Standards Institute, Inc.
ABSTRACT
This standard specifies the AT Attachment command set used to communicate between host systems and
storage devices. This provides a common command set for systems manufacturers, system integrators, software
suppliers, and suppliers of storage devices. The AT Attachment command set includes the PACKET feature set
implemented by devices commonly known as ATAPI devices. This standard maintains a high degree of
compatibility with the ATA/ATAPI Command Set - 2 (ACS-2).
Draft
Working Draft ATA/ATAPI Command Set - 3 (ACS-3) iii
T13/2161-D Revision 5 October 28, 2013
American Approval of an American National Standard requires verification by ANSI that the
requirements for due process, consensus, and other criteria for approval have been met by
National the standards developer. Consensus is established when, in the judgment of the ANSI Board
of Standards Review, substantial agreement has been reached by directly and materially
Standard affected interests. Substantial agreement means much more than a simple majority, but not
necessarily unanimity. Consensus requires that all views and objections be considered, and
that effort be made towards their resolution.
The use of American National Standards is completely voluntary; their existence does not in
any respect preclude anyone, whether he has approved the standards or not, from
manufacturing, marketing, purchasing, or using products, processes, or procedures not
conforming to the standards.
The American National Standards Institute does not develop standards and will in no
circumstances give interpretation on any American National Standard. Moreover, no person
shall have the right or authority to issue an interpretation of an American National Standard
in the name of the American National Standards Institute. Requests for interpretations
should be addressed to the secretariat or sponsor whose name appears on the title page of
this standard.
CAUTION NOTICE: This American National Standard may be revised or withdrawn at any
time. The procedures of the American National Standards Institute require that action be
taken periodically to reaffirm, revise, or withdraw this standard. Purchasers of American
National Standards may receive current information on all standards by calling or writing the
American National Standards Institute.
CAUTION: The developers of this standard have requested that holders of patents that
may be required for the implementation of the standard, disclose such patents to the
publisher. However, neither the developers nor the publisher have undertaken a patent
search in order to identify which, if any, patents may apply to this standard. As of the date
of publication of this standard, following calls for the identification of patents that may be
required for the implementation of the standard, notice of one or more claims has been
received. By publication of this standard, no position is taken with respect to the validity
of this claim or of any rights in connection therewith. The known patent holder(s) has
(have), however, filed a statement of willingness to grant a license under these rights on
reasonable and nondiscriminatory terms and conditions to applicants desiring to obtain
such a license. Details may be obtained from the publisher. No further patent search is
conducted by the developer or the publisher in respect to any standard it processes. No
representation is made or implied that licenses are not required to avoid infringement in
the use of this standard.
Published by
American National Standards Institute
23 W. 43rd Street, New York, New York 10036
Copyright © 2013 by Information Technology Industry Council (ITI).
All rights reserved.
No part of this publication may by reproduced in any form, in an electronic retrieval system or otherwise, without
prior written permission of:
Information Technology Industry Council
1101 K St, NW Suite 610
Washington, D.C. 20005 Printed in the United States of America
Contents
Page
Points of Contact....................................................................................................................................................ii
Contents.................................................................................................................................................................v
Foreword .............................................................................................................................................................. xx
1 Scope ................................................................................................................................................................. 1
7.44 SET DATE & TIME EXT – 77h, Non-Data .......................................................................................... 226
7.45 SET FEATURES – EFh, Non-Data .................................................................................................... 227
7.45.6 SET FEATURES subcommands ............................................................................................... 228
7.45.7 Enable/disable volatile write cache ........................................................................................... 230
7.45.8 Set transfer mode ...................................................................................................................... 231
7.45.9 Enable/disable the APM feature set .......................................................................................... 232
7.45.10 Enable/disable the PUIS feature set ....................................................................................... 232
7.45.11 PUIS feature set device spin-up .............................................................................................. 232
7.45.12 Enable/Disable Write-Read-Verify feature set ........................................................................ 233
7.45.13 Set Maximum Host Interface Sector Times ............................................................................. 234
7.45.14 Enable/disable read look-ahead .............................................................................................. 234
7.45.15 Enable/disable reverting to defaults ........................................................................................ 234
7.45.16 Enable/Disable the Free-fall Control feature set ..................................................................... 235
7.45.17 Enable/Disable SATA feature ................................................................................................. 235
7.45.18 Enable/Disable the Sense Data Reporting feature set ............................................................ 237
7.45.19 Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control ....................................................... 237
7.45.20 Extended Power Conditions subcommand ............................................................................. 238
7.45.21 Enable/Disable the DSN feature set ........................................................................................ 248
7.46 SET MULTIPLE MODE – C6h, Non-Data .......................................................................................... 249
7.47 SLEEP – E6h, Non-Data .................................................................................................................... 251
7.48 SMART ............................................................................................................................................... 252
7.48.2 SMART DISABLE OPERATIONS – B0h/D9h, Non-Data .......................................................... 253
7.48.3 SMART ENABLE/DISABLE ATTRIBUTE AUTOSAVE – B0h/D2h, Non-Data .......................... 254
7.48.4 SMART ENABLE OPERATIONS – B0h/D8h, Non-Data ........................................................... 256
7.48.5 SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE – B0h/D4h, Non-Data........................................... 257
7.48.6 SMART READ DATA – B0h/D0h, PIO Data-In .......................................................................... 261
7.48.7 SMART READ LOG – B0h/D5h, PIO Data-In ............................................................................ 266
7.48.8 SMART RETURN STATUS – B0h/DAh, Non-Data.................................................................... 267
7.48.9 SMART WRITE LOG – B0h/D6h, PIO Data-Out........................................................................ 268
7.49 STANDBY – E2h, Non-Data ............................................................................................................... 269
7.50 STANDBY IMMEDIATE – E0h, Non-Data .......................................................................................... 270
7.51 TRUSTED NON-DATA – 5Bh, Non-Data ........................................................................................... 271
7.52 TRUSTED RECEIVE – 5Ch, PIO Data-In .......................................................................................... 273
7.53 TRUSTED RECEIVE DMA – 5Dh, DMA ............................................................................................ 280
7.54 TRUSTED SEND – 5Eh, PIO Data-Out ............................................................................................. 281
7.55 TRUSTED SEND DMA – 5Fh, DMA .................................................................................................. 283
7.56 WRITE BUFFER – E8h, PIO Data-Out .............................................................................................. 284
7.57 WRITE BUFFER DMA – EBh, DMA ................................................................................................... 285
7.58 WRITE DMA – CAh, DMA .................................................................................................................. 286
7.59 WRITE DMA EXT – 35h, DMA ........................................................................................................... 287
7.60 WRITE DMA FUA EXT – 3Dh, DMA .................................................................................................. 288
7.61 WRITE FPDMA QUEUED – 61h, DMA Queued ................................................................................ 289
7.62 WRITE LOG EXT – 3Fh, PIO Data-Out ............................................................................................. 291
7.63 WRITE LOG DMA EXT – 57h, DMA .................................................................................................. 293
7.64 WRITE MULTIPLE – C5h, PIO Data-Out ........................................................................................... 294
7.65 WRITE MULTIPLE EXT – 39h, PIO Data-Out .................................................................................... 295
7.66 WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT – CEh, PIO Data-Out .......................................................................... 297
7.67 WRITE SECTOR(S) – 30h, PIO Data-Out ......................................................................................... 299
7.68 WRITE SECTOR(S) EXT – 34h, PIO Data-Out ................................................................................. 300
7.69 WRITE STREAM DMA EXT – 3Ah, DMA ........................................................................................... 301
7.70 WRITE STREAM EXT – 3Bh, PIO Data-Out ...................................................................................... 304
7.71 WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT – 45h, Non-Data ........................................................................... 305
Annex D (Informative) Implementation Guidelines For 1 024 and 4 096 Byte Sector Sizes.............................. 548
D.1 Scope ................................................................................................................................................... 548
D.2 Overview .............................................................................................................................................. 548
D.3 Implementation .................................................................................................................................... 550
Tables
Page
Table 1 - Approved ANSI References.................................................................................................................... 2
Table 2 - References Under Development ............................................................................................................ 3
Table 3 - Numbering conventions ........................................................................................................................ 13
Table 4 - ATA string byte swapping ..................................................................................................................... 16
Table 5 - FIRMWARE REVISION field example ......................................................................................................... 17
Table 6 - Feature set summary ............................................................................................................................ 18
Table 7 - IDENTIFY DEVICE capacity reporting.................................................................................................. 19
Table 8 - Words Transferred Per COUNT Field Unit by Command ....................................................................... 28
Table 9 - PRIO field ............................................................................................................................................... 32
Table 10 - Summary of Security States and Security Characteristics.................................................................. 47
Table 11 - Security Command Actions ................................................................................................................ 48
Table 12 - Security page settings for the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state ...................... 52
Table 13 - Security page settings for the SEC2: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Frozen state............................. 53
Table 14 - Security page settings for the SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state.............................. 54
Table 15 - Security page settings for the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state ....................... 55
Table 16 - Security page settings for the SEC6: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Frozen state.............................. 56
Table 17 - Preserved Feature Sets and Settings ................................................................................................. 59
Table 18 - STATUS field ......................................................................................................................................... 64
Table 19 - ERROR field .......................................................................................................................................... 67
Table 20 - INTERRUPT REASON field....................................................................................................................... 68
Table 21 - COUNT field use for NCQ Tag .............................................................................................................. 69
Table 22 - Example Command Structure............................................................................................................. 71
Table 23 - Example Normal Output ..................................................................................................................... 72
Table 24 - Example Error Output ......................................................................................................................... 73
Table 25 - Command Code Usage Matrix ........................................................................................................... 74
Table 26 - Accessible Max Address Configuration FEATURE field values ............................................................. 75
Table 27 - GET NATIVE MAX ADDRESS EXT command inputs ........................................................................ 75
Table 28 - SET ACCESSIBLE MAX ADDRESS EXT command inputs............................................................... 76
Table 29 - FREEZE ACCESSIBLE MAX ADDRESS EXT command inputs........................................................ 77
Table 30 - CHECK POWER MODE command inputs.......................................................................................... 78
Table 31 - CONFIGURE STREAM command inputs ........................................................................................... 79
Table 32 - DATA SET MANAGEMENT command inputs .................................................................................... 81
Table 33 - Trim related interactions ..................................................................................................................... 82
Table 34 - LBA Range Entries ............................................................................................................................. 83
Table 35 - DEVICE RESET command inputs ...................................................................................................... 84
Table 36 - DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUBCOMMAND field.................................................................................. 86
Table 37 - DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command inputs .................................................................................... 96
Table 38 - COUNT field output for DOWNLOAD MICROCODE requesting the offset transfer method ............... 97
Table 39 - DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command inputs ........................................................................... 98
Table 40 - EXECUTE DEVICE DIAGNOSTIC command inputs.......................................................................... 99
Table 41 - Diagnostic codes .............................................................................................................................. 100
Table 42 - FLUSH CACHE command inputs ..................................................................................................... 101
Table 43 - FLUSH CACHE EXT command inputs ............................................................................................. 102
Table 44 - IDENTIFY DEVICE command inputs................................................................................................ 103
Table 45 - IDENTIFY DEVICE data ................................................................................................................... 104
Table 46 - Specific configuration........................................................................................................................ 124
Table 47 - Minor version number ....................................................................................................................... 129
Table 48 - Transport minor version number....................................................................................................... 139
Table 49 - IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command inputs ................................................................................ 140
Table 50 - IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data.................................................................................................... 141
Table 51 - IDLE command inputs ...................................................................................................................... 160
Table 52 - Standby timer periods ...................................................................................................................... 160
Table 53 - IDLE IMMEDIATE command inputs.................................................................................................. 162
Table 54 - IDLE IMMEDIATE with Unload feature command inputs.................................................................. 163
Table 55 - NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT command inputs .............................................................................. 164
Table 170 - Summary of ATA commands used by the SCT Command Transport ............................................ 307
Table 171 - Fields to send an SCT Command using SMART WRITE LOG ...................................................... 309
Table 172 - Fields to send an SCT Command using GPL write logs................................................................. 310
Table 173 - Successful SCT Command response ............................................................................................. 311
Table 174 - SCT Command error response....................................................................................................... 312
Table 175 - EXTENDED STATUS CODE field ........................................................................................................... 313
Table 176 - SCT data transfer using the SMART feature set ............................................................................ 314
Table 177 - SCT data transfer using the GPL feature set.................................................................................. 315
Table 178 - Successful SMART SCT data transfer response............................................................................ 316
Table 179 - Successful GPL SCT data transfer response ................................................................................. 317
Table 180 - SMART SCT data transfer error response...................................................................................... 318
Table 181 - GPL SCT data transfer error response ........................................................................................... 319
Table 182 - SCT status request using the SMART feature set .......................................................................... 320
Table 183 - SCT status request using the GPL feature set ............................................................................... 321
Table 184 - Successful SMART SCT status response ...................................................................................... 322
Table 185 - Successful GPL SCT status response............................................................................................ 323
Table 186 - Format of SCT status response ...................................................................................................... 324
Table 187 - SMART and GPL SCT status error response ................................................................................. 325
Table 188 - SCT command basic key page structure ........................................................................................ 326
Table 189 - ACTION CODE field ............................................................................................................................ 326
Table 190 - SCT Write Same command key page............................................................................................. 330
Table 191 - SCT Write Same command status response.................................................................................. 331
Table 192 - SCT Error Recovery Control command .......................................................................................... 332
Table 193 - SCT Error Recovery Control command status response................................................................ 333
Table 194 - SCT Feature Control command key page ...................................................................................... 334
Table 195 - Feature Code list ............................................................................................................................ 335
Table 196 - Options Flags for each Feature Code............................................................................................. 336
Table 197 - SCT Feature Control command status response............................................................................ 337
Table 198 - SCT Data Table command ............................................................................................................. 338
Table 199 - TABLE ID field ................................................................................................................................... 338
Table 200 - HDA Temperature History table...................................................................................................... 339
Table 201 - SCT Data Table command status response ................................................................................... 341
Table 202 - Generic Normal Output (No LBA Return Value) for Normal Output................................................ 342
Table 203 - Download Microcode Normal Output .............................................................................................. 343
Table 204 - Check Power Mode Normal Output ................................................................................................ 344
Table 205 - Stream Normal Output .................................................................................................................... 346
Table 206 - Device Signatures for Normal Output ............................................................................................. 347
Table 207 - IDLE Unload Normal Output ........................................................................................................... 348
Table 208 - ATAPI Normal Output ..................................................................................................................... 349
Table 209 - SMART Off-Line Immediate Normal Output ................................................................................... 350
Table 210 - SMART Return Status Normal Output ............................................................................................ 351
Table 211 - Generic Extended Normal Output................................................................................................... 352
Table 212 - NCQ Command Acceptance Normal Output .................................................................................. 353
Table 213 - NCQ Normal Output ....................................................................................................................... 354
Table 214 - REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT Normal Output .............................................................................. 355
Table 215 - GET NATIVE MAX ADDRESS EXT Normal Output ....................................................................... 356
Table 216 - Sanitize Device Normal Output....................................................................................................... 357
Table 217 - Unsupported Command Error......................................................................................................... 359
Table 218 - Check Power Mode Abort Error ...................................................................................................... 360
Table 219 - Generic Abort wo/ICRC Error ......................................................................................................... 361
Table 220 - Generic Abort Error......................................................................................................................... 362
Table 221 - Trusted Abort Error ......................................................................................................................... 363
Table 222 - Configure Stream Error................................................................................................................... 364
Table 223 - Flush Cache Error........................................................................................................................... 365
Table 224 - Flush Cache Ext Error .................................................................................................................... 366
Table 225 - Read DMA Ext Error ....................................................................................................................... 367
Table 226 - Read Log Ext Error ......................................................................................................................... 368
Table A.40 - Short format ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field........................................................................ 459
Table A.41 - Extended format ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field ................................................................. 459
Table A.42 - Short format NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field............................................................................ 460
Table A.43 - Extended format NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field ..................................................................... 460
Table A.44 - Parallel ATA .................................................................................................................................. 462
Table A.45 - PATA device number detected coded values ............................................................................... 470
Table A.46 - Serial ATA ..................................................................................................................................... 474
Table A.47 - CURRENT NEGOTIATED SERIAL ATA SIGNAL SPEED field ..................................................................... 479
Table A.48 - Defined LBA Status log pages ...................................................................................................... 481
Table A.49 - Number of Valid LBA Ranges log page......................................................................................... 481
Table A.50 - LBA Status log page...................................................................................................................... 482
Table A.51 - LBA Status Descriptor ................................................................................................................... 482
Table A.52 - LPS Mis-alignment log (log page 0) .............................................................................................. 483
Table A.53 - LPS Mis-alignment log (log pages 1..x)......................................................................................... 484
Table A.54 - NCQ Command Error log .............................................................................................................. 485
Table A.55 - Read Stream Error log .................................................................................................................. 487
Table A.56 - Stream Error Log Entry ................................................................................................................. 488
Table A.57 - SATA Phy Event Counters log Format .......................................................................................... 489
Table A.58 - SATA NCQ Queue Management log (log page 00h) .................................................................... 490
Table A.59 - SATA NCQ Send and Receive log (log page 00h)........................................................................ 492
Table A.60 - Selective Self-Test log................................................................................................................... 493
Table A.61 - FEATURE FLAGS field ....................................................................................................................... 494
Table A.62 - Self-test log data structure ............................................................................................................ 495
Table A.63 - Self-test log descriptor entry.......................................................................................................... 495
Table A.64 - Summary SMART Error log........................................................................................................... 496
Table A.65 - Error log data structure.................................................................................................................. 497
Table A.66 - Command data structure ............................................................................................................... 498
Table A.67 - Error data structure ....................................................................................................................... 498
Table A.68 - State values................................................................................................................................... 499
Table A.69 - Write Stream Error log................................................................................................................... 500
Table A.70 - Current Device Internal Status Data header (page 0) ................................................................... 501
Table A.71 - Current Device Internal Status Data (pages 1..n).......................................................................... 503
Table A.72 - Saved Device Internal Status Data header (page 0) ..................................................................... 505
Table A.73 - Saved Device Internal Status Data (pages 1..n) ........................................................................... 506
Table A.74 - Device Statistics Notifications pages............................................................................................. 506
Table A.75 - Summary Page of the Device Statistics Notifications log .............................................................. 507
Table A.76 - DSN Match Entry........................................................................................................................... 507
Table A.77 - Definition pages of the Device Statistics Notifications log ............................................................. 508
Table A.78 - DSN CONDITION FLAGS field ............................................................................................................. 509
Table B.1 - Command codes (sorted by command code).................................................................................. 510
Table B.2 - Command codes (sorted by command name) ................................................................................ 515
Table B.3 - Historical Command Assignments................................................................................................... 518
Table B.4 - Historical SET FEATURE Code Assignments................................................................................. 527
Table C.1 - SCT command using SMART WRITE LOG command ................................................................... 545
Table C.2 - SCT command using WRITE LOG EXT command......................................................................... 546
Figures
Page
Figure 1 - ATA document relationships................................................................................................................ 1
Figure 2 - State diagram convention .................................................................................................................. 13
Figure 3 - Byte, word, DWord, QWord, and DQWord relationships ................................................................... 15
Figure 4 - LLS and LPS Example ...................................................................................................................... 30
Figure 5 - Alignment 0........................................................................................................................................ 30
Figure 6 - Alignment 1........................................................................................................................................ 30
Figure 7 - Alignment 3........................................................................................................................................ 31
Figure 8 - Power management state diagram.................................................................................................... 35
Figure 9 - Sanitize Device state machine .......................................................................................................... 42
Figure 10 - Security state diagram ..................................................................................................................... 51
Figure 11 - DOWNLOAD MICROCODE State Machine .................................................................................... 88
Figure 12 - Selective self-test span example ................................................................................................... 259
Figure A.1 - Example of a Device Internal Status log with data in all three data areas ................................... 503
Figure A.2 - Example of a Device Internal Status log with no data .................................................................. 504
Figure A.3 - Example of a Device Internal Status log with mixed data areas .................................................. 504
Figure C.1 - Example flowchart for SCT commands........................................................................................ 538
Figure C.2 - Example sequence for foreground write same with a repeating pattern ...................................... 539
Figure C.3 - Example sequence for foreground write same with a repeating pattern ...................................... 539
Figure C.4 - Example sequence for writing data using an SCT command with no background activity .......... 540
Figure C.5 - Example sequence for reading data using an SCT command with no background activity......... 540
Figure C.6 - Example sequence for a Non-Data SCT command with no background activity......................... 541
Figure C.7 - Example sequence for writing data using an SCT command with background activity ............... 542
Figure C.8 - Example sequence for writing data using multiple write data transfers ....................................... 543
Figure C.9 - Example sequence for a Non-Data SCT command with background activity.............................. 544
Figure D.1 - System Dependency Chain ......................................................................................................... 548
Figure D.2 - Mapping Proposals ...................................................................................................................... 549
Figure D.3 - Logical Sector to Physical Mapping ............................................................................................. 549
Figure D.4 - Uncorrectable Error Handling....................................................................................................... 551
Figure D.5 - Typical HDD Layout Using A Master Boot Record....................................................................... 552
Foreword
(This foreword is not part of this standard.)
This standard is designed to maintain a high degree of compatibility with the ACS-2 standard.
Requests for interpretation, suggestions for improvement and addenda, or defect reports are welcome. They
should be sent to the INCITS Secretariat, ITI, 1101 K Street NW, Suite 610, Washington, DC 20005.
This standard was processed and approved for submittal to ANSI by InterNational Committee for Information
Technology Standards (INCITS). Committee approval of this standard does not necessarily imply that all
committee members voted for approval. At the time it approved this standard, INCITS had the following
members:
Name Company
TBD
Technical Committee T13 on ATA Interfaces, that reviewed this standard, had the following members and
additional participants:
Dan Colegrove (HGST), Chair
Jim Hatfield (Seagate), Vice-Chair
William Martin (Samsung), Secretary
Company Name
AMI Alex Podgorsky
Consultant Hale Landis
Dell Frank Widjaja
Kevin Marks
Mike Wilson
Emulex Hossein Hashemi
Fujitsu Mike Fitzpatrick
Fujitsu America Kun Katsumata
Mark Malcolm
Hewlett Packard Jeff Wolford
Wayne Bellamy
HGST Frank Chu
IBM Henry Pesulima
Steve Livaccari
Intel James Boyd
Steven Wells
Kionix Anil Godavarthi
Lexar Media John Geldman
Company Name
Lingua Data Joe Breher
LSI Brad Besmer
George Penokie
Marvell John Schadegg
Kevin TonThat
Paul Wassenberg
Micron Alan Haffner
Jafar Naji
Jim Cooke
Jim Warino
Marc Noblitt
Michael George
Neal Galbo
Victor Tsai
Microsoft Calvin Chen
Frank Shu
Lee Prewitt
NetApp Fred Knight
Tim Emami
nVidia Mark Overby
Prajakta Gvdadhe
Andrew Currid
Rakesh Iyer
PMC-Sierra Neil Wanamaker
Samsung Daniel Kim
Joseph Chen
Samsung Semiconductor KeunSoo Jo
Tim Markey
William Martin
Sandforce Ross Stenfort
SanDisk Avraham Shimor
Bill Grace
David Landsman
Yoni Shternhell
Seagate Mike Danielson
Tom Lenny
STEC Aaron Wilson
Company Name
Toshiba Daniel Colegrove
Mike Fitzpatick
Patrick Hery
Sumit Puri
Western Digital Bob Griswold
Curtis Stevens
Danny Ybarra
Mark Evans
Nathan Obr
Ralph Weber
Introduction
This standard encompasses the following:
Clause 1 describes the scope.
Clause 2 provides normative references for the entire standard.
Clause 3 provides definitions, abbreviations, and conventions used within the entire standard.
Clause 4 describes the general operating requirements of the command layer.
Clause 5 describes the ATA protocols used by the commands in this standard.
Clause 6 describes Normal and Error Output fields.
Clause 7 describes commands.
Clause 8 describes the SCT Command Transport.
Clause 9 describes command normal and error outputs.
Annex A describes logs.
Annex B provides command summaries.
Annex C provides a tutorial on how to use SCT.
Annex D provides implementation guidelines for 1 024/4 096 byte sectors.
Windows is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other countries.
CFast and CompactFlash are trademarks of the Compact Flash Association.
Packet delivered
command sets
device specifications
Architecture Model
AT Attachment – 8
Other related
(ATA8-AAM)
ATA/ATAPI Command Set – 3 (ACS‐3)
AT Attachment – 8 AT Attachment – 8
Parallel Transport Serial Transport
(ATA8-APT) (ATA8-AST)
This standard maintains compatibility with the ACS-2 standard, INCITS 482-2012, while providing additional
functions.
2 Normative references
2.1 General
The standards listed in 2.2, 2.3, and 2.4 contain provisions that, through reference in the text, constitute
provisions of this standard. At the time of publication, the editions indicated were valid. All standards are subject
to revision, and parties to agreements based on this standard are encouraged to investigate the possibility of
applying the most recent editions of the standards listed in 2.2, 2.3, and 2.4.
Copies of these standards may be obtained from ANSI: Approved ANSI standards, approved and draft
international and regional standards (ISO, IEC, CEN/CENELEC, ITUT), and approved and draft foreign
standards (including BSI, JIS, and DIN). For further information, contact ANSI Customer Service Department at
212-642-4900 (phone), 212-302-1286 (fax), or via the World Wide Web at http://www.ansi.org.
Additional availability contact information is provided as needed.
Name Reference
ATA/ATAPI Command Set - 2 (ACS-2) ANSI INCITS 482-2012
AT Attachment-8 - ATA/ATAPI Architecture Model (ATA8-AAM) ANSI INCITS 451-2008
AT Attachment-8 - ATA Serial Transport (ATA8-AST) ANSI INCITS 493-2012
SMART Command Transport (SCT) ANSI INCITS TR38-2005
Acoustics - Measurement of airborne noise emitted by information ISO/IEC 7779:1999(E)
technology and telecommunications equipment
Information Systems - Coded Character Sets - 7-Bit American National ANSI INCITS 4-1986 (R2002)
Standard Code for Information Interchange (7-Bit ASCII)
indicated in table 2.
NOTE 1 — An SDA login is required to access the Trusted Flash specification. If you need an SDA login, please
go to the “Contact Us” page for information on joining the SDA, and/or getting access to the Members
Site/Workspace pages. SD-ATA Interface Specification (Part H2)
1) JEDEC® is a registered trademark of the JEDEC Solid State Technology Association. This informa-
tion is given for the convenience of users of this document and does not constitute an endorsement
by ISO.
3.1.77 Stream
set of operating parameters specified by a host using the CONFIGURE STREAM command (see 7.4) to be used
for subsequent read stream commands and write stream commands
3.1.78 transport
mechanism used to communicate with a device. See ATA8-APT and ATA8-AST
3.1.79 unaligned write
write command that does not start at the first logical sector of a physical sector or does not end at the last logical
sector of a physical sector
3.1.79.1 unrecoverable error
error that causes the device to set either the ERROR bit or the DEVICE FAULT bit to one in the STATUS field at
command completion
3.1.80 user data
data that is transferred between the application client and the device using read commands and write commands
3.1.81 user data area
area of the media that is addressable from LBA 0 to the native max address if the Accessible Max Address
Configuration feature set is supported or LBA 0 to the maximum value defined in table 7 if the Accessible Max
Address Configuration feature set is not supported
3.1.82 vendor specific
bits, bytes, fields, and code values that are reserved for vendor specific purposes. These bits, bytes, fields, and
code values are not described in this standard, and implementations may vary among vendors. This term is also
applied to levels of functionality whose definition is left to the vendor
3.1.83 volatile cache
cache that does not retain data through power cycles
3.1.84 word (see 3.3.9)
sequence of two contiguous bytes considered as a unit
3.1.85 write command
command that causes the device to transfer user data from the host to the device (i.e., the SCT Write Same
command, WRITE DMA command, WRITE DMA EXT command, WRITE DMA FUA EXT command, WRITE
FPDMA QUEUED command, WRITE MULTIPLE command, WRITE MULTIPLE EXT command, WRITE
MULTIPLE FUA EXT command, WRITE SECTOR(S) command, WRITE SECTOR(S) EXT command, WRITE
STREAM DMA EXT command, and WRITE STREAM EXT command)
3.1.86 write stream command
command that causes the device to transfer user data from the host to the device (i.e., the WRITE STREAM
DMA EXT command and WRITE STREAM EXT command)
3.1.87 WWN (World Wide Name)
64 bit worldwide unique name based upon a company’s IEEE OUI, reported in IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
108..111 (see 7.12.7.58) and IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data words 108..111 (see 7.13.6.44)
Abbreviation Meaning
LSB Least Significant Bit
ms milliseconds
MSB Most Significant Bit
NCQ Native Command Queueing
ns nanoseconds
OUI Organizationally Unique Identifier
PATA Parallel ATA
PIO Programmed Input/Output
PUIS Power-Up In Standby
RMW Read-Modify-Write
SATA Serial ATA
SATA-IO Serial ATA International Organization (see www.sata-io.org)
SCT SMART Command Transport (see clause 8)
SFQ SEND FPDMA QUEUED
SMART Self-Monitoring Analysis and Reporting Technology
SPC-4 SCSI Primary Commands - 4 (see 2.3)
SSP Software Settings Preservation
T10 INCTIS Technical Committee T10
TCG Trusted Computing Group (see www.trustedcomputinggroup.org)
µs microseconds
VS Vendor Specific
WWN World Wide Name
3.3 Conventions
3.3.1 Overview
Lowercase is used for words having the normal English language meaning. Certain words and terms used in this
standard have a specific meaning beyond the normal English language meaning. These words and terms are
defined either in clause 3 or in the text where they first appear.
The names of abbreviations, commands, fields, and acronyms used as signal names are in all uppercase (e.g.,
IDENTIFY DEVICE). Fields containing only one bit are usually referred to as the “name” bit instead of the “name”
field. (See 3.3.6 for the naming convention used for naming bits.)
Names of device fields begin with a capital letter (e.g., Count).
Names of fields are in small uppercase (e.g., DRAT SUPPORTED). Normal case is used when the contents of a field
are being discussed. Fields containing only one bit are usually referred to as the NAME bit instead of the NAME
field.
The expression “word n” or “bit n” shall be interpreted as indicating the content of word n or the content of bit n.
3.3.2 Precedence
If there is a conflict between text, figures, and tables, the precedence shall be tables, figures, then text.
3.3.3 Lists
3.3.3.1 Lists overview
Lists are introduced by a complete grammatical proposition followed by a colon and completed by the items in
the list.
Each item in a list is preceded by an identification with the style of the identification being determined by whether
the list is intended to be an ordered list or an unordered list.
If the item in a list is not a complete sentence, the first word in the item is not capitalized. If the item in a list is a
complete sentence, the first word in the item is capitalized.
Each item in a list ends with a semicolon, except the last item, which ends in a period. The next to the last entry
in the list ends with a semicolon followed by an “and” or an “or” (i.e., “…; and”, or “…; or”). The “and” is used if all
the items in the list are required. The “or” is used if only one or more items in the list are required.
3.3.3.2 Unordered lists
An unordered list is one in which the order of the listed items is unimportant (i.e., it does not matter where in the
list an item occurs as all items have equal importance). Each list item shall start with a lower case letter followed
by a close parenthesis. If it is necessary to subdivide a list item further with an additional unordered list (i.e., have
a nested unordered list), then the nested unordered list shall be indented and each item in the nested unordered
list shall start with an upper case letter followed by a close parenthesis.
The following is an example of an unordered list with a nested unordered list:
The following are the items for the assembly:
a) a box containing:
A) a bolt;
B) a nut; and
C) a washer;
b) a screwdriver; and
c) a wrench.
An ordered list is one in which the order of the listed items is important (i.e., item n is required before item n+1).
Each listed item starts with a Western-Arabic numeral followed by a close parenthesis. If it is necessary to
subdivide a list item further with an additional unordered list (i.e., have a nested unordered list), then the nested
unordered list shall be indented and each item in the nested unordered list shall start with an upper case letter
followed by a close parenthesis.
The following is an example of an ordered list with a nested unordered list:
The following are the instructions for the assembly:
1) remove the contents from the box;
2) assemble the item;
A) use a screwdriver to tighten the screws; and
B) use a wrench to tighten the bolts;
and
3) take a break.
3.3.4 Keywords
Several keywords are used to differentiate between different levels of requirements and options.
3.3.4.1 expected
A keyword used to describe the behavior of the hardware or software in the design models assumed by this
standard. Other hardware and software design models may also be implemented.
3.3.4.2 mandatory
A keyword indicating items to be implemented as defined by this standard.
3.3.4.3 may
A keyword that indicates flexibility of choice with no implied preference.
3.3.4.4 N/A
A keyword that indicates a field is not applicable and has no defined value and should not be checked by the host
or device.
3.3.4.5 obsolete
A keyword indicating that the designated bits, bytes, words, fields, and code values that may have been defined
in previous standards are not defined in this standard and shall not be reclaimed for other uses in future
standards. However, some degree of functionality may be required for items designated as “obsolete” to provide
for backward compatibility.
Obsolete commands should not be used by the host. Commands defined as obsolete may return command
aborted by devices conforming to this standard. However, if a device does not return command aborted for an
obsolete command, then the device shall return command completion for the command.
3.3.4.6 optional
A keyword that describes features that are not required by this standard. However, if any optional feature defined
by the standard is implemented, the feature shall be implemented in the way defined by the standard.
3.3.4.7 prohibited
A keyword indicating that an item shall not be implemented by an implementation.
3.3.4.8 reserved
A keyword indicating reserved bits, bytes, words, fields, and code values that are set aside for future
standardization. Their use and interpretation may be specified by future extensions to this or other standards.
A reserved bit, byte, word, or field shall be cleared to zero, or in accordance with a future extension to this
standard. The recipient shall not check reserved bits, bytes, words, or fields. Receipt of reserved code values
in defined fields shall be considered a command parameter error and reported by returning command aborted.
3.3.4.9 retired
A keyword indicating that the designated bits, bytes, words, fields, and code values that had been defined in
previous standards are not defined in this standard and may be reclaimed for other uses in future standards. If
retired bits, bytes, words, fields, or code values are used before they are reclaimed, they shall have the meaning
or functionality as described in previous standards.
3.3.4.10 shall
A keyword indicating a mandatory requirement. Designers are required to implement all such mandatory
requirements to ensure interoperability with other products that conform to this standard.
3.3.4.11 should
A keyword indicating flexibility of choice with a strongly preferred alternative. Equivalent to the phrase “it is
recommended”.
3.3.5 Numbering
A binary number is represented in this standard by any sequence of digits consisting of only the Western-Arabic
numerals 0 and 1 immediately followed by a lower-case b (e.g., 0101b). Underscores or spaces may be included
between characters in binary number representations to increase readability or delineate field boundaries (e.g., 0
0101 1010b or 0_0101_1010b).
A hexadecimal number is represented in this standard by any sequence of digits consisting of only the
Western-Arabic numerals 0 through 9 and/or the upper-case English letters A through F immediately followed by
a lower-case h (e.g., FA23h). Underscores or spaces may be included between characters in hexadecimal
number representations to increase readability or delineate field boundaries (e.g., B FD8C FA23h or
B_FD8C_FA23h).
A decimal number is represented in this standard by any sequence of digits consisting of only the Arabic
numerals 0 through 9 not immediately followed by a lower-case b or lower-case h (e.g., 25). This standard uses
the following conventions for representing decimal numbers:
a) the decimal separator (i.e., separating the integer and fractional portions of the number) is a period;
b) the thousands separator (i.e., separating groups of three digits in a portion of the number) is a space;
and
c) the thousands separator is used in both the integer portion and the fraction portion of a number.
Table 3 shows some examples of decimal numbers using various numbering conventions.
A decimal number represented in this standard with an overline over one or more digits following the decimal
point is a number where the overlined digits are infinitely repeating (e.g., 666.6 means 666.666 666… or 666 2/3,
and 12.142 857 means 12.142 857 142 857… or 12 1/7).
3.3.6 Bit conventions
Name (n:m), where n is greater than m, denotes a set of bits (e.g., Feature (7:0)). n:m where n is greater than m
denotes a bit range in a table.
3.3.7 Number range convention
p..q, where p is less than q, represents a range of numbers (e.g., words 100..103 represents words 100, 101,
102, and 103).
3.3.8 State diagram conventions
All state diagrams use the notation shown in Figure 2.
Transition Condition
or COMMAND (value)
Transition Label
Transition Action
Transition Condition
or COMMAND (value)
Transition Label
Transition Action
Transition Condition
Transition Label
Transition Action
State re-entry
Each state is identified by a state designator and a state name. The state designator is unique among all states
in all state diagrams in this standard. The state designator consists of a set of letters that are capitalized in the
title of the figure containing the state diagram followed by a unique number. The state name is a brief description
of the primary action taken during the state, and the same state name may appear in other state diagrams. If the
same primary function occurs in other states in the same state diagram, then the primary functions are
designated with a unique letter at the end of the name. Additional actions may be taken while in a state and these
actions are described in the state description text.
Each transition is identified by a transition label, a transition condition, and optionally by a transition action. The
transition label consists of the state designator of the state from which the transition is being made followed by
the state designator of the state to which the transition is being made. The transition to enter or exit a state
diagram may come from or go to a number of state diagrams, depending on the command being processed. In
this case, the state designator is labeled State_name. The transition condition is a brief description of the event
or condition that causes the transition to occur. A transition action may be included, indicated in italics, that is
taken when the transition occurs. This action is described in the transition description text.
Upon entry to a state, all actions to be processed in that state are processed. If a state is re-entered from itself, all
actions to be processed in the state are processed again.
Each state machine is instantiated based on the Entry Conditions. An Entry Condition is a transition based on an
action occurring outside of the state machine.
All transitions shall be instantaneous.
The notation COMMAND (value), as a transition condition, refers to the device receiving the command with a
specific value or values. For example:
a) CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT (failure exit allowed) means the device processes a CRYPTO SCRAMBLE
EXT command with the FAILURE MODE bit set to one; or
b) CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT (hard failure required) means the device processes CRYPTO SCRAMBLE
EXT command with the FAILURE MODE bit cleared to zero.
If the (value) notation is not present on a transition, then the transition occurs for any parameter combination of
the command.
Word at offset n
Word n
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
MSB LSB
DWord n/2
31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
MSB LSB
QWord n/4
63 ... 56 55 ... 48 47 ... 40 39 ... 32 31 ... 24 23 ... 16 15 ... 8 7 ... 0
MSB LSB
Byte 2n+7 Byte 2n+6 Byte 2n+5 Byte 2n+4 Byte 2n+3 Byte 2n+2 Byte 2n+1 Byte 2n
DQWord n/8
127 ... 112 111 ... 96 95 ... 80 79 ... 64 63 ... 48 47 ... 32 31 ... 16 15 ... 0
MSB LSB
Word n+7 Word n+6 Word n+5 Word n+4 Word n+3 Word n+2 Word n+1 Word n
Unless stated or defined otherwise, in a field containing a multi-byte value (e.g., a word, DWord, or QWord), the
byte containing the LSB is stored at the lowest offset and the byte containing the MSB is stored at the highest
offset. For example:
a) if the two-byte field (i.e., word) in SCT command (see table 188) word 0 contains 0007h, then:
A) byte 0 contains 07h; and
B) byte 1 contains 00h;
b) if the four-byte field (i.e., DWord) at IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 60..61 (see table 45) contains
8001_0203h (i.e., 2 147 549 699), then:
A) byte 120 contains 03h;
B) byte 121 contains 02h;
C) byte 122 contains 01h; and
D) byte 123 contains 80h;
and
c) if an eight-byte field (i.e., QWord) in the WRITE SAME command words 2..5 (see table 190) contains
0000_0504_0302_0100h), then:
A) byte 4 contains 00h;
B) byte 5 contains 01h;
C) byte 6 contains 02h;
D) byte 7 contains 03h;
E) byte 8 contains 04h;
F) byte 9 contains 05h;
G) byte 10 contains 00h; and
H) byte 11 contains 00h.
Exceptions to this convention include:
a) each field containing an ATA string (e.g., the IDENTIFY DEVICE data and IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE
data Serial number, Firmware revision, and Model number fields) is considered to be an array of bytes,
not a multi-byte value, and is handled as described in 3.3.10;
b) the IDENTIFY DEVICE data and IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data World Wide Name field consists of
four word fields rather than one QWord field and is handled as described in 7.12.7.58;
c) the command packet in the PACKET command (see 7.18) is formatted as defined by the applicable
command standard); and
d) parameter data in the TRUSTED RECEIVE command (see 7.52), TRUSTED RECEIVE DMA command
(see 7.53), TRUSTED SEND command (see 7.54), and TRUSTED SEND DMA command (see 7.55) is
formatted as defined in those sections or in the standard defining the security protocol.
3.3.10 ATA string convention
ATA strings (e.g., the MODEL NUMBEr field (see A.11.7.4)) are sequences of bytes containing ASCII graphic
characters in the range of 20h-7Eh. ATA strings shall not contain values in the range of 00h-1Fh or 7Fh-FFh.
Each pair of bytes in an ATA string is swapped as shown in table 4.
Using the ATA string that contains firmware revision information as an example, table 5 shows the contents
of the FIRMWARE REVISION field (see A.11.7.3) in the Strings page (see A.11.7) in IDENTIFY DEVICE data log
(see A.11). In this example, the firmware revision string is “abcdefg ”, including one padding space character
at the end of the string. Table 5 also shows the copy of the FIRMWARE REVISION field that uses the word format
of the IDENTIFY DEVICE input from device to host data structure (see 7.12.7).
4.1 Overview
4.1.1 Feature set summary
Table 6 lists the feature sets in alphabetical order and shows whether a feature set is mandatory, optional, or
prohibited for ATA devices and ATAPI devices.
ATA ATAPI
Feature set devices devices
48-Bit Address feature set (see 4.4) O P
Accessible Max Address Configuration (see 4.5) O P
Advanced Power Management (APM) feature set (see 4.6) O O
CompactFlash Association (CFA) feature set (see 4.7) O P
Device Statistics Notifications (DSN) feature set (see 4.8) O P
Extended Power Conditions (EPC) feature set (see 4.9) O P
Free-fall Control feature set (see 4.10) O P
General feature set (see 4.2) M P
General Purpose Logging (GPL) feature set (see 4.11) M O
Long Logical Sector (LLS) feature set (see 4.12) O P
Long Physical Sector (LPS) feature set (see 4.13) O P
Native Command Queuing (NCQ) feature set (see 4.14) O P
PACKET feature set (see 4.3) P M
Power Management feature set (see 4.15) M O
Power-Up In Standby (PUIS) feature set (see 4.16) O O
Sanitize Device feature set (see 4.17) O P
SATA Hardware feature control (see 4.22) O P
Security feature set (see 4.18) O Obsolete
Self-Monitoring, Analysis, and Reporting Technology (SMART) feature set (see 4.19) O P
Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 4.20) O P
Software Settings Preservation (SSP) feature set (see 4.21) O P
Streaming feature set (see 4.23) O P
Trusted Computing feature set (see 4.24) O P
Write-Read-Verify feature set (see 4.25) O P
Key: M – Mandatory, O – Optional, P – Prohibited
Current Capacity
Device Settings Settings Reported Capacities
IDENTIFY accessible accessible
DEVICE IDENTIFY max max
data DEVICE address address IDENTIFY IDENTIFY
word 83 bit data IDENTIFY DEVICE DEVICE ACCESSIBLE
10 (48-bit word 69 0FFF_ FFFF_ DEVICE data data words data words CAPACITY
a
support) bit 3 FFFFh FFFFh words 60..61 100..103 230..233 field
accessible accessible
0 N/A N/A N/A max address reserved reserved max address
+1 +1
accessible accessible accessible
1 0 yes yes max address max address reserved max address
+1 +1 +1
accessible accessible
0000_0000_
1 0 no no max address reserved max address
0FFF_FFFFh
+1 +1
accessible accessible
0000_0000_
1 0 no yes max address reserved max address
0FFF_FFFFh
+1 +1
accessible accessible accessible accessible
1 1 yes yes max address max address max address max address
+1 +1 +1 +1
less than
or equal to accessible accessible
0000_0000_
1 1 no no accessible max address max address
0FFF_FFFFh
max address + 1 +1
+1b
less than
or equal to accessible accessible
0000_0000_
1 1 no yes accessible max address max address
0FFF_FFFFh
max address + 1 +1
+1b
a The ACCESSIBLE CAPACITY field is defined in A.11.4.2.
b IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 100..103 may be limited to 0000_0000_FFFF_FFFFh
A device shall not change the content in the ACCESSIBLE CAPACITY field (see A.11.4.2), IDENTIFY DEVICE data
words 60..61, or IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 230..233, during the processing of all resets (e.g., a power-on
reset).
For ATAPI devices, the IDENTIFY DEVICE command (see 7.12) and the READ SECTOR(S) command
(see 7.28) are command aborted and return the ATAPI device signature (see table 206).
The following commands are optional for devices that implement the PACKET feature set:
a) FLUSH CACHE (see 7.10);
b) READ LOG DMA EXT (see 7.25);
c) READ LOG EXT (see 7.24);
d) WRITE LOG DMA EXT (see 7.63); and
e) WRITE LOG EXT (see 7.62).
The following commands are prohibited for devices that implement the PACKET feature set:
a) DATA SET MANAGEMENT (see 7.5);
b) FLUSH CACHE (see 7.10);
c) READ BUFFER (see 7.19);
d) READ BUFFER DMA (see 7.20);
e) READ DMA (see 7.21);
f) READ MULTIPLE (see 7.26);
g) READ VERIFY SECTOR(S) (see 7.32);
h) SET MULTIPLE MODE (see 7.46);
i) WRITE BUFFER (see 7.56);
j) WRITE BUFFER DMA (see 7.57);
k) WRITE DMA (see 7.58);
l) WRITE MULTIPLE (see 7.64);
m) WRITE SECTOR(S) (see 7.67); and
n) WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT (see 7.71); and
o) commands for feature sets that are prohibited for ATAPI devices in table 6.
4.3.2 Identification of PACKET feature set devices
The IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command (see 7.13) is used by the host to get identifying parameter
information for a device that implement the PACKET feature set. Devices the implement the PACKET feature
set process IDENTIFY DEVICE commands (see 7.12) as described in 7.12.5.
4.3.3 Signature for ATAPI devices
ATAPI devices return a signature in the Normal Outputs that differentiate them from other device types
(see table 206).
4.3.4 The PACKET command
The PACKET command (see 7.18) allows a host to send a command to the device via a SCSI CDB packet.
The protocol for handling the transmission of the PACKET command and associated data is transport specific.
b) a DSN Condition Definition (see table A.77) is configured for that device statistic;
c) the DSN Condition Definition for that device statistic is met; and
d) the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 4.20) is enabled.
If the device is reporting changes based on DSN Condition Definitions that have been met in response to a
REQUEST SENSE EXT command, then the normal outputs shall contain:
a) the SENSE KEY field set to NO SENSE (i.e., 0h); and
b) the additional sense code set to WARNING – DEVICE STATISTICS NOTIFICATION ACTIVE (i.e.,
0Bh/09h).
The contents of the Summary page (i.e., 00h) of the Device Statistics Notifications log (see A.25) are always
valid while the DSN ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.2) is set to one. The validity of the Device Statistics Notifications log
is not affected by the value of the SENSE DATA ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.6) or the value of the NCQ AUTOSENSE
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.21). The host may read the Summary page to check for notification status
changes. The Summary page shall not be changed by:
a) a READ LOG EXT command (see 7.24) or READ LOG DMA EXT (see 7.25) command addressing the:
A) Summary page of the Device Statistics Notifications log (see A.25); or
B) NCQ Command Error log (see A.14);
or
b) a REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command (see 7.35).
4.8.3 DSN notifications setup
The host requests specific device statistics notifications by writing to the Definition pages (see table A.77) of the
Device Statistics Notifications log (see A.25). In each Definition page, the host may write one or more pairs of
QWords with each pair forming one device statistic notification entry as follows:
1) a Device Statistics Location QWord that specifies a device statistic in the Device Statistics log (see A.5)
that is to be tested for the device statistics notification; and
2) a Device Statistics Condition Definition QWord that specifies the test to be made.
Each device statistic notification entry is independent of other device statistic notification entries.
If any Definition page being written Device Statistics Notifications log contains a device statistic notification entry
that:
a) refers to a device statistic that is not supported (see table A.8);
b) refers to a device statistic that does not support device statistic notification (see table A.8);
c) contains a threshold value that is out of range for the referenced device statistic (see table A.78); or
d) contains a Comparison Type that is reserved (see table A.78),
then:
1) none of the Definition pages being written to the Device Statistics Notifications log shall be saved by the
device; and
2) the command shall return command aborted (see table 230).
The following command-related device properties are mandatory if this feature set is supported:
a) the SET FEATURES command Extended Power Conditions subcommand (see 7.45.20);
b) the Power Conditions log (see A.8);
c) the additional status values returned by the CHECK POWER MODE command (see 7.3);
d) the EPC SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.27); and
e) the EPC ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.3).
4.9.2 Power conditions
Idle_a, Idle_b, and Idle_c are power conditions within the PM1: Idle state (see 4.15.4). Standby_y and Standby_z
are power conditions within the PM2: Standby state (see 4.15.4). The power conditions shall be ordered from
highest power consumption to lowest power consumption as follows:
Idle_a power Idle_b power Idle_c power Standby_y power Standby_z power
In this ordering, a power condition:
a) on the right side of the relationship is a lower power condition than any power condition to its left (e.g.,
Standby_y is a lower power condition than Idle_c); and
b) on the left side of the relationship is a higher power condition than any power condition to its right (e.g.,
Standby_y is a higher power condition than Standby_z).
The Standby timer (see 4.15.3) is controlled using:
c) the SET FEATURES command Extended Power Conditions subcommand (see 7.45.20);
d) the IDLE command (see 7.14); and
e) the STANDBY command (see 7.49).
The EPC feature set also defines a default for the Standby timer that is controlled in the same manner as the
other power condition timers (e.g., enabled, disabled, and queried).
Each of these power conditions has a set of current, saved and default settings (see A.8). Default settings are
not changeable. Default and saved settings shall persist across all resets (e.g., power-on resets). The current
settings shall not persist across power cycles.
4.9.3 Power condition timers
The device shall have manufacturer specified power-on default settings for the power condition timers. Power
condition timers are changeable with the SET FEATURES command Extended Power Conditions subcommand
(see 7.45.20). Configured settings for the timers are readable in the Power Conditions log (see A.8).
A power condition timer cleared to zero indicates that the associated power condition is disabled.
If the power condition is enabled, the value of each timer specifies the time after command completion that the
device shall wait before transitioning to that power condition. All enabled power condition timers run concurrently.
If a command is accepted that requires a transition to PM0: Active state (see 4.15.4), all enabled power condition
timers shall be stopped. If a command is accepted that does not require a transition to PM0: Active state (e.g., a
CHECK POWER MODE command), then the timers shall continue to run.
On command completion, all power condition timers that were stopped shall be initialized with their current timer
values (see A.8) and started.
As a result of processing any command, the device may change to a different power condition.
If an enabled timer expires and that timer is associated with a lower power condition (see 4.9.2) than the device's
current power condition, then the device shall transition to the power condition associated with the expired timer.
The device shall not transition to a higher power condition as the result of a timer expiring. If the timers
associated with multiple enabled power conditions expire at the same time, the device shall transition to the
lowest of the lower power conditions associated with expired timers.
If volatile write cache is enabled (i.e., if the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.4) is set to one), then
prior to entering into any power condition that prevents access to the media (e.g., before a hard drive stops its
spindle motor during a transition to the Standby_z power condition), the device shall write all cached data to the
media for the device (e.g., as a device does in response to a flush command).
4.9.4 Interaction with resets, commands, and other features if the EPC feature set is enabled
If the device processes a power-on reset or the Enable the EPC feature set subcommand (see 7.45.20.6), the
device shall:
1) stop all power condition timers (see 4.9.3);
2) copy the SAVED TIMER ENABLED bit to the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit in the power conditions descriptors
(see A.8.4) for all supported power conditions;
3) copy the contents of the SAVED TIMER SETTING field to the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field in the power
conditions descriptors for all supported power conditions; and
4) initialize and restart all enabled power condition timers with the values in the CURRENT TIMER SETTING
fields in the associated power conditions descriptors.
If the device processes a hardware reset, a software reset, or a DEVICE RESET command, then the device
shall:
1) stop all power condition timers;
2) remain in the current power condition; and
3) initialize and restart all enabled power condition timers with the values in the CURRENT TIMER SETTING
fields in the associated power conditions descriptors.
If the device processes an IDLE command (see 7.14) without error, then:
1) in the Standby_z power condition descriptor of the Standby power conditions page (see A.8.3) in the
Power Conditions log, if the specified Standby timer period (see table 51) in the IDLE command is set to:
A) a non-zero value, then the device shall set the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit to one, convert the
specified timer period to units of 100 milliseconds, and set the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field to the
converted value; or
B) zero, then the device shall clear the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit to zero and clear the CURRENT TIMER
SETTING field to zero;
2) the device shall transition to the PM1: Idle state (see 4.15.4); and
3) the device shall enter the Idle_a power condition.
If the device processes an IDLE IMMEDIATE command (see 7.15) without error, then:
1) if the Unload feature (see 7.15.2.2) was selected, then:
A) the device shall perform the operations described in 7.15.2.2; and
B) if volatile write cache is enabled (i.e., if the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.4) is set
to one), then the device shall retain data in the write cache and resume writing the cached data onto
the media after receiving a software reset, a hardware reset, or any new command except IDLE
IMMEDIATE command with unload feature;
2) the device shall transition to the PM1:Idle state; and
3) the device shall enter the Idle_a power condition.
If the device processes a STANDBY command (see 7.49) without error, then:
1) in the Standby_z power condition descriptor of the Standby power conditions page (see A.8.3) in the
Power Conditions log, if the specified Standby timer period (see table 137) in the STANDBY command
is set to:
A) a non-zero value, then the device shall set the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit to one, convert the
specified timer period to units of 100 milliseconds, and set the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field to the
converted value; or
B) zero, then the device shall clear the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit to zero and clear the CURRENT TIMER
SETTING field to zero;
2) the device shall transition to the PM2: Standby state (see 4.15.4); and
3) the device shall enter the Standby_z power condition.
If the device processes a STANDBY IMMEDIATE command (see 7.50) without error, then the device shall:
1) write all cached data to the media, if volatile write cache is enabled;
2) transition to the PM2:Standby state; and
3) enter the Standby_z power condition.
The EPC feature set and the APM feature set (see 4.6) are mutually exclusive. If the EPC feature set is disabled
(i.e., the EPC ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.3) is cleared to zero), the device:
a) shall process the Enable the EPC feature set subcommand (see 7.45.20.6);
b) may process the Set EPC Power Source subcommand (see 7.45.20.8); and
c) shall return command aborted for all other EPC feature set subcommands.
If the device processes a SET FEATURES Enable APM subcommand without error and the EPC ENABLED bit
(see A.11.6.2.3) is set to one, then the device shall disable the EPC feature set.
During background activities:
a) all power condition timers may be stopped; and
b) on completion of the background activity, the power condition timers that were stopped shall be restarted
from where they were stopped.
Table 8 describes the number of words transferred per COUNT field unit for ATA devices that support the LLS
feature set. Data transfer commands transfer either the logical sector size (see A.11.4.4) or 256 words
depending on the command.
EXAMPLE - The READ DMA EXT command and the WRITE DMA EXT command transfer data in units of logical
sectors each of which has a size in words that is indicated by the contents of the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field
(see A.11.4.4) while the READ LOG EXT command and the WRITE LOG EXT command transfer 256 words
per DRQ data block, regardless of the logical sector size.
In figure 4, the long logical sector example shows a device formatted with long logical sectors.
The Long Physical Sector (LPS) feature set (see 4.13) and the LLS feature set are not mutually exclusive. In
figure 4, the long logical and long physical sector example shows a device that implements both the LPS feature
set and the LLS feature set.
Long physical sector example: 512 bytes per LBA, 1,024 bytes per physical sector
512 Bytes 512 Bytes 512 Bytes 512 Bytes 512 Bytes 512 Bytes 512 Bytes
Long logical and Long physical sector example: 524 bytes per LBA, 1,048 bytes per physical sector
524 Bytes 524 Bytes 524 Bytes 524 Bytes 524 Bytes 524 Bytes 524 Bytes
If the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.4.3.1) is set to one and the LOGICAL TO
PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field (see A.11.4.3.4) is cleared to zero, then the device may report the alignment
of the first logical sector (LBA 0) within the first physical sector in the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field
(see A.11.4.3.5).
Examples of logical/physical sector alignments follow.
EXAMPLE 1 - In Figure 5 there are two logical sectors within one physical sector, and the first logical sector
is in the first half. The offset is zero, and the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see A.11.4.3.5) is set to 0000h.
Figure 5 — Alignment 0
EXAMPLE 2 - In Figure 6 there are two logical sectors within one physical sector, and the first logical sector
is in the second half. The offset is one, and the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see A.11.4.3.5) is set to 0001h.
Figure 6 — Alignment 1
EXAMPLE 3 - In Figure 7 there are four logical sectors within one physical sector, and the first logical sector is
in the second half. The offset is three, and the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see A.11.4.3.5) is set to 0003h.
Figure 7 — Alignment 3
NOTE 2 — The NCQ Tag identifies return information (e.g., error status, data transfer and command
completion).
If an error occurs while the device is processing an NCQ command, then the device shall return command
aborted for all NCQ commands that are in the queue and shall return command aborted for any new commands,
except a READ LOG EXT command requesting log address 10h, until the device completes a READ LOG EXT
command requesting log address 10h (i.e., reading the NCQ Command Error log) without error.
4.14.2 Priority
The priority is specified in the PRIO field for NCQ commands (e.g., the READ FPDMA QUEUED command and
the WRITE FPDMA QUEUED command). Table 9 describes the meaning of the PRIO field.
Code Description
00b Normal priority
Isochronous deadline-dependent priority
01b The device should complete isochronous requests prior to their
associated deadline.
High priority
The device should attempt to provide better quality of service for
10b the command. The device should complete high priority
requests in a more timely fashion than normal and isochronous
requests.
11b Reserved
SLEEP command
PM0:PM3
PM2: Standby PM1: Idle
PM0: Active: This state shall be entered if the device processes a media access command while in Idle mode or
Standby mode. This state shall also be entered after processing a power-on reset if the Power-Up In Standby
feature is not supported or is not enabled (see 4.16).
In Active mode the device is capable of responding to commands. During the processing of a media access
command a device shall be in the Active mode. Power consumption is greatest in this mode.
Transition PM0:PM0: The device shall transition to the PM0: Active state after processing a hardware reset,
software reset, or DEVICE RESET command (see 7.6).
Transition PM0:PM1: The device shall transition to the PM1: Idle state if:
a) an IDLE command (see 7.14) is processed without error;
b) an IDLE IMMEDIATE command (see 7.15) is processed without error; or
c) a vendor specific implementation determines a transition to the PM1: Idle state is required.
Transition PM0:PM2: The device shall transition to the PM2: Standby state if:
a) a STANDBY command (see 7.49) is processed without error;
b) a STANDBY IMMEDIATE command (see 7.50) is processed without error;
c) the Standby timer expires (see 4.15.3); or
d) a vendor specific implementation determines a transition to the PM2: Standby state is required.
Transition PM0:PM3: If a SLEEP command (see 7.47) is processed, the device shall transition to the PM3:
Sleep state.
PM1: Idle: This state shall be entered if the device processes an IDLE command or IDLE IMMEDIATE command
without error. Some devices may perform vendor specific internal power management and transition to the Idle
mode without host intervention.
In Idle mode the device is capable of processing commands but the device may take longer to complete
commands than when in the Active mode. Power consumption may be reduced from that of Active mode.
Transition PM1:PM0: If a media access is required, the device shall transition to the PM0: Active state.
Transition PM1:PM1: The device shall transition to the PM1: Idle state after processing a hardware reset,
software reset, or DEVICE RESET command.
Transition PM1:PM2: The device shall transition to the PM2: Standby state if:
a) a STANDBY command is processed without error;
b) a STANDBY IMMEDIATE command is processed without error;
c) the Standby timer expires; or
d) a vendor specific implementation determines a transition to the PM2: Standby state is required.
Transition PM1:PM3: If a SLEEP command is processed without error, the device shall transition to the PM3:
Sleep state.
PM2: Standby: This state shall be entered if:
a) the device returns completion for a STANDBY command without error;
b) the device returns completion for a STANDBY IMMEDIATE command without error;
c) the Standby timer expires;
d) a device performs a vendor specific power management function; or
e) the device processes a hardware reset, a software reset, or returns completion for a DEVICE RESET
command without an error while in PM2: Standby or PM3: Sleep.
In Standby mode the device is capable of processing commands but the device may take longer (e.g., 30
seconds) to complete commands than in the Idle mode. Power consumption may be reduced from that of Idle
mode.
Transition PM2:PM0: If a media access is required, the device shall transition to the PM0: Active state.
Transition PM2:PM1: The device shall transition to the PM1: Idle state if:
a) an IDLE command is processed without error; or
b) an IDLE IMMEDIATE command is processed without error.
Transition PM2:PM2: The device shall transition to the PM2: Standby state after processing a hardware reset,
software reset, or DEVICE RESET command.
Transition PM2:PM3: If a SLEEP command is processed without error, the device shall transition to the PM3:
Sleep state.
PM3: Sleep: This state shall be entered if the device processes a SLEEP command without error.
A device transitions from Sleep mode only after processing a hardware reset, a software reset, or a DEVICE
RESET command. Processing a hardware reset, a software reset, or a DEVICE RESET command may take a
long time (e.g., 30 seconds). Sleep mode provides the lowest power consumption of any mode.
In Sleep mode, the device interface behavior is defined in the applicable transport standard.
Transition PM3:PM2:, A device shall transition to the PM2: Standby state after processing a hardware reset,
software reset, or DEVICE RESET command.
PM4: PUIS: This state shall be entered after processing a power-on reset if the PUIS feature set (see 4.16) is
supported and is enabled.
Transition PM4:PM5: A device shall transition to the PM5: PUIS and spin-up subcommand not supported state
if the device does not implement the PUIS feature set device spin-up subcommand (see 7.45.11).
Transition PM4:PM6: A device shall transition to the PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported state if
the device implements the PUIS feature set device spin-up subcommand.
PM5: PUIS and spin-up subcommand not supported: This state shall be entered after processing a power-on
reset if the PUIS feature set is supported and is enabled and the device does not implement the PUIS feature set
device spin-up subcommand.
In this state, the device is capable of processing commands but the device may take longer (e.g., 30 seconds) to
complete commands than in the Idle mode. Power consumption may be reduced from that of Idle mode.
Transition PM5:PM0: If the device processes a media access command, the device shall transition to the PM0:
Active state.
Transition PM5:PM5: A device shall transition to the PM5: PUIS and spin-up subcommand not supported state
after processing:
a) an IDENTIFY DEVICE command;
b) an IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command;
c) any hardware reset;
d) any software reset; or
e) any command that does not require media access.
PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported: This state shall be entered after processing a power-on
reset if the PUIS feature set is supported, is enabled, and the device implements the PUIS feature set device
spin-up command.
In this state, the device is capable of processing commands but the device may take longer (e.g., 30 seconds) to
complete commands than in the Idle mode. Power consumption may be reduced from that of Idle mode.
Transition PM6:PM0: A device shall transition to the PM0: Active state after processing a SET FEATURES
PUIS feature set device spin-up subcommand.
Transition PM6a:PM6: A device shall transition to the PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported state
after processing IDENTIFY DEVICE command or IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command.
Transition PM6b:PM6: The device shall transition to the PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported state
after returning command aborted in response to a command, other than IDENTIFY DEVICE command or
IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command, that requires media access.
Transition PM6c:PM6: A device shall transition to the PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported state
after processing a command, other than IDENTIFY DEVICE command or IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE
command, that does not require media access.
Transition PM6d:PM6: A device shall transition to the PM6: PUIS and spin-up subcommand supported state
after processing a hardware reset, software reset, or DEVICE RESET command.
An overwrite sanitize operation (i.e., a sanitize operation that is initiated by an OVERWRITE EXT command
(see 7.36.4) fills all user data with a four byte pattern passed in the LBA field of the command. Parameters for the
OVERWRITE EXT command include a count for multiple overwrites and whether to invert the four byte pattern
between consecutive overwrite passes.
Sector reallocation is allowed during sanitize operations.
If deferred microcode data (see table 7.7) exists, sanitize operation commands return command aborted.
4.17.5 Command processing during sanitize operations
After a device has started processing a Sanitize operation and until the device transitions to the SD0: Sanitize
Idle state (see 4.17.9.2), the device shall abort all commands other than the:
a) IDENTIFY DEVICE command;
b) IDLE IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD;
c) READ LOG EXT command or READ LOG DMA EXT command if one of the following log addresses is
requested:
A) 10h (i.e., NCQ Command Error log);
B) 30h (i.e., IDENTIFY DEVICE data log); or
C) E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log);
d) REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command;
e) SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT command;
f) SANITIZE STATUS EXT command;
g) SECURITY UNLOCK command;
h) SET FEATURES PUIS feature set device spin-up subcommand;
i) SMART READ LOG command if one of the following log addresses is requested:
A) 30h (i.e., IDENTIFY DEVICE data log); or
B) E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log);
j) SMART RETURN STATUS command; and
k) supported sanitize operations commands (see 4.17.4), if the device is in the SD3: Sanitize Operation
Failed state (see 4.17.9.5) or the SD4: Sanitize Operation Succeeded state (see 4.17.9.6).
If the device processes an IDLE IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD (see 7.15) that returns command
completion without error, then the sanitize operation shall be suspended. The sanitize operation shall be
resumed after the processing of a software reset, a hardware reset, or any new command except IDLE
IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD.
If the device processes a power-on reset and enters the PM5: PUIS and spin-up subcommand not supported
state (see figure 8), then the device shall resume processing the sanitize operation after receiving a media
access command, even though the media access command returns command aborted.
4.17.6 Sanitize Operation Completed Without Error value
The Sanitize Operation Completed Without Error value is an indication of the success of the last completed
sanitize operation. The value shall be maintained in non-volatile storage. The Sanitize Operation Completed
Without Error value is:
a) cleared to zero when the Sanitize Device state machine transitions to the SD2: Sanitize Operation In
Progress state (see 4.17.9.4);
b) set to one when the Sanitize Device state machine transitions to the SD4: Sanitize Operation Succeeded
state (see 4.17.9.6); and
c) preserved over all resets (e.g., power-on reset).
The Sanitize Operation Completed Without Error value is reported in the SANITIZE OPERATION COMPLETED
WITHOUT ERROR bit (see table 216).
If the Failure Mode Policy value is cleared to zero and the FAILURE MODE bit is set to one in a sanitize operation
command processed while in the SD3: Sanitize Operation Failed state (see 4.17.9.5) or in the SD4: Sanitize
Operation Succeeded state (see 4.17.9.6), then the sanitize operation command returns command aborted.
The Failure Mode Policy value is:
a) cleared to zero when the Sanitize Device state machine enters the SD0: Sanitize Idle state
(see 4.17.9.2); and
b) preserved over all resets (e.g., power-on reset).
4.17.8 Sanitize Antifreeze value
The Sanitize Antifreeze value is an indication of whether a SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT command
(see 7.36.5) returned command completion without error.
The Sanitize Antifreeze value is:
a) set to one if a SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT command returns command completion without
error; and
b) cleared to zero by the processing of:
A) a power-on reset; or
B) a hardware reset with the SSP feature disabled (see 4.21).
4.17.9 Sanitize Device state machine
4.17.9.1 Overview
Figure 9 describes the operation of the Sanitize Device state machine.
UNLOCK (see 7.42) command or a SECURITY DISABLE PASSWORD (see 7.37) command if the Master
password is supplied.
4.18.9 Password attempt counter and SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit
The device shall maintain a password attempt counter and a SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit (see A.11.8.3.4).
The password attempt counter shall be decremented if:
a) the device is in the SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8);
b) the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit is cleared to zero; and
c) a SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42) fails as a result of an invalid User password or Master
password.
If the password attempt counter reaches zero, the device shall set the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit to one.
If the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit is set to one, the device shall return command aborted for all SECURITY
UNLOCK commands and SECURITY ERASE UNIT commands (see 7.39).
If the device processes a power-on reset or a hardware reset, then the device shall:
a) clear the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit to zero; and
b) set the password attempt counter to five.
4.18.10 Master Password Identifier feature
The Master Password Identifier feature associates a 16-bit non-volatile value with the Master password. The
master password identifier does not indicate whether a Master password exists or is valid.
Support for this feature is reported in the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.8.2). Valid identifiers are
0001h through FFFEh. A value of 0000h or FFFFh indicates that this feature is not supported.
If the Master Password Identifier feature is supported, then:
a) the host may specify the value of the master password identifier using the SECURITY SET PASSWORD
command (see 7.41);
b) the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field shall not be modified by the device except in response to the
SECURITY SET PASSWORD command; and
c) the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field shall be set to FFFEh at the time of manufacture.
If supported, the Master Password Identifier feature allows an administrator to use several sets of Master
passwords (e.g., for use in different deployments of devices). The administrator may:
a) maintain a mapping of actual Master passwords to corresponding Master Password Identifiers;
b) set the corresponding Master Password Identifier at the same time the Master password is set using a
SECURITY SET PASSWORD command in which the Master password is specified (i.e, the IDENTIFIER bit
is set to one); and
c) retrieve the most recently set Master Password Identifier from the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field in
the Security page of the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log.
If a User password had been set and lost, an administrator may read the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field to
obtain a hint as to which Master password was previously set.
Security Characteristics
Security
state Reference Power Enabled a Locked b Frozen c Password Attempts Exceeded d
SEC0 4.18.11.4 off 0 N/A N/A N/A
SEC1 4.18.11.5 on 0 0 0 0
SEC2 4.18.11.6 on 0 0 1 Varies
SEC3 4.18.11.7 off 1 N/A N/A N/A
SEC4 4.18.11.8 on 1 1 0 Varies
SEC5 4.18.11.9 on 1 0 0 Varies
SEC6 4.18.11.10 on 1 0 1 Varies
a See the SECURITY ENABLED bit (see A.11.8.3.7).
b See the SECURITY LOCKED bit (see A.11.8.3.6).
c See the SECURITY FROZEN bit (see A.11.8.3.5).
d See the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit (see A.11.8.3.4).
Hardware Reset
Note: Some events may change SEC5: Enabled/
SEC1:SEC1
Security characteristics without Not Locked/
changing state in this figure SECURITY SET PASSWORD Not Frozen
command (user)
SEC1:SEC5
Successful SECURITY
SECURITY ERASE UNLOCK command
UNIT command
SEC4:SEC5
SEC4:SEC1 Hardware Reset
Power-on reset
SEC5:SEC4
SEC3:SEC4
Power-down
SEC4:SEC3 Hardware Reset
SEC4:SEC4
Table 12 — Security page settings for the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state
Transition SEC1:SEC0: If the device is powered-down, the device shall transition to the SEC0: Powered
down/Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.4).
Transition SEC1:SEC1: If the device processes a hardware reset, the device shall transition to the SEC1:
Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5).
Transition SEC1a:SEC1: If a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command (see 7.41) in which the Master password
is specified (i.e, the IDENTIFIER bit is set to one) returns command completion without error, then the device shall:
a) save the Master password and the optional Master Password Identifier;
b) transition to the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5); and
c) not change the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see A.11.8.3.2).
Transition SEC1:SEC2: If a SECURITY FREEZE LOCK command (see 7.40) returns command completion
without error, then the device shall transition to the SEC2: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Frozen state
(see 4.18.11.6).
Transition SEC1:SEC5: If a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command (see 7.41) in which the User password is
specified (i.e, the IDENTIFIER bit is cleared to zero) returns command completion without error, then the device
shall:
a) save the User password;
b) update the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see A.11.8.3.2); and
c) transition to the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.9).
4.18.11.6 SEC2: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Frozen state
The SEC2: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Frozen state shall be entered when the device processes a
SECURITY FREEZE LOCK command while in the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state
(see 4.18.11.5).
In this state, the device shall respond to commands as specified in the Frozen column of table 11. With the
exception of the commands in the Security feature set, processing of commands shall not cause a transition from
this state.
The device shall set the bits in the Security page (see A.11.8) of the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log as described in
table 13.
Table 13 — Security page settings for the SEC2: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Frozen state
Transition SEC2:SEC0: If the device is powered-down, the device shall transition to the SEC0: Powered
down/Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.4).
Transition SEC2:SEC1: If the device receives a hardware reset, the device shall transition to the SEC1:
Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5).
4.18.11.7 SEC3: Powered down/Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state
The SEC3: Powered down/Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state shall be entered if the device is
powered-down with the Security feature set enabled.
Transition SEC3:SEC4: If the device processes a power-on reset, the device shall transition to the SEC4:
Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8).
4.18.11.8 SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state
The SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state shall be entered if:
a) the Security feature set is enabled and:
A) the device processes a power-on reset; or
B) the device processes a hardware reset;
or
b) while in this state, the device processes a SECURITY ERASE PREPARE command (see 7.38) or a
SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42) and:
A) the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit (see A.11.8.3.4) is set to one; or
B) the password supplied is incorrect.
In this state, the device shall respond to commands as specified in the Locked column of table 11. With the
exception of the commands in the Security feature set, processing of commands shall not cause a transition from
this state.
If this state is entered due to power-on reset or hardware reset, the device shall set the password attempt
counter and the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit as described in 4.18.9.
The device shall set the bits in the Security page (see A.11.8) of the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log as described in
table 14.
Table 14 — Security page settings for the SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state
Transition SEC4:SEC1: If a SECURITY ERASE UNIT command (see 7.39) returns command completion
without error, then the device shall transition to the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state
(see 4.18.11.5).
Transition SEC4:SEC3: If the device is powered-down, the device shall transition to the SEC3: Powered
down/Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.7).
Transition SEC4:SEC4: If the device processes a hardware reset, the device shall transition to the SEC4:
Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8).
Transition SEC4a:SEC4: If a SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42) is processed with an incorrect
password, then the device shall:
a) process the password attempt counter as described in 4.18.9; and
b) transition to the SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8).
After processing of the SECURITY ERASE PREPARE command (see 7.38), the device shall transition to the
SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state.
Transition SEC4:SEC5: If a SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42) returns command completion without
error, the device shall transition to the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.9).
4.18.11.9 SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state
The SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state shall be entered if the device processes one of the
following commands that returns command completion without error:
a) while in the SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5) the device processes
a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command (see 7.41) in which the User password is specified (i.e, the
IDENTIFIER bit is cleared to zero);
b) while in the SEC4: Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8) the device processes a
SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42); or
c) while in the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.9) the device processes
a:
A) SECURITY SET PASSWORD command; or
B) SECURITY ERASE PREPARE command (see 7.38).
In this state, the device shall respond to commands as specified in the Unlocked or Disabled column of table 11.
With the exception of the commands in the Security feature set, processing of commands shall not cause a
transition from this state.
The device shall set the bits in the Security page (see A.11.8) of the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log as described in
table 15.
Table 15 — Security page settings for the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state
Transition SEC5:SEC1: If a SECURITY DISABLE PASSWORD command (see 7.37) or a SECURITY ERASE
UNIT command (see 7.39) returns command completion without error, then the device shall transition to the
SEC1: Security Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5).
Transition SEC5:SEC3: If the device is powered-down, the device shall transition to the SEC3: Powered
down/Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.7).
Transition SEC5:SEC4: If the device processes a hardware reset, the device shall transition to the SEC4:
Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8).
Transition SEC5:SEC5: If a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command (see 7.41) in which the Master password
is specified (i.e, the IDENTIFIER bit is set to one) returns command completion without error, then the device shall:
a) save the Master password and the optional Master Password Identifier;
b) not change the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see A.11.8.3.2); and
c) transition to the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.9).
If a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command in which the User password is specified (i.e, the IDENTIFIER bit is
cleared to zero) or a SECURITY UNLOCK command (see 7.42) returns command completion without error, then
the device shall:
a) save the User password;
b) update the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see A.11.8.3.2); and
c) transition to the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state.
If a SECURITY ERASE PREPARE command (see 7.38) returns command completion without error, then the
device shall transition to the SEC5: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state.
Transition SEC5:SEC6: If a SECURITY FREEZE LOCK command (see 7.40) returns command completion
without error, the device shall transition to the SEC6: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Frozen state
(see 4.18.11.10).
Table 16 — Security page settings for the SEC6: Security Enabled/Not Locked/Frozen state
Transition SEC6:SEC4: If the device processes a hardware reset, the device shall transition to the SEC4:
Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.8).
Transition SEC6:SEC3: If the device is powered-down, the device shall transition to the SEC3: Powered
down/Security Enabled/Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.7).
methods by which the data is collected in this mode may be different than those in the background data collection
mode for any particular device and may vary from one device to another.
4.19.5 Threshold exceeded condition
If the device’s SMART reliability status indicates an impending degrading or fault condition (see 7.48.8), a
threshold exceeded condition occurs.
4.19.6 SMART feature set commands
These commands use a single command code and are differentiated from one another by the value placed in the
FEATURE field (see 7.48).
If the SMART feature set is implemented, the following commands shall be implemented:
a) SMART DISABLE OPERATIONS (see 7.48.2);
b) SMART ENABLE/DISABLE ATTRIBUTE AUTOSAVE (see 7.48.3);
c) SMART ENABLE OPERATIONS (see 7.48.4); and
d) SMART RETURN STATUS (see 7.48.8).
If the SMART feature set is implemented, the following commands are optional:
a) SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE (see 7.48.5);
b) SMART READ DATA (see 7.48.6);
c) SMART READ LOG (see 7.48.7); and
d) SMART WRITE LOG (see 7.48.9).
4.19.7 SMART operation with power management modes
If the SMART feature set is enabled (i.e., if the SMART ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.9) is set to one), a device should
save the device accumulated SMART data upon receipt of an IDLE IMMEDIATE command, STANDBY
IMMEDIATE command, or SLEEP command or upon return to an Active mode or Idle mode from a Standby
mode (see 7.48.6).
If a SMART feature set enabled device has been set to use the Standby timer (see 4.15.3), the device should
save the device accumulated SMART data prior to going from an Idle mode to the Standby mode or upon return
to an Active mode or Idle mode from a Standby mode.
A device shall not process any routine to save the device accumulated SMART data while the device is in a
Standby mode or Sleep mode.
4.19.8 SMART device error log reporting
The logging of reported errors is an optional SMART feature. If error logging is supported by a device, support for
error logging is indicated in byte 370 of the SMART READ DATA command response data (see table 130) and
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 84 bit 0 (see 7.12.7.40). If error logging is supported, the device shall provide
information on the last five errors that the device reported as described in the SMART READ LOG command
(see 7.48.7). The device may also provide additional vendor specific information on these reported errors.
If error logging is supported, error logging shall not be disabled when SMART is disabled. Error log information
shall be gathered while the device is powered-on and in a normal power mode. The logging of errors while in a
reduced power mode is optional. If errors are logged while in a reduced power mode, the reduced power mode
shall not change. Disabling SMART shall disable the delivering of error log information via the SMART READ
LOG command.
The SMART error logs are:
a) the Summary SMART Error Log (see A.21);
b) the Comprehensive SMART Error Log (see A.4); and
c) the Extended Comprehensive SMART Error Log (see A.7).
The REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command (see 7.35) and the SET FEATURES subcommand Enable/Disable
the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 7.45.18) are mandatory for this feature set.
This feature is enabled by issuing a SET FEATURES subcommand Enable/Disable the Sense Data Reporting
feature set (see 7.45.18) to the device. The host may disable this capability by issuing a SET FEATURES
subcommand Enable/Disable the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 7.45.18) to the device.
If the Sense Data Reporting feature set has been enabled (see 7.45.18), the device notifies the host of available
sense data by setting the SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit to one (see 6.2.10) in the STATUS field. The ERROR field shall
comply with the requirements in clause 6. The host retrieves the sense data described in table 214 by issuing a
REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command (see 7.35) to the device. The device may set the SENSE DATA AVAILABLE
bit to one in the STATUS field and clear the ERROR bit to zero in the STATUS field to indicate that the command
returned completion without an error and the sense data described in table 214 is available (e.g., a correctable
error occurred).
If the Sense Data Reporting feature set is supported and is not enabled, then:
a) if the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.38) is set to one, then the device shall
make the sense data described in table 214 available through the REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT
command; and
b) if the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the device may make the
sense data described in table 214 available through the REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command.
The device maintains only the most recent sense data. If more than one reportable event has occurred before
the host issues a REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command, then the device shall return the most recent sense
data.
The sense data shall stop being available to be returned by the REQUEST SENSE EXT command after:
a) receiving any reset;
b) acceptance of a command other than REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command that does not read the
NCQ Command Error log; or
c) completion of a REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command.
This feature set shall be disabled upon the processing of a power-on reset (see ATA8-AAM).
The software settings that shall be preserved across COMRESET are listed in table 17. The device is only
required to preserve the indicated software setting if it supports the particular feature/command with which the
setting is associated.
NOTE 3 — The NOT SEQUENTIAL bit provides information for the device to optimize pre-fetching decisions.
5 ATA protocols
ATA Protocols are described in the transport standards (e.g., ATA8-APT and ATA8-AST). The protocols listed in
this clause shall be implemented by all transports that use the commands defined in this standard. The following
list of protocols are described in ATA8-AAM and the implementation of each protocol is described in the transport
standards:
a) Non-Data Command Protocol;
b) PIO Data-In Command Protocol;
c) PIO Data-Out Command Protocol;
d) DMA Command Protocol;
e) PACKET command Protocol;
f) DMA Queued Command Protocol;
g) Execute Device Diagnostic Command Protocol; and
h) Device Reset Command Protocol.
6.1 Overview
Clause 6 describes requirements for all commands. Individual commands may describe additional requirements.
The normal outputs (see 9.2) and error outputs (see 9.3) for each command include:
a) a one byte STATUS field (see 6.2);
b) a one byte ERROR field (see 6.3);
c) a one byte INTERRUPT REASON field (see 6.4), if required, for certain commands (e.g., PACKET, READ
DMA QUEUED, READ DMA QUEUED EXT, WRITE DMA QUEUED, and WRITE DMA QUEUED EXT);
d) a COUNT field (see 6.5), SACTIVE field (see 6.6), and SATA STATUS field (see 6.7), if required, for certain
commands (e.g., the READ FPDMA QUEUED command, Sanitize Device feature set commands, and
WRITE FPDMA QUEUED command); and
e) an LBA field (see 6.8) that may contain the LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2).
Otherwise, an ATAPI device shall clear the CHECK CONDITION bit to zero.
6.2.5 DATA REQUEST bit
The DATA REQUEST bit is transport dependent (see 6.2.12). Refer to the appropriate transport standard for the
usage of the DATA REQUEST bit.
6.2.6 DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit
The DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit shall be set to one if an error was detected in a deferred write to the media for a
previous WRITE STREAM DMA EXT command (see 7.69) or WRITE STREAM EXT command (see 7.70).
Otherwise, the DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit shall be cleared to zero.
If the DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit is set to one, then the location of the deferred error is only reported in the Write
Stream Error Log (see A.22).
6.2.7 DEVICE FAULT bit
If the device is in a condition where continued operation may affect the integrity of user data on the device (e.g.,
failure to spin-up without error, or no spares remaining for reallocation), then the device shall:
a) return command aborted with the DEVICE FAULT bit set to one in response to all commands (e.g.,
IDENTIFY DEVICE commands, IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE commands) except REQUEST SENSE
DATA EXT commands;
b) complete a REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command without error with a sense key of HARDWARE
ERROR with additional sense code of INTERNAL TARGET FAILURE (see SPC-4), if:
A) the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.28) is set to one; and
B) the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.38) is set to one;
or
c) return command aborted with the DEVICE FAULT bit set to one in response to a REQUEST SENSE DATA
EXT command, if:
A) the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.28) is cleared to zero; or
B) the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit is set to one and the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.38) is cleared to zero.
Power cycling the device is the only mechanism that may clear the DEVICE FAULT bit to zero.
If the DEVICE FAULT bit has been cleared to zero, then it may remain clear until a command that affects user data
integrity is received by the device.
6.2.8 DEVICE READY bit
The DEVICE READY bit is transport dependent (see 6.2.12). Refer to the applicable transport standard for the
usage of the DEVICE READY bit.
6.2.9 ERROR bit
An ATA device shall set the ERROR bit to one if any bit in the ERROR field (see 6.3) is set to one. Otherwise, an
ATA device shall clear the ERROR bit to zero.
then:
a) the STREAM ERROR bit shall be set to one;
b) the ERROR bit shall be cleared to zero; and
c) the error information (e.g., bits set in the ERROR field) shall be saved in the appropriate:
A) Read Stream Error Log (see A.15); or
B) Write Stream Error log (see A.22).
6.2.12 Transport Dependent bits and fields
All bits and fields that are labelled transport dependent are defined in the transport standards.
Bit Description
7:2 Obsolete
1 INPUT/OUTPUT bit (see 6.4.3)
0 COMMAND/DATA bit (see 6.4.2)
Bit Description
7:3 NCQ TAG field (see 7.16.3.3)
2:0 Reserved
7 Command descriptions
ATA commands may use the ICC field and the AUXILIARY field (see table 22).
Field lengths are different based on the type of command (see 7.1.3).
This standard describes the ATA command set in a transport independent fashion. Each command is defined by
a series of subclauses as described in 7.1.2 through 7.1.8.
7.1.2 Command Name – Command Code [/Subcommand Code], Command Protocol
The heading for each command starts with the name of the command. The name is followed by “-” and then the
command code, subcommand code if applicable, and protocol used to process the command.
An example heading reads:
READ SECTOR(S) – 20h, PIO Data-In
In this example heading the name of the command is READ SECTOR(S). The command code is 20h. The
protocol used to transfer the data is PIO Data-In.
Protocols are defined in ATA8-AAM. The transport protocol standards define the implementation of each
protocol.
7.1.3 Feature Set
The feature set subclause for each command lists the feature set (see clause 4) along with a statement that
indicates if the command uses 28-bit field formatting or 48-bit field formatting. If a command uses 28-bit
formatting, then:
a) the FEATURE field, COUNT field, DEVICE field, ERROR field, STATUS field, and COMMAND field are each eight
bits in length; and
b) the LBA field is 28 bits in length.
If a command uses 48-bit formatting, then:
a) the DEVICE field, ERROR field, STATUS field, and COMMAND field are each eight bits in length;
b) the FEATURE field and COUNT field are 16 bits in length; and
c) the LBA field is 48 bits in length.
An example feature set subclause reads:
Feature Set
This 28-bit command is for all ATA devices.
7.1.4 Inputs
7.1.4.1 Overview
The Inputs subclause contains a table showing the inputs for the command. An example command structure is
shown in table 22.
Field Description
FEATURE Each transport standard defines how the FEATURE field is mapped for proper functionality. Each
transport standard also defines how 28-bit commands are mapped differently than 48-bit
commands.
COUNT Each transport standard defines how the COUNT field is mapped for proper functionality. Each
transport standard also defines how 28-bit commands are mapped differently than 48-bit
commands.
LBA For many commands, the LBA field contains the LBA of the first logical sector to be transferred.
Each transport standard defines how the LBA field is mapped to the appropriate fields or registers.
a
ICC Each transport standard defines how the ICC field, if present, is mapped to the appropriate fields
or registers. The ICC field is not present in all commands.
AUXILIARY a Each transport standard defines how the AUXILIARY field, if present, is mapped to the appropriate
fields or registers. The AUXILIARY field is not present in all commands.
DEVICE Each transport standard defines how the DEVICE field bits 7:4 are mapped. Bits 3:0 are marked
reserved in every reference to the DEVICE field.
COMMAND The COMMAND field contains the command code.
a Commands that depend on the transport of this field are defined by this standard in a way that prevents
the operation codes from being valid on devices that implement a transport standard that does not define
a mapping for this field.
Field Description
ERROR Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9
5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 Obsolete
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2:1 N/A
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
x0h x1h x2h x3h x4h x5h x6h x7h x8h x9h xAh xBh xCh xDh xEh xFh
a a
0xh C R R A R R C R C R R C R R R R
1xh O E E E E E E E E E E E E E E E
a
2xh C O O O C C O O R C C C R R R C
a a a
3xh C O O O C C O O A C C C O C O C
4xh C O C R R C R C R R R R R R R R
5xh O C R R R R R C R R R C C C C C
a a a
6xh C C S C C C S S R R R R R R R R
7xh O E E E E E E Ca Ca E E E E E E E
8xh V V V V V V V A V V V V V V V V
9xh C O C C E E E E E E V R R R R R
Axh C C O R R R R R R R R R R R R R
a a a
Bxh C O R R C R O A A A A A R R R R
a a
Cxh A V V V C C C O C O C O O A C R
Dxh R O R R R R R R R R O E E E O O
a a
Exh C C C C C C C C C C C C C O O C
a a
Fxh V C C C C C C V O O V V V V V V
Key: C = defined command O = Obsolete
R = Reserved, undefined in current E = retired command
specifications A = Reserved for CFA
V = Vendor specific commands S = Reserved for Serial ATA
a This entry has changed from ACS-2.
Field Description
FEATURE 0000h
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0001h
COUNT Reserved
LBA Requested maximum LBA value
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0002h
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.3.3 Inputs
See table 30 for the CHECK POWER MODE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 DEFAULT CCTL field – See 7.4.3.4.
7 ADD/REMOVE STREAM bit – See 7.4.3.2.
6 Obsolete
5:3 Reserved
2:0 STREAM ID field – See 7.4.3.3.
NOTE 5 — Setting the ALLOCATION UNIT field does not restrict or change command behavior.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:1 Reserved.
0 TRIM bit – See 7.5.3.2.
COUNT Number of 512-byte blocks to be transferred (see 7.5.6). The value zero is reserved.
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Bit
TRIM DRAT RZAT
SUPPORTED SUPPORTED SUPPORTED Description
0 see A.11.5.9.1 see A.11.5.9.1 The Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT
command (see 7.5.3.2) is not supported. The data is
unaffected by the DATA SET MANAGEMENT command.
0 see A.11.5.2.8 The Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT
command (see 7.5.3.2) causes non-deterministic read after
trim behavior a.
1 1 0 The Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT
command (see 7.5.3.2) shall cause deterministic read after
trim behavior b with data set to any value.
1 1 The Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT
command (see 7.5.3.2) shall cause deterministic read after
trim behavior b with data cleared to zero.
a
non-deterministic read after trim behavior: Each read command to the logical block may return different
data.
b
deterministic read after trim behavior: After a read command has completed processing, the data in that
logical block becomes determinate (i.e., subsequent read commands to that logical block shall return the
same data).
The data read from an LBA that has been trimmed shall not be retrieved from data that was previously received
from a host addressed to any other LBA.
Once a trimmed LBA has been written (e.g., a write command or a SECURITY ERASE UNIT command), the
data in that logical block becomes determinate (i.e., the logical block contains the written data).
7.5.4 Normal Outputs
See table 211.
7.5.5 Error Outputs
If the TRIM bit is set to one and:
a) the device detects an invalid LBA Range Entry (see 7.5.6); or
b) count is greater than IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 105 (see 7.12.7.55),
then the device shall return command aborted.
A device may trim one or more LBA Range Entries before it returns command aborted. See table 230.
EXAMPLE 1 - Logical blocks 11 through 18 make one LBA Range Entry that has LBA 11 as its LBA VALUE field
and the value of 8 as its RANGE LENGTH field (i.e., 0008_0000_0000_000Bh).
EXAMPLE 2 - If only logical block 20 is represented in an LBA Range Entry, the range value is one (i.e.,
0001_0000_0000_0014h).
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Phases Included
Code Subcommand Name
Download Save Activate
01h Obsolete
03h Download with offsets and save microcode for one or more Yes Yes a
immediate and future use (see 7.7.2.2) segments
07h Download and save microcode for immediate and one segment only Yes Yes
future use (see 7.7.2.3)
0Eh Download with offsets and save microcode for future one or more Yes No b
use (see 7.7.2.4) segments
0Fh Activate downloaded microcode (see 7.7.2.5) No No Yes
all others Reserved
a Activation occurs after the complete updated microcode data has been downloaded.
b Activation does not occur as part of the processing of the command, but is triggered by events that occur
after command completion (e.g., power cycle or Activate downloaded microcode subcommand).
7.7.2.2 Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use subcommand (i.e., 03h)
The Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use subcommand transfers the updated
microcode data in one or more DOWNLOAD MICROCODE commands or DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA
commands. This subcommand downloads data containing a segment of the updated microcode data. On normal
command completion, the COUNT field may contain additional indicators (see 7.7.4).
If the final segment has been downloaded, the device validates the downloaded updated microcode. If the
validation is successful, the downloaded updated microcode is saved to non-volatile storage and is activated.
After transferring a segment where the value of the BUFFER OFFSET field is cleared to zero, if the device begins to
process a command that is not a DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command and is not a DOWNLOAD MICROCODE
DMA command, then the device:
1) may discard any updated microcode data that has not been saved; and
2) shall continue to process the new command.
7.7.2.3 Download and save microcode for immediate and future use subcommand (i.e., 07h)
The Download and save microcode for immediate and future use subcommand transfers the updated microcode
data in one DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command or in one DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command.
After the updated microcode data has been downloaded:
1) the device shall save the updated microcode data;
2) the device shall activate the updated microcode data; and
3) if command completion has not previously been returned, then the device shall return command
completion.
7.7.2.4 Download with offsets and save microcode for future use subcommand (i.e., 0Eh)
The Download and save microcode for future use subcommand transfers the updated microcode data in one
or more DOWNLOAD MICROCODE commands or DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA commands. On normal
command completion, the COUNT field may contain additional indicators (see 7.7.4).
If the final segment has been downloaded, the device validates the downloaded updated microcode. If the
validation is successful, the downloaded updated microcode is saved to non-volatile storage and becomes the
deferred microcode. The deferred microcode data is activated as a result of processing the next power on reset
or processing an Activate downloaded microcode subcommand (see 7.7.2.5).
The processing of commands other than the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command and the DOWNLOAD
MICROCODE DMA command shall not affect any:
a) updated microcode; and
b) saved microcode.
7.7.2.5 Activate downloaded microcode subcommand (i.e., 0Fh)
The Activate downloaded microcode subcommand shall activate deferred microcode data that had been
previously downloaded and saved by the Download with offsets and save microcode for future use subcommand
(see 7.7.2.4).
If there is no deferred microcode data that has been saved using the Download with offsets and save microcode
for future use subcommand, then the device shall return command aborted.
If the activation attempt fails, the device shall return command aborted.
7.7.2.6 DOWNLOAD MICROCODE state machine
7.7.2.6.1 Overview
Subclause 7.7.2.6 and figure 11 describe the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE state machine for all subcommands of
the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command and the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command.
DL1:No DL
In Process DL0:PowerOn
Process PowerOn Reset
DL0:DL1
DL2:SubCmd 07h DL
DL SubCmd 07h
DL1:DL2
Error Detected
DL2a:DL1
Reset
DL2b:DL1
Saved And Activated
DL2c:DL1
DL3:First Segment
SubCmd 03h
DL SubCmd 03h
DL1:DL3
DL4:Next Segment
First Segment != SubCmd 03h
Last Segment
Error Detected DL3:DL4
DL3a:DL1 Offset=0
DL4:DL3
DL5: SubCmd 03h DL SubCmd 07h
Reset
Save & Activate DL4:DL2
DL3b:DL1
Error Detected
DL4a:DL1
Reset
DL4b:DL1
DL6:First Segment
SubCmd 0Eh
DL SubCmd 0Eh
DL1:DL6
DL7:Next Segment
First Segment != SubCmd 0Eh
Last Segment
Error Detected DL6:DL7
DL6a:DL1 Offset=0 DL SubCmd 03h
DL7:DL6
DL7:DL3
Reset DL8: SubCmd 0Eh
DL6:DL1 DL SubCmd 07h
Save
DL7:DL2
First Segment = Final Segment
Last Segment DL7:DL8
Error Detected DL6:DL8
DL8a:DL1
Reset
DL8b:DL1
Saved
DL8c:DL1
Error Detected
DL7a:DL1
Reset
DL7b:DL1
DL9: Activate
SubCmd 0Fh
DL SubCmd 0Fh
DL1:DL9
Activated by command
DL9a:DL1
Activation error
DL9b:DL1
Transition DL2c:DL1: If the device does not detect an error, then the device:
1) should activate the updated microcode data before the device returns command completion without
error;
2) shall activate the updated microcode data if the device returned command completion without error first;
3) shall return command completion without error if the device has not previously returned command
completion; and
4) shall transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
7.7.2.6.5 DL3: First Segment SubCmd 03h state
In the DL3: First Segment SubCmd 03h state, the device processes a Download with offsets and save microcode
for immediate and future use subcommand and the value of the BUFFER OFFSET field is cleared to zero. The
device shall transfer the first segment of updated microcode data from the host.
If a Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use subcommand is processed and the
value of the BLOCK COUNT field is cleared to zero, then the Non-Data transfer protocol shall be used. This
condition shall not be considered as an error.
Transition DL3a:DL1: If the device processes a Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and
future use subcommand and:
a) the value of the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see A.11.5.3.5) is:
A) not 0000h;
B) not FFFFh; and
C) greater than the BLOCK COUNT field of the Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate
and future use subcommand;
b) the value of the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see A.11.5.3.4) is:
A) not 0000h;
B) not FFFFh; and
C) less than the value of the BLOCK COUNT field of the Download with offsets and save microcode for
immediate and future use subcommand;
or
c) the device detects an error,
then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data;
3) return command aborted; and
4) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL3b:DL1: If the device processes a hardware reset or a software reset, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL3:DL4: If the data transfer is complete and not all of the updated microcode data has been
received by the device (e.g., the first segment is not the last segment), then the device:
1) shall retain all deferred microcode data;
2) shall return command completion with no error;
3) may set the COUNT field to 01h (see 7.7.4); and
4) shall transition to the DL4: Next Segment SubCmd 03h (see 7.7.2.6.6) state.
Transition DL3:DL5: If the data transfer is complete and all of the updated microcode data has been received by
the device, then the device shall:
1) not return command completion; and
2) transition to the DL5: SubCmd 03h Save & Activate (see 7.7.2.6.7) state.
Transition DL5c:DL1: If the device does not detect an error, then the device:
1) may change the feature configuration (e.g., SET FEATURES settings);
2) should activate the updated microcode data;
3) may set the COUNT field to 02h (see 7.7.4);
4) shall return command completion without error; and
5) shall transition to DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
7.7.2.6.8 DL6: First Segment SubCmd 0Eh state
In the DL6: First Segment SubCmd 0Eh state, the device processes a Download with offsets and save
microcode for future use subcommand if the value of the BUFFER OFFSET field is equal to zero. The device shall
transfer the first segment of updated microcode data from the host.
If a Download with offsets and save microcode for future use subcommand is processed and the value of the
BLOCK COUNT field is cleared to zero, then the Non-Data transfer protocol shall be used. This condition shall not
be considered as an error.
Transition DL6a:DL1: If the device processes a Download with offsets and save microcode for future use
subcommand and:
a) the value of the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see A.11.5.3.5) is:
A) not 0000h;
B) not FFFFh; and
C) greater than the BLOCK COUNT field of the Download with offsets and save microcode for future use
subcommand;
or
b) the value of the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see A.11.5.3.4) is:
A) not 0000h;
B) not FFFFh; and
C) less than the value of the BLOCK COUNT field of the Download with offsets and save microcode for
future use subcommand,
then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data;
3) return command aborted; and
4) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL6b:DL1: If the device processes a hardware reset or a software reset, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL6:DL7: If the data transfer is complete and not all of the updated microcode data have been
received by the device (e.g., the first segment is not the last segment), then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data;
3) return command completion without error;
4) set the COUNT field to 01h (see 7.7.4); and
5) transition to the DL7: Next Segment SubCmd 0Eh (see 7.7.2.6.9) state.
Transition DL6:DL8: If the data transfer is complete and all of the updated microcode data has been received by
the device, then the device shall:
1) not return command completion; and
2) transition to the DL8: SubCmd 0Eh Save (see 7.7.2.6.10) state.
Transition DL7b:DL1: If the device processes a hardware reset or a software reset, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL7:DL2: If the device processes a Download and save microcode for immediate and future use
subcommand, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL2: SubCmd 07h DL (see 7.7.2.6.4) state.
Transition DL7:DL3: If the device processes a Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and
future use subcommand and the value of the BUFFER OFFSET field is cleared to zero, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL3: First Segment SubCmd 03h (see 7.7.2.6.5) state.
Transition DL7:DL6: If the device processes a Download with offsets and save microcode for future use
subcommand and the value of the BUFFER OFFSET field is cleared to zero, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL6: First Segment SubCmd 0Eh (see 7.7.2.6.8) state.
Transition DL7:DL8: If the device determines that all segments of the updated microcode data have been
downloaded, then the device shall transition to the DL8: SubCmd 0Eh Save (see 7.7.2.6.10) state.
7.7.2.6.10 DL8: SubCmd 0Eh Save state
In the DL8: SubCmd 0Eh Save state, the device shall:
1) perform any verification required by the device; and
2) save the updated microcode data in a non-volatile location, replacing any deferred microcode data.
Transition DL8a:DL1: If the device detects an error, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data;
3) return command aborted; and
4) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL8b:DL1: If the device processes a hardware reset or a software reset prior to saving the updated
microcode data, then the device shall:
1) discard all updated microcode data that has not been saved;
2) retain all deferred microcode data; and
3) transition to the DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
Transition DL8c:DL1: If the device does not detect an error, then the device:
1) shall set the COUNT field to 03h (see 7.7.4);
2) shall return command completion with no error; and
3) shall transition to DL1: No DL In Process (see 7.7.2.6.3) state.
7.7.2.6.11 DL9: Activate SubCmd 0Fh state
In the DL9: Activate SubCmd 0Fh state, the deferred microcode data is activated.
Transition DL9a:DL1: If the device has deferred microcode data, then the device shall:
1) activate the deferred microcode data;
2) discard the deferred microcode data;
3) set the COUNT field to 03h (see 7.7.4);
4) return command completion without error; and
Field Description
FEATURE SUBCOMMAND field (see 7.7.3.2)
COUNT BLOCK COUNT field (7:0) (see 7.7.3.3)
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 BUFFER OFFSET field (see 7.7.3.4)
7:0 BLOCK COUNT field (15:8) (see 7.7.3.3)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 38 — COUNT field output for DOWNLOAD MICROCODE requesting the offset transfer method
Valid for
Value Description
Subcommands
00h 03h No indication of download microcode status.
01h 03h and 0Eh Indicates the ATA device is expecting more download microcode commands to
follow.
02h 03h and 0Fh Indicates that the ATA device has applied the new microcode.
03h 0Eh All segments of the updated microcode data have been received and saved,
and the device is waiting for activation of the updated microcode data.
04h-FFh None Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE See the FEATURE field in 7.7.3.
COUNT See the COUNT field in 7.7.3.
LBA See the LBA field in 7.7.3.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Code a Description
When this code is in the Device 0 b ERROR field
01h Device 0 b passed, Device 1 b passed or not present
00h, 02h..7Fh Device 0 b failed, Device 1 b passed or not present
81h Device 0 b passed, Device 1 b failed
80h, 82h..FFh Device 0 b failed, Device 1 b failed
When this code is in the Device 1 b ERROR field
01h Device 1 b passed c
00h, 02h..7Fh Device 1 b failed c
80h..FFh Reserved
a
Codes other than 01h and 81h may indicate additional information about
the failure(s).
b
See the appropriate transport standard for the definition of device 0 and
device 1.
c If Device 1 is not present, the host may see the information from Device
0 even though Device 1 is selected.
7.10.3 Inputs
See table 42 for the FLUSH CACHE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.11.3 Inputs
See table 42 for the FLUSH CACHE EXT command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 8 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
O S F
Word M P V Description
0 M B General configuration (see 7.12.7.2)
F 15 0 = ATA device
X 14:8 Retired
X 7:6 Obsolete
X 5:3 Retired
V 2 Incomplete response
X 1 Retired
0 Reserved
1 X Obsolete
2 O B V Specific configuration (see 7.12.7.4)
3 X Obsolete
4..5 X Retired
6 X Obsolete
7..8 N Reserved for CFA (see 7.12.7.8)
9 X Retired
10..19 M B F Serial number (see 7.12.7.10)
20..21 X Retired
22 X Obsolete
23..26 M B F Firmware revision (see 7.12.7.13)
27..46 M B F Model number (see 7.12.7.14)
47 M See 7.12.7.15
B F 15:8 80h
B F 7:0 00h = Reserved
01h-FFh = Maximum number of logical sectors that shall be transferred
per DRQ data block
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
48 O B Trusted Computing feature set options (see 7.12.7.16)
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
F 14 Shall be set to one
13:1 Reserved for the Trusted Computing Group
F 0 Trusted Computing feature set is supported
49 M Capabilities (see 7.12.7.17)
15:14 Reserved for the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command.
B F 13 1 = Standby timer values as specified in this standard are supported.
0 = Standby timer values shall be vendor specific.
12 Reserved for the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command.
P F 11 1 = IORDY (see ATA8-APT) supported
0 = IORDY (see ATA8-APT) may be supported
P F 10 IORDY (see ATA8-APT) may be disabled
B F 9 Shall be set to one (i.e., LBA is supported).
P F 8 DMA supported
7:2 Reserved
B V 1:0 Long Physical Sector Alignment Error reporting
50 M Capabilities (see 7.12.7.17)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
13:2 Reserved
X 1 Obsolete
B F 0 1 = There is a minimum Standby time value and it is vendor specific.
0 = There is no minimum Standby timer value.
51..52 X Obsolete
53 M See 7.12.7.19
B V 15:8 Free-fall Control Sensitivity
7:3 Reserved
B F 2 the fields reported in word 88 are valid
B F 1 the fields reported in words 64..70 are valid
X 0 Obsolete
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
54..58 X Obsolete
59 M See 7.12.7.21
B F 15 The BLOCK ERASE EXT command is supported (see 7.36.2)
B F 14 The OVERWRITE EXT command is supported (see 7.36.4)
B F 13 The CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT command is supported (see 7.36.3)
B F 12 The Sanitize feature set is supported (see 4.17)
B F 11 1 = The commands allowed during a sanitize operation are as specified by
this standard (see 4.17.5)
0 = The commands allowed during a sanitize operation are as specified by
ACS-2
B F 10 The SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT command is supported
(see 7.36.5)
9 Reserved
B V 8 Multiple logical sector setting is valid
B V 7:0 Current setting for number of logical sectors that shall be transferred per
DRQ data block
60..61 M B F Total number of user addressable logical sectors for 28-bit commands (DWord)
(see 7.12.7.22)
62 X Obsolete
63 M See 7.12.7.24
15:11 Reserved
P V 10 Multiword DMA mode 2 is selected
P V 9 Multiword DMA mode 1 is selected
P V 8 Multiword DMA mode 0 is selected
7:3 Reserved
P F 2 Multiword DMA mode 2 and below are supported
P F 1 Multiword DMA mode 1 and below are supported
P F 0 Multiword DMA mode 0 is supported
64 M See 7.12.7.25
15:2 Reserved
P F 1:0 PIO mode 3 and mode 4 supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
65 M P F Minimum Multiword DMA transfer cycle time per word (see 7.12.7.26)
66 M P F Manufacturer’s recommended Multiword DMA transfer cycle time (see 7.12.7.27)
67 M P F Minimum PIO transfer cycle time without flow control (see 7.12.7.28)
68 M P F Minimum PIO transfer cycle time with IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control
(see 7.12.7.29)
69 M Additional Supported (see 7.12.7.30)
N 15 Reserved for CFA
B F 14 Deterministic data in trimmed LBA range(s) is supported
B F 13 Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control is supported
X 12 Obsolete
B F 11 READ BUFFER DMA is supported
B F 10 WRITE BUFFER DMA is supported
X 9 Obsolete
B F 8 DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA is supported
7 Reserved for IEEE 1667
B F 6 0 = Optional ATA device 28-bit commands supported
B F 5 Trimmed LBA range(s) returning zeroed data is supported
B F 4 Device Encrypts All User Data on the device
B F 3 Extended Number of User Addressable Sectors is supported
B V 2 All write cache is non-volatile
1:0 Reserved
70 Reserved
71..74 Reserved for the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE command
75 O Queue depth (see 7.12.7.33)
15:5 Reserved
S F 4:0 Maximum queue depth – 1
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
76 O Serial ATA Capabilities (see 7.12.7.34)
S F 15 Supports READ LOG DMA EXT as equivalent to READ LOG EXT
S F 14 Supports Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions
S F 13 Supports Host Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions
S F 12 Supports NCQ priority information
S F 11 Supports Unload while NCQ commands are outstanding
S F 10 Supports the SATA Phy Event Counters log
S F 9 Supports receipt of host initiated power management requests
S F 8 Supports the NCQ feature set
7:4 Reserved for Serial ATA
S F 3 Supports SATA Gen3 Signaling Speed (6.0Gb/s)
S F 2 Supports SATA Gen2 Signaling Speed (3.0Gb/s)
S F 1 Supports SATA Gen1 Signaling Speed (1.5Gb/s)
S F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
77 O Serial ATA Additional Capabilities (see 7.12.7.35)
15:7 Reserved for Serial ATA
S F 6 Supports RECEIVE FPDMA QUEUED and SEND FPDMA QUEUED
commands
S F 5 Supports NCQ Queue Management Command
S F 4 Supports NCQ Streaming
S V 3:1 Coded value indicating current negotiated Serial ATA signal speed
S F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
78 O Serial ATA features supported (see 7.12.7.36)
15:8 Reserved for Serial ATA
S F 7 Device supports NCQ Autosense
S F 6 Device supports Software Settings Preservation
S F 5 Device supports Hardware Feature Control
S F 4 Device supports in-order data delivery
S F 3 Device supports initiating power management
S F 2 Device supports DMA Setup auto-activation
S F 1 Device supports non-zero buffer offsets
S F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
79 O Serial ATA features enabled (see 7.12.7.37)
15:8 Reserved for Serial ATA
S V 7 Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions enabled
S V 6 Software Settings Preservation enabled
S V 5 Hardware Feature Control is enabled
S V 4 In-order data delivery enabled
S V 3 Device initiated power management enabled
S V 2 DMA Setup auto-activation enabled
S V 1 Non-zero buffer offsets enabled
S F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
80 M Major version number (see 7.12.7.38)
15:11 Reserved
B F 10 supports ACS-3
B F 9 supports ACS-2
B F 8 supports ATA8-ACS
B F 7 supports ATA/ATAPI-7
B F 6 supports ATA/ATAPI-6
B F 5 supports ATA/ATAPI-5
X 4 Obsolete
X 3 Obsolete
X 2 Obsolete
X 1 Obsolete
0 Reserved
81 M B F Minor version number (see 7.12.7.39)
82 M Commands and feature sets supported (see 7.12.7.40)
X 15 Obsolete
B F 14 The NOP command is supported
B F 13 The READ BUFFER command is supported
B F 12 The WRITE BUFFER command is supported
X 11:10 Obsolete
B F 9 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the DEVICE RESET command is not
supported)
X 8:7 Obsolete
B F 6 Read look-ahead is supported
B F 5 The volatile write cache is supported
B F 4 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the PACKET feature set is not supported)
B F 3 Shall be set to one (i.e., the Power Management feature set is supported)
X 2 Obsolete
B F 1 The Security feature set is supported
B F 0 The SMART feature set is supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
83 M Commands and feature sets supported (see 7.12.7.40)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
B F 13 The FLUSH CACHE EXT command is supported
B F 12 Shall be set to one (i.e., the FLUSH CACHE command is supported)
X 11 Obsolete
B F 10 The 48-bit Address feature set is supported
X 9:8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
B F 6 SET FEATURES subcommand is required to spin-up after power-up
B F 5 The PUIS feature set is supported
X 4 Obsolete
B F 3 The APM feature set is supported
N 2 Reserved for CFA
X 1 Obsolete
B F 0 The DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
84 M Commands and feature sets supported (see 7.12.7.40)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
B F 13 The IDLE IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD feature is supported
X 12:11 Obsolete
X 10:9 Obsolete
B F 8 Shall be set to one (i.e., the World Wide Name is supported)
X 7 Obsolete
B F 6 The WRITE DMA FUA EXT command and WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT
command are supported
B F 5 The GPL feature set is supported
B F 4 The Streaming feature set is supported
X 3 Obsolete
2 Reserved
B F 1 The SMART self-test is supported
B F 0 SMART error logging is supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
85 M Commands and feature sets supported or enabled (see 7.12.7.41)
X 15 Obsolete
B F 14 The NOP command is supported
B F 13 The READ BUFFER command is supported
B F 12 The WRITE BUFFER command is supported
X 11 Obsolete
X 10 Obsolete
B F 9 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the DEVICE RESET command is not
supported)
X 8:7 Obsolete
B V 6 Read look-ahead is enabled
B V 5 The volatile write cache is enabled
B F 4 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the PACKET feature set is not supported)
B F 3 Shall be set to one (i.e., the Power Management feature set is supported)
X 2 Obsolete
B V 1 The Security feature set is enabled
B V 0 The SMART feature set is enabled
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
86 M Commands and feature sets supported or enabled (see 7.12.7.41)
B F 15 Words 119..120 are valid
14 Reserved
B F 13 FLUSH CACHE EXT command supported
B F 12 FLUSH CACHE command supported
X 11 Obsolete
B F 10 The 48-bit Address features set is supported
X 9:8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
B F 6 SET FEATURES subcommand is required to spin-up after power-up
B V 5 The PUIS feature set is enabled
X 4 Obsolete
B V 3 The APM feature set is enabled
N 2 Reserved for CFA
X 1 Obsolete
B F 0 The DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
87 M Commands and feature sets supported or enabled(see 7.12.7.41)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
B F 13 The IDLE IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD FEATURE is supported
X 12:11 Obsolete
X 10:9 Obsolete
B F 8 Shall be set to one (i.e., the World Wide Name is supported)
X 7 Obsolete
B F 6 The WRITE DMA FUA EXT command and WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT
command are supported
B F 5 The GPL feature set is supported
X 4 Obsolete
X 3 Obsolete
B V 2 Media serial number is valid
B F 1 SMART self-test supported
B F 0 SMART error logging is supported
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
88 O Ultra DMA modes (see 7.12.7.42)
15 Reserved
P V 14 Ultra DMA mode 6 is selected.
P V 13 Ultra DMA mode 5 is selected.
P V 12 Ultra DMA mode 4 is selected.
P V 11 Ultra DMA mode 3 is selected.
P V 10 Ultra DMA mode 2 is selected.
P V 9 Ultra DMA mode 1 is selected.
P V 8 Ultra DMA mode 0 is selected.
7 Reserved
P F 6 Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are supported
P F 5 Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are supported
P F 4 Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are supported
P F 3 Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are supported
P F 2 Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are supported
P F 1 Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are supported
P F 0 Ultra DMA mode 0 is supported
89 O B F See 7.12.7.43
15 1=Extended Time is reported in bits 14:0
0=Time is reported in bits 7:0
If bit 15 is set to one
14:0 Extended Time required for Normal Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT
command
If bit 15 is set to zero
14:8 Reserved
7:0 Time required for Normal Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT command
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
90 O B F See 7.12.7.44
15 1=Extended Time is reported in bits 14:0
0=Time is reported in bits 7:0
If bit 15 is set to one
14:0 Extended Time required for Enhanced Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT
command
If bit 15 is set to zero
14:8 Reserved
7:0 Time required for Enhanced Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT
command
91 15:8 Reserved
O B V 7:0 Current APM level value (see 7.12.7.45)
92 O B V Master Password Identifier (see 7.12.7.46)
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
93 M Hardware reset results (see 7.12.7.47)
For SATA devices, word 93 shall be set to the value 0000h.
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero.
B F 14 Shall be set to one for PATA devices.
P V 13 1 = device detected the CBLID- above ViHB (see ATA8-APT)
0 = device detected the CBLID- below ViL (see ATA8-APT)
P 12:8 Device 1 hardware reset result. Device 0 shall clear these bits to zero.
Device 1 shall set these bits as follows:
12 Reserved
V 11 Device 1 asserted PDIAG-.
V 10:9 These bits indicate how Device 1 determined the device number:
00 = Reserved
01 = a jumper was used.
10 = the CSEL signal was used.
11 = some other method was used or the method is unknown.
F 8 Shall be set to one.
P 7:0 Device 0 hardware reset result. Device 1 shall clear these bits to zero.
Device 0 shall set these bits as follows:
7 Reserved
F 6 Device 0 responds when Device 1 is selected.
V 5 Device 0 detected the assertion of DASP-.
V 4 Device 0 detected the assertion of PDIAG-.
V 3 Device 0 passed diagnostics.
V 2:1 These bits indicate how Device 0 determined the device number:
00 = Reserved
01 = a jumper was used.
10 = the CSEL signal was used.
11 = some other method was used or the method is unknown.
F 0 Shall be set to one for PATA devices.
94 X Obsolete
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
95 O B F Stream Minimum Request Size (see 7.12.7.49)
96 O B V Streaming Transfer Time – DMA (see 7.12.7.50)
97 O B V Streaming Access Latency – DMA and PIO (see 7.12.7.51)
98..99 O B F Streaming Performance Granularity (DWord) (see 7.12.7.52)
100..103 O B V Number of User Addressable Logical Sectors (QWord) (see 7.12.7.53)
104 O B V Streaming Transfer Time – PIO (see 7.12.7.54)
105 O B V Maximum number of 512-byte blocks per DATA SET MANAGEMENT command
(see 7.5)
106 O Physical sector size / logical sector size (see 7.12.7.56)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
B F 13 Device has multiple logical sectors per physical sector.
B F 12 Device Logical Sector longer than 256 words
11:4 Reserved
B F 3:0 2X logical sectors per physical sector
P
107 O B F Inter-seek delay for ISO/IEC 7779 standard acoustic testing (see 7.12.7.57)
108..111 M B F World wide name (see 7.12.7.58)
112..115 Reserved
116 X Obsolete
117..118 O B F Logical sector size (DWord) (see 7.12.7.61)
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
119 M Commands and feature sets supported (Continued from words 82..84) (see 7.12.7.40)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
13:10 Reserved
B F 9 DSN feature set is supported
S F 8 Accessible Max Address Configuration feature set is supported
S F 7 EPC feature set is supported
B F 6 Sense Data Reporting feature set is supported
B F 5 The Free-fall Control feature set is supported
B F 4 Download Microcode mode 3 is supported
B F 3 The READ LOG DMA EXT command and WRITE LOG DMA EXT
command are supported
B F 2 The WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT command is supported
B F 1 The Write-Read-Verify feature set is supported
X 0 Obsolete
120 M Commands and feature sets supported or enabled (Continued from words 85..87)
(see 7.12.7.41)
B F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
B F 14 Shall be set to one
13:10 Reserved
B V 9 DSN feature set is enabled
8 Reserved
B V 7 EPC feature set is enabled
B V 6 Sense Data Reporting feature set is enabled
B V 5 The Free-fall Control feature set is enabled
B F 4 Download Microcode mode 3 is supported
B F 3 The READ LOG DMA EXT command and WRITE LOG DMA EXT
command are supported
B F 2 The WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT command is supported
B V 1 The Write-Read-Verify feature set is enabled
X 0 Obsolete
121..126 Reserved for expanded supported and enabled settings
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
127 X Obsolete
128 O Security status (see 7.12.7.66)
15:9 Reserved
B V 8 Master Password Capability: 0 = High, 1 = Maximum
7:6 Reserved
B F 5 Enhanced security erase supported
B V 4 Security count expired
B V 3 Security frozen
B V 2 Security locked
B V 1 Security enabled
B F 0 Security supported
129..159 X Vendor specific
160..167 Reserved for CFA (see 7.12.7.68)
168 See 7.12.7.69
15:4 Reserved
O B F 3:0 Device Nominal Form Factor
169 DATA SET MANAGEMENT command support (see 7.12.7.70)
15:1 Reserved
O B F 0 the TRIM bit in the DATA SET MANAGEMENT command is supported
170..173 O B F Additional Product Identifier (see 7.12.7.71)
174..175 Reserved
176..205 O B V Current media serial number (see 7.12.7.73)
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
206 O B SCT Command Transport (see 7.12.7.74)
X 15:12 Vendor Specific
11:8 Reserved
7 Reserved for Serial ATA
6 Reserved
F 5 The SCT Data Tables command is supported
F 4 The SCT Feature Control command is supported
F 3 The SCT Error Recovery Control command is supported
F 2 The SCT Write Same command is supported
X 1 Obsolete
F 0 The SCT Command Transport is supported
207..208 Reserved
209 O B F Alignment of logical sectors within a physical sector (see 7.12.7.75)
15 Shall be cleared to zero
14 Shall be set to one
13:0 Logical sector offset within the first physical sector where the first logical
sector is placed
210..211 O B V Write-Read-Verify Sector Mode 3 Count (DWord) (see 7.12.7.76)
212..213 O B F Write-Read-Verify Sector Mode 2 Count (DWord) (see 7.12.7.77)
214..216 X Obsolete
217 M B F Nominal media rotation rate (see 7.12.7.79)
218 Reserved
219 X Obsolete
220 O See 7.12.7.82
15:8 Reserved
B V 7:0 Write-Read-Verify feature set current mode
221 Reserved
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
222 M B Transport major version number (see 7.12.7.84)
0000h or FFFFh = device does not report version
F 15:12 Transport Type
0h = Parallel
1h = Serial
2h-Fh = Reserved
Parallel Serial
11:7 Reserved Reserved
F 6 Reserved SATA 3.1
F 5 Reserved SATA 3.0
F 4 Reserved SATA 2.6
F 3 Reserved SATA 2.5
F 2 Reserved SATA II: Extensions
F 1 ATA/ATAPI-7 SATA 1.0a
F 0 ATA8-APT ATA8-AST
223 M B F Transport minor version number (see 7.12.7.85)
224..229 Reserved
230..233 O B V Extended Number of User Addressable Sectors (QWord) (see 7.12.7.87)
234 O B F Minimum number of 512-byte data blocks per Download Microcode operation
(see 7.12.7.88)
235 O B F Maximum number of 512-byte data blocks per Download Microcode operation
(see 7.12.7.89)
236..254 Reserved
255 M B V Integrity word (see 7.12.7.91)
15:8 Checksum
7:0 Checksum Validity Indicator
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial
by the device. or Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is not
defined in this standard.
Value Description
37C8h Device requires SET FEATURES subcommand to spin-up after power-up and
IDENTIFY DEVICE data is incomplete (see 4.16).
738Ch Device requires SET FEATURES subcommand to spin-up after power-up and
IDENTIFY DEVICE data is complete (see 4.16).
8C73h Device does not require SET FEATURES subcommand to spin-up after
power-up and IDENTIFY DEVICE data is incomplete (see 4.16).
C837h Device does not require SET FEATURES subcommand to spin-up after
power-up and IDENTIFY DEVICE data is complete (see 4.16).
All other values Reserved
7.12.7.5 Word 3
Word 3 is obsolete.
7.12.7.6 Words 4..5
Words 4..5 are retired.
7.12.7.7 Word 6
Word 6 is obsolete.
7.12.7.8 Words 7..8: Reserved for CFA
Words 7..8 are reserved for use by CFA (e.g., for use in CFA-CF).
7.12.7.9 Word 9
Word 9 is retired.
7.12.7.10 Words 10..19: Serial number
Words 10..19 are a copy of the SERIAL NUMBER field (see A.11.7.2).
7.12.7.11 Words 20..21
Words 20..21 are retired.
7.12.7.12 Word 22
Word 22 is obsolete.
7.12.7.13 Words 23..26: Firmware revision
Words 23..26 are a copy of the FIRMWARE REVISION field (see A.11.7.3).
7.12.7.14 Words 27..46: Model number
Words 27..46 are a copy of the MODEL NUMBER field (see A.11.7.4).
7.12.7.15 Word 47
Bits 7:0 of this word define the maximum number of logical sectors per DRQ data block that the device supports
for READ MULTIPLE commands (see 7.26), READ MULTIPLE EXT commands (see 7.27), WRITE MULTIPLE
commands (see 7.64), WRITE MULTIPLE EXT commands (see 7.65), and WRITE MULTIPLE EXT FUA
commands (see 7.66).
For SATA devices, bits 7:0 shall be set to 16 or less.
7.12.7.16 Word 48: Trusted Computing feature set options
Bit 0 of word 48 is a copy of the TRUSTED COMPUTING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.6).
7.12.7.17 Words 49..50: Capabilities
Bits 15:14 of word 49 are reserved.
If bit 13 of word 49 is set to one, then table 52 shall define the Standby timer values used by the device. If bit 13
of word 49 is cleared to zero, then the Standby timer values used by the device shall be vendor specific.
Bit 12 of word 49 is reserved for use in the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data.
For PATA devices:
a) bit 11 of word 49 is a copy of the IORDY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.1); and
b) bit 10 of word 49 is a copy of the IORDY DISABLE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.2).
For SATA devices, bits 11:10 of word 49 shall be set to 11b.
Bit 9 of word 49 shall be set to one (i.e., LBA is supported).
For PATA devices, bit 8 of word 49 is a copy of the DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.3).
For SATA devices, bit 8 of word 49 shall be set to one.
Bits 7:2 of word 49 are reserved.
Bits 1:0 of word 49 are a copy of the ALIGNMENT ERROR REPORTING field (see A.11.4.3.3).
Bit 15 of word 50 shall be cleared to zero.
Bit 14 of word 50 shall be set to one.
Bits 13:2 of word 50 are reserved.
Bit 1 of word 50 is obsolete.
If bit 0 of word 50 is set to one, the device has a minimum Standby timer value that is vendor specific. If this bit is
cleared to zero, there is no minimum Standby timer value.
7.12.7.18 Words 51..52
Words 51..52 are obsolete.
7.12.7.19 Word 53
Bit 0 of word 53 is obsolete.
For PATA devices, if bit 1 of word 53 is set to one, the values reported in words 64..70 are valid. If this bit is
cleared to zero, the values reported in words 64..70 are not valid. All devices except CFA-APT devices shall
support PIO mode 3 or above and shall set bit 1 of word 53 to one and support the fields contained in words
64..70. If Minimum PIO transfer cycle time without flow control is supported (see A.11.9.5.2), bit 1 of word 53
shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, bit 1 of word 53 shall be set to one.
For PATA devices, if the device supports Ultra DMA and the values reported in word 88 are valid, then bit 2 of
word 53 shall be set to one. If the device does not support Ultra DMA and the values reported in word 88 are not
valid, then this bit shall be cleared to zero.
For SATA devices, bit 2 of word 53 shall be set to one.
Bits 15:8 of word 53 are a copy of the FREE-FALL SENSITIVITY field (see A.11.6.9).
7.12.7.20 Words 54..58
Words 54..58 are obsolete.
7.12.7.21 Word 59
Bit 15 of word 59 is a copy of the BLOCK ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.1).
Bit 14 of word 59 is a copy of the OVERWRITE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.2).
Bit 13 of word 59 is a copy of the CRYPTO SCRAMBLE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.3).
Bit 12 of word 59 is a copy of the SANITIZE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.4).
Bit 11 of word 59 is a copy of the ACS-3 COMMANDS ALLOWED BY SANITIZE bit (see A.11.8.7.7).
Bit 10 of word 59 is a copy of the SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.5).
Bit 9 of word 59 is reserved.
If bit 8 of word 59 is set to one, then bits 7:0 indicate the number of logical sectors that shall be transferred per
DRQ data block for a READ MULTIPLE command (see 7.26), a READ MULTIPLE EXT command (see 7.27),
a WRITE MULTIPLE command (see 7.64), a WRITE MULTIPLE EXT command (see 7.65), and a WRITE
MULTIPLE EXT FUA commands (see 7.66). The default setting of this field is the optimum value for the device
or zero (see 7.46).
7.12.7.22 Words 60..61: Total number of user addressable logical sectors for 28-bit commands
Words 60..61 contain a value that is one greater than the maximum user addressable LBA. The maximum value
that shall be placed in this field is 0FFF_FFFFh. If words 60..61 contain 0FFF_FFFFh and the device has user
addressable LBAs greater than or equal to 0FFF_FFFFh, then the ACCESSIBLE CAPACITY field (see A.11.4.2)
contains the total number of user addressable LBAs (see 4.1).
7.12.7.23 Word 62
Word 62 is obsolete.
7.12.7.24 Word 63
Bits 15:11 of word 63 are reserved.
Bit 10 of word 63 shall have the content described for the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.2).
Bit 9 of word 63 shall have the content described for the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.3).
Bit 8 of word 63 shall have the content described for the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.4).
Bits 7:3 of word 63 are reserved.
For PATA devices:
a) bit 2 of word 63 is a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.5);
b) bit 1 of word 63 is a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.6); and
c) bit 0 of word 63 is a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.7).
For SATA devices, bits 2:0 of word 63 shall be set to 111b.
7.12.7.25 Word 64
Bits 15:2 of word 64 are reserved.
For PATA devices:
a) bit 1 of word 64 is a copy of the PIO MODE 4 IS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.3.1); and
b) bit 0 of word 64 is a copy of the PIO MODE 3 IS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.3.2).
For SATA devices, bits 1:0 of word 64 shall be set to 11b.
7.12.7.26 Word 65: Minimum Multiword DMA transfer cycle time per word
For PATA devices, word 65 is a copy the MIN MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field (see A.11.9.4.2).
For SATA devices, word 65 shall be set to 0078h.
7.12.7.27 Word 66: Manufacturer’s recommended Multiword DMA transfer cycle time
For PATA devices, word 66 is a copy the RECOMMENDED MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field (see A.11.9.4.1).
For SATA devices, word 66 shall be set to 0078h.
7.12.7.28 Word 67: Minimum PIO transfer cycle time without IORDY flow control
For PATA devices, word 67 is a copy of the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY field (see A.11.9.5.2).
For SATA devices, word 67 shall be set to 0078h.
7.12.7.29 Word 68: Minimum PIO transfer cycle time with IORDY flow control
For PATA devices, word 68 is a copy of the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field (see A.11.9.5.1).
For SATA devices, word 68 shall be set to 0078h.
7.12.7.30 Word 69: Additional Supported
Word 69 shall indicate features, feature sets, or commands that are supported. If a defined bit is cleared to zero,
the indicated feature, feature set or command is not supported. Feature sets and commands for which bits in
word 69 indicate support do not include a mechanism to disable them.
Bit 15 of word 69 is reserved for CFA (e.g., for use in CFast).
Bit 14 of word 69 is a copy of the DRAT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.2).
Bit 13 of word 69 is a copy of the LPS MISALIGNMENT REPORTING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.3).
Bit 12 of word 69 is obsolete.
Bit 11 of word 69 is a copy of the READ BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.4).
Bit 10 of word 69 is a copy of the WRITE BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.5).
Bit 9 of word 69 is obsolete.
Bit 8 of word 69 is a copy of the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6).
Bit 7 is reserved for IEEE 1667.
Bit 6 of word 69 is a copy of the 28-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.7).
Bit 5 of word 69 is a copy of the RZAT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.8).
Bit 4 of word 69 is a copy of the ENCRYPT ALL SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.7.6).
If word 69 bit 3 is set to one, then words 230..233 (see 7.12.7.87) are valid. If word 69 bit 3 is cleared to zero,
then words 230..233 (see 7.12.7.87) are reserved.
Bit 2 of word 69 is a copy of the NON-VOLATILE WRITE CACHE bit (see A.11.6.2.7).
Bits 2:0 of word 69 are reserved.
7.12.7.31 Word 70
Word 70 is reserved.
7.12.7.32 Words 71..74: Reserved for ATAPI
Words 71..74 are reserved for ATAPI.
7.12.7.33 Word 75: Queue depth
Bits 4:0 of word 75 indicate the maximum queue depth supported by the device. The queue depth includes all
commands for which command acceptance has occurred and command completion has not occurred. The value
in bits 4:0 of word 75 shall be set to one less than the maximum queue depth (e.g., a value of zero in bits 4:0 of
word 75 indicates a queue depth of one, and a value of 31 in bits 4:0 of word 75 indicates a queue depth of 32).
If bit 6 of word 76 is cleared to zero indicating that the device does not support NCQ feature set commands, then
the value in bits 4:0 of word 75 shall be zero. Support of this word is mandatory if the NCQ feature set is
supported.
7.12.7.34 Word 76: Serial ATA Capabilities
Word 76 indicates the capabilities of a SATA device. A PATA device shall set word 76 to 0000h or FFFFh. If word
76 is set to 0000h or FFFFh, then the device does not claim compliance with the Serial ATA specification and
words 76..79 are not valid and shall be ignored.
If word 76 is not set to 0000h or FFFFh, then the device claims compliance with the Serial ATA specification, and
words 77..79 shall be valid.
Bit 15 of word 76 is a copy of the READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.11).
Bit 14 of word 76 is a copy of the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.10).
Bit 13 of word 76 is a copy of the HOST AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.9).
Bit 12 of word 76 is a copy of the NCQ PRIORITY INFORMATION SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.8).
Bit 11 of word 76 is a copy of the UNLOAD WHILE NCQ COMMANDS ARE OUTSTANDING SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.7).
Bit 10 of word 76 is a copy of the SATA PHY EVENT COUNTERS LOG SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.6).
Bit 9 of word 76 is a copy of the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.5).
Bit 8 of word 76 is a copy of the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4).
Bits 7:4 of word 76 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 3 of word 76 is a copy of the SATA GEN3 SIGNALING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.3).
Bit 2 of word 76 is a copy of the SATA GEN2 SIGNALING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.2).
Bit 1 of word 76 is a copy of the SATA GEN1 SIGNALING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.1).
Bit 0 of word 76 shall be cleared to zero.
7.12.7.35 Word 77: Serial ATA Additional Capabilities
Word 77 reports additional capabilities supported by the device. Support for this word is optional and if not
supported, the word shall be zero indicating the device has no support for additional Serial ATA capabilities.
Bits 15:7 of word 77 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 6 of word 77 is a copy of the SEND AND RECEIVE QUEUED COMMANDS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.14).
Bit 5 of word 77 is a copy of the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT COMMAND SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.13).
Bit 4 of word 77 is a copy of the NCQ STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.12).
Bits 3:1 of word 77 are a copy of the CURRENT SERIAL ATA SIGNAL SPEED field (see A.11.10.2.21).
Bit 0 of word 77 shall be cleared to zero.
7.12.7.36 Word 78: Serial ATA features supported
If word 76 is not 0000h or FFFFh, word 78 reports the features supported by the device. If this word is not
supported the word shall be cleared to zero.
Bits 15:8 of word 78 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 7 of word 78 is a copy of the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.21).
Bit 6 of word 78 is a copy of the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.20).
Bit 5 of word 78 is a copy of the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.19).
Bit 4 of word 78 is a copy of the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.18).
Bit 3 of word 78 is a copy of the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.17).
Bit 2 of word 78 is a copy of the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.16).
Bit 1 of word 78 is a copy of the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.15).
Bit 0 of word 78 shall be cleared to zero.
7.12.7.37 Word 79: Serial ATA features enabled
If word 76 is not 0000h or FFFFh, word 79 reports which features supported by the device are enabled. This
word shall be supported if word 78 is supported and shall not be supported if word 78 is not supported.
Bits 15:8 of word 79 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 7 of word 79 is a copy of the AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.8).
Bit 6 of word 79 is a copy of the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.7).
Bit 5 of word 79 is a copy of the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IS ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.6).
Bit 4 of word 79 is a copy of the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.5).
Bit 3 of word 79 is a copy of the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.4).
Bit 2 of word 79 is a copy of the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.3).
Bit 1 of word 79 is a copy of the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.2).
Bit 0 of word 79 shall be cleared to zero.
7.12.7.38 Word 80: Major version number
If word 80 is not set to 0000h or FFFFh, then the device claims compliance with the major version(s) as indicated
by bits 10:5 being set to one. Values other than 0000h and FFFFh are bit significant. A device may set more than
one bit.
7.12.7.39 Word 81: Minor version number
Table 47 defines the value that shall be reported in word 81 to indicate the version of the standard that guided the
implementation.
7.12.7.41 Words 85..87, 120: Commands and feature sets supported or enabled
Words 85..87 and 120 indicate features, feature sets, or commands enabled. If a defined bit is cleared to zero,
the indicated feature, feature set, or command is not enabled. If a supported feature or feature set is supported
and there is no defined method to disable the feature or feature set, then it is defined as supported and the bit
shall be set to one.
If bit 14 of word 87 is set to one and bit 15 of word 87 is cleared to zero, then the contents of words 85..87 contain
valid information. Otherwise, the information is not valid in words 85..87.
If bit 15 of word 86 is set to one, bit 14 of word 120 is set to one, and bit 15 of word 120 is cleared to zero, then
the contents of word 120 contain valid information. Otherwise, the information is not valid in word 120.
Bit 14 of word 85 is a copy of bit 14 of word 82.
Bit 13 of word 85 is a copy of bit 13 of word 82.
Bit 12 of word 85 is a copy of bit 12 of word 82.
Bit 10 of word 85 is a copy of bit 10 of word 82.
Bit 9 of word 85 shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the DEVICE RESET command is not supported).
Bits 8:7 of word 85 are obsolete.
bit 6 of word 85 is a copy of the READ LOOK-AHEAD ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.8).
bit 5 of word 85 is a copy of the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.4).
Bit 4 of word 85 is a copy of bit 4 of word 82.
Bit 3 of word 85 is a copy of bit 3 of word 82.
Bit 1 of word 85 is a copy of bit 1 in word 128.
Bit 0 of word 85 is a copy of the SMART ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.9).
If bit 15 of word 86 is set to one, bit 14 of word 119 is set to one, and bit 15 of word 119 is cleared to zero, then
word 119 is valid. If bit 15 of word 86 is set to one, bit 14 of word 120 is set to one, and bit 15 of word 120 is
cleared to zero, then word 120 is valid.
Bit 14 of word 86 is reserved.
Bit 13 of word 86 is a copy of bit 13 of word 83.
Bit 12 of word 86 is a copy of bit 12 of word 83.
Bit 11 of word 86 is obsolete.
Bit 10 of word 86 is a copy of bit 10 of word 83.
Bits 9:8 of word 86 are obsolete.
Bit 7 of word 86 is obsolete.
Bit 6 of word 86 is a copy of bit 6 of word 83.
Bit 5 of word 86 is a copy of the PUIS ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.10).
Bit 3 of word 86 is a copy of the APM ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.11)
Bit 2 of word 86 is reserved for CFA (e.g., for use in CFA-CF).
Bit 1 of word 86 is obsolete.
Bit 0 of word 86 is a copy of bit 0 of word 83.
Bit 13 of word 87 is a copy of bit 13 of word 84.
Bits 12:11 of word 87 are obsolete.
Bits 10:9 of word 84 are obsolete.
7.12.7.43 Word 89
Word 89 is a copy of the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see A.11.8.5).
7.12.7.44 Word 90
Word 90 is a copy of the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see A.11.8.4).
7.12.7.45 Word 91: Current advanced power management level value
Bits 15:8 of word 91 are reserved.
Bits 7:0 of word 91 are a copy of the APM LEVEL field (see A.11.6.3.2).
7.12.7.46 Word 92: Master Password Identifier
Word 92 is a copy of the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.8.2).
7.12.7.47 Word 93: Hardware reset results
For PATA devices, if bit 14 of word 93 is set to one and bit 15 of word 93 is cleared to zero, then the content of
word 93 contains valid information.
Bit 13 of word 93 is a copy of the CBLID bit (see A.11.9.2.6.1).
Bit 12 of word 93 is reserved.
Bit 11 of word 93 is a copy of the D1 PDIAG bit (see A.11.9.2.6.2).
Bits 10:9 of word 93 are a copy of the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see A.11.9.2.6.3).
Bit 8 of word 93 shall be set to one for a PATA device.
Bit 7 of word 93 is reserved.
Bit 6 of word 93 is a copy of the D0/D1 SELECTION bit (see A.11.9.2.6.6),
Bit 5 of word 93 is a copy of the D0 DASP bit (see A.11.9.2.6.5).
Bit 4 of word 93 is a copy of the D0 PDIAG bit (see A.11.9.2.6.4).
Bit 3 of word 93 is a copy of the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit (see A.11.9.2.6.7).
Bits 2:1 of word 93 are a copy of the D0 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see A.11.9.2.6.8).
Bit 0 of word 93 shall be set to one for a PATA device.
For SATA devices, word 93 shall be set to the value 0000h.
7.12.7.48 Word 94
Word 94 is obsolete.
7.12.7.49 Word 95: Stream Minimum Request Size
Word 95 is a copy of the STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field (see A.11.6.6).
7.12.7.50 Word 96: Streaming Transfer Time – DMA
Word 96 is a copy of the DMA SECTOR TIME field (see A.11.6.4).
7.12.7.51 Word 97: Streaming Access Latency – DMA and PIO
Word 97 is a copy of the STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field (see A.11.6.7).
7.12.7.52 Words 98..99: Streaming Performance Granularity
Words 98..99 are a copy of the STREAM GRANULARITY field (see A.11.6.8).
If bit 2 of word 206 is set to one, then the device supports SCT Write Same (see 8.3.2).
Bit 1 of word 206 is obsolete.
If bit 0 of word 206 is set to one, then the device supports the SCT Command Transport including SCT Read
Status (see clause 8).
7.12.7.75 Word 209: Alignment of logical blocks within a physical block
Word 209 indicates the location of logical sector zero within the first physical sector of the media. See Annex D
for more information. Word 209 is valid if the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.4.3.1) is set to one.
Bit 15 of word 209 shall be cleared to zero.
Bit 14 of word 209 shall be set to one.
Bits 13:0 of word 209 are a copy of the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see A.11.4.3.5).
7.12.7.76 Words 210..211: Write-Read-Verify Sector Mode 3 Count
Words 210..211 are a copy of the WRV MODE 3 COUNT field (see A.11.5.6).
7.12.7.77 Words 212..213: Write-Read-Verify Sector Mode 2 Count
Words 212..213 are a copy of the WRV MODE 2 COUNT field (see A.11.5.7).
7.12.7.78 Words 214..216
Words 214..216 are obsolete.
7.12.7.79 Word 217: Nominal media rotation rate
Word 217 is a copy of the NOMINAL MEDIA ROTATION RATE field (see A.11.5.4).
7.12.7.80 Word 218
Word 218 is reserved.
7.12.7.81 Word 219
Word 219 is obsolete.
7.12.7.82 Word 220
Bits 15:8 of word 220 are reserved.
Bits 7:0 of word 220 are a copy of the WRV MODE field (see A.11.6.3.3).
7.12.7.83 Word 221
Word 221: reserved
7.12.7.84 Word 222: Transport major version number
If word 222 is not set to FFFFh or 0000h, then the device claims compliance with one or more of the ATA
transport standard major versions as indicated by bits 11:0. Bits 15:12 indicate the transport type. Values other
than 0000h and FFFFh are bit significant. A device may set more than one bit to one.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 9 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
O S F
Word M P V Description
0 M B General configuration
F 15:14 10b = ATAPI device
F 11b = Reserved
13 Reserved
F 12:8 Indicates command set used by the device
X 7 Obsolete
F 6:5 00b = Device shall set DRQ to one within 3 ms of receiving PACKET
command.
01b = Obsolete.
10b = Device shall set DRQ to one within 50 s of receiving PACKET
command.
11b = Reserved
4:3 Reserved
V 2 Incomplete response
F 1:0 00b = 12 byte command packet
01b = 16 byte command packet
1xb = Reserved
1 Reserved
2 B V Specific configuration
3..9 Reserved
10..19 M B F Serial number (ATA String)
20..22 Reserved
23..26 M B F Firmware revision (ATA String)
27..46 M B F Model number (ATA String)
47..48 Reserved
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
49 M Capabilities
X 15:12 Obsolete
P F 11 1 = IORDY supported
P F 10 1 = IORDY may be disabled
F 9 Shall be set to one.
P F 8 1 = DMA supported. Devices that require the DMADIR bit in the PACKET
command (see 7.18) shall clear this bit to 0
X 7:0 Vendor specific
50 O Capabilities
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero.
F 14 Shall be set to one.
13:2 Reserved
X 1 Obsolete
B F 0 Shall be set to one to indicate a device specific Standby timer value
minimum.
51..52 X Obsolete
53 M 15:3 Reserved
B F 2 1 = the fields reported in word 88 are valid
B F 1 1 = the fields reported in words 64..70 are valid
X 0 Obsolete
54..61 Reserved
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
62 M DMA information (see 7.13.6.17)
S F 15 1 = DMADIR bit in the PACKET command (see 7.18) is required for DMA
transfers
0 = DMADIR bit in PACKET command is not required for DMA transfers.
14:11 Reserved
P F 10 1 = DMA is supported
P F 9 1 = Multiword DMA mode 2 is supported
P F 8 1 = Multiword DMA mode 1 is supported
P F 7 1 = Multiword DMA mode 0 is supported
P F 6 1 = Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are supported
P F 5 1 = Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are supported
P F 4 1 = Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are supported
P F 3 1 = Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are supported
P F 2 1 = Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are supported
P F 1 1 = Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are supported
P F 0 1 = Ultra DMA mode 0 is supported
63 M 15:11 Reserved
P V 10 1 = Multiword DMA mode 2 is selected
P V 9 1 = Multiword DMA mode 1 is selected
P V 8 1 = Multiword DMA mode 0 is selected
7:3 Reserved
P F 2 1 = Multiword DMA mode 2 and below are supported.
P F 1 1 = Multiword DMA mode 1 and below are supported.
P F 0 1 = Multiword DMA mode 0 is supported Multiword DMA mode selected.
64 M 15:8 Reserved
P F 7:0 PIO transfer modes supported
65 M Minimum Multiword DMA transfer cycle time per word
P F 15:0 Cycle time in nanoseconds
66 M Manufacturer’s recommended Multiword DMA transfer cycle time
P F 15:0 Cycle time in nanoseconds
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
67 M Minimum PIO transfer cycle time without flow control
P F 15:0 Cycle time in nanoseconds
68 M Minimum PIO transfer cycle time with IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control
P F 15:0 Cycle time in nanoseconds
69..70 Reserved
71..72 X Obsolete
73..74 Reserved
75 X Obsolete
76 O S Serial ATA Capabilities
15 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 14 1 = Supports Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions
F 13 1 = Supports Host Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions
12:11 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 10 1 = The SATA Phy Event Counters log is supported
F 9 1 = Receipt of host initiated power management requests are supported
8:4 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 3 1 = The SATA Gen3 Signaling Speed (6.0Gb/s) is supported
F 2 1 = The SATA Gen2 Signaling Speed (3.0Gb/s) is supported
F 1 1 = The SATA Gen1 Signaling Speed (1.5Gb/s) is supported
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
77 O S Serial ATA Additional Capabilities
15:6 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 5 1 = Supports host environment detect
F 4 1 = Supports Device Attention on slimline connected device
V 3:1 Coded value indicating current negotiated Serial ATA signal speed
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
78 O S Serial ATA features supported
15:7 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 6 1 = The SSP feature set is supported
F 5 1 = Asynchronous notification supported
4 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 3 1 = Device initiated power management is supported
2:1 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
79 O S Serial ATA features enabled
15:7 Reserved for Serial ATA
V 6 1 = The SSP feature set is enabled
V 5 1 = Asynchronous notification enabled
4 Reserved for Serial ATA
V 3 1 = Device initiated power management is enabled
2:1 Reserved for Serial ATA
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero
80 M B Major version number
0000h or FFFFh = device does not report version
15:11 Reserved
B F 10 supports ACS-3
B F 9 supports ACS-2
F 8 1 = ATA8-ACS is supported
F 7 1 = ATA/ATAPI-7 is supported
F 6 1 = ATA/ATAPI-6 is supported
F 5 1 = ATA/ATAPI-5 is supported
F 4 Obsolete
X 3 Obsolete
X 2 Obsolete
X 1 Obsolete
0 Reserved
81 M B F Minor version number
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
82 M B Commands and feature sets supported
X 15 Obsolete
F 14 Shall be set to one (i.e., the NOP command is supported)
F 13 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the READ BUFFER command is not supported)
F 12 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the WRITE BUFFER command is not
supported)
X 11 Obsolete
F 10 Obsolete
F 9 Shall be set to one (i.e., the DEVICE RESET command is supported)
X 8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
F 6 1 = Read look-ahead supported
F 5 1 = The volatile write cache is supported
F 4 Shall be set to one indicating the PACKET feature set is supported.
F 3 1 = The Power Management feature set supported
X 2 Obsolete
X 1 Obsolete
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the SMART feature set is not supported)
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
83 M B Commands and feature sets supported
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
F 14 Shall be set to one
13 Reserved
F 12 1 = The FLUSH CACHE command is supported
F 11 Obsolete
10 Reserved
F 9:8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
F 6 1 = The SET FEATURES subcommand is required to spin-up after power-up
F 5 1 = The PUIS feature set is supported
X 4 Obsolete
F 3 1 = The APM feature set is supported
2:1 Reserved
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is
not supported)
84 M B Commands and feature sets supported
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
F 14 Shall be set to one
13:9 Reserved
F 8 shall be set to one (i.e., the WWN is supported)
7:6 Reserved
F 5 1 = The GPL feature set is supported
4:0 Reserved
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
85 M B Commands and feature sets supported or enabled
X 15 Obsolete
F 14 Shall be set to one (i.e., the NOP command is supported)
F 13 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the READ BUFFER command is not supported)
F 12 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the WRITE BUFFER command is not
supported)
X 11 Obsolete
V 10 Obsolete
F 9 Shall be set to one (i.e., the DEVICE RESET command is supported)
X 8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
V 6 1 = Read look-ahead is enabled
V 5 1 = The volatile write cache is enabled
F 4 Shall be set to one indicating the PACKET feature set is supported.
F 3 1 = Power Management feature set is enabled
X 2 Obsolete
X 1 Obsolete
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the SMART feature set is not supported)
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
86 M B Commands and feature sets supported or enabled
15:13 Reserved
V 12 1 = The FLUSH CACHE command is supported
F 11 Obsolete
10 Reserved
V 9:8 Obsolete
X 7 Obsolete
F 6 1 = SET FEATURES subcommand required to spin-up after power-up
V 5 1 = The PUIS feature set is enabled
X 4 Obsolete
V 3 1 = The APM feature set is enabled
2:1 Reserved
F 0 Shall be cleared to zero (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is
not supported)
87 M Commands and feature sets supported or enabled
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero
F 14 Shall be set to one
13:9 Reserved
F 8 Shall be set to one (i.e., the WWN is supported)
7:6 Reserved
F 5 This bit is a copy of word 84 bit 5
4:0 Reserved
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
88 M B Ultra DMA modes
15 Reserved
V 14 1 = Ultra DMA mode 6 is selected.
V 13 1 = Ultra DMA mode 5 is selected.
V 12 1 = Ultra DMA mode 4 is selected.
V 11 1 = Ultra DMA mode 3 is selected.
V 10 1 = Ultra DMA mode 2 is selected.
V 9 1 = Ultra DMA mode 1 is selected.
V 8 1 = Ultra DMA mode 0 is selected.
7 Reserved
F 6 1 = Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are supported.
F 5 1 = Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are supported.
F 4 1 = Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are supported.
F 3 1 = Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are supported.
F 2 1 = Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are supported.
F 1 1 = Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are supported.
F 0 1 = Ultra DMA mode 0 is supported.
89 O B F Time required for Normal Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT command
90 O B F Time required for an Enhanced Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT command
91 O B V Current APM level value (see 7.13.6.39)
92 O B V Master Password Identifier
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
93 M B Hardware reset result.
The contents of bits 12:0 of this word shall change only during the processing of a
hardware reset.
F 15 Shall be cleared to zero.
F 14 Shall be set to one.
V 13 1 = device detected CBLID- (see ATA8-APT) above ViHB
0 = device detected CBLID- (see ATA8-APT) below ViLB
12:8 Device 1 hardware reset result. Device 0 shall clear these bits to zero. Device
1 shall set these bits as follows:
12 Reserved.
V 11 0 = Device 1 did not assert PDIAG-.
1 = Device 1 asserted PDIAG-.
V 10:9 These bits indicate how Device 1 determined the device number:
00b = Reserved.
01b = a jumper was used.
10b = the CSEL signal was used.
11b = some other method was used or the method is unknown.
F 8 Shall be set to one.
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
93 7:0 Device 0 hardware reset result. Device 1 shall clear these bits to zero. Device
(cont.) 0 shall set these bits as follows:
7 Reserved
F 6 0 = Device 0 does not respond when Device 1 is selected.
1 = Device 0 responds when Device 1 is selected.
V 5 0 = Device 0 did not detect the assertion of DASP-.
1 = Device 0 detected the assertion of DASP-.
V 4 0 = Device 0 did not detect the assertion of PDIAG-.
1 = Device 0 detected the assertion of PDIAG-.
V 3 0 = Device 0 failed diagnostics.
1 = Device 0 passed diagnostics.
V 2:1 These bits indicate how Device 0 determined the device number:
00b = Reserved.
01b = a jumper was used.
10b = the CSEL signal was used.
11b = some other method was used or the method is unknown.
F 0 Shall be set to one.
94 Obsolete
95..107 Reserved
108..111 M B F World wide name
112..115 Reserved for world wide name extension to 128 bits
116..118 Reserved
119 Commands and feature sets supported
15:0 Reserved
120 Commands and feature sets supported or enabled
15:0 Reserved
121..125 Reserved
125 M B F ATAPI byte count = 0 behavior
126..127 X Obsolete
128 X Obsolete
129..159 X Vendor specific
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
O S F
Word M P V Description
160..175 Reserved for CFA
176..221 Reserved
222 M B Transport Major version number. 0000h or FFFFh = device does not report version
F 15:12 Transport Type
0h = Parallel
1h = Serial
2h-Fh = Reserved
Parallel Serial
11:7 Reserved Reserved
F 6 Reserved SATA 3.1
F 5 Reserved SATA 3.0
F 4 Reserved SATA 2.6
F 3 Reserved SATA 2.5
F 2 Reserved SATA II: Extensions
F 1 ATA/ATAPI-7 SATA 1.0a
F 0 ATA8-APT ATA8-AST
223 M B F Transport Minor version number
224..254 Reserved
255 O B V Integrity word
15:8 Checksum
7:0 Checksum Validity Indicator
Key: O/M – Mandatory/optional requirement.
F/V – Fixed/variable content M – Support of the word is mandatory.
F – The content of the field does not change O – Support of the word is optional.
except following a download microcode S/P – Content applies to Serial or Parallel transport
or power-on reset. S – Serial Transport
V – The contents of the field is variable and P – Parallel Transport
may change depending on the state of B – Both Serial and Parallel Transports
the device or the commands processed N – Belongs to a transport other than Serial or
by the device. Parallel
X – The fixed or variable type of this field is
not defined in this standard.
is 3 ms. The value 01b is obsolete. A value of 10b indicates that the maximum time for a device to set DRQ to
one after receiving a PACKET command is 50 µs. The value 11b is reserved.
If bit 2 of word 0 is set to one, then the content of the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data is incomplete (e.g., the
device supports the Power-up In Standby feature set and required data is contained on the device media
(see 4.16)).
Bits 1:0 of word 0 indicate the packet size the device supports. A value of 00b indicates that a 12-byte packet is
supported and a value of 01b indicates a 16 byte packet. The values 10b and 11b are reserved.
The content of IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data word 0 shall be valid.
7.13.6.3 Word 1
Word 1 is reserved.
7.13.6.4 Word 2: Specific configuration
Word 2 shall have the same content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 2 (see 7.12.7.4). The content of
IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data word 2 shall be valid.
7.13.6.5 Words 3..9
Words 3..9 are reserved.
7.13.6.6 Words 10..19: Serial number
If the ATAPI device does not report the serial number, then the content of these words shall be 0000h in each
word. Otherwise, the content of these words shall be as described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 10..19
(see 7.12.7).
7.13.6.7 Words 20..22
Words 20..22 are reserved.
7.13.6.8 Words 23..26: Firmware revision
Words 23..26 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 23..26 (see 7.12.7.13).
7.13.6.9 Words 27..46: Model number
Words 27..46 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data words 27..46 (see 7.12.7.14).
7.13.6.10 Words 47..48
Words 47..48 are reserved.
7.13.6.11 Word 49: Capabilities
Bits 15:12 of word 49 are obsolete.
Bit 11 of word 49 indicates whether a device supports IORDY (see ATA8-APT). If bit 11 of word 49 is set to one,
then the device supports IORDY operation. If bit 11 of word 49 is cleared to zero, the device may support IORDY
operation. If a device supports PIO mode 3 or higher, then bit 11 of word 49 shall be set to one. For SATA
devices, bit 11 of word 49 shall be set to one.
Bit 10 of word 49 indicates a device’s ability to enable or disable the use of IORDY (see ATA8-APT). If bit 10 of
word 49 is set to one, then the device supports the disabling of IORDY. Disabling and enabling of IORDY is
accomplished using the SET FEATURES command. For SATA devices, bit 10 of word 49 shall be set to one.
Bit 9 of word 49 shall be set to one.
Bit 8 of word 49 indicates that DMA is supported. Devices that require the DMADIR bit in the PACKET command
(see 7.18) shall clear bit 8 of word 49 to 0
7.13.6.12 Word 50: Capabilities
Word 50 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 50 (see 7.12.7.17). Support of this
word is mandatory if the STANDBY command is supported.
7.13.6.13 Word 51
Word 51 is obsolete.
7.13.6.14 Word 52
Word 52 is obsolete.
7.13.6.15 Word 53
Word 53 bits 2:0 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 53 bits 2:0. Bits 15:3 are
reserved.
7.13.6.16 Words 54..61
Words 54..61 are reserved.
7.13.6.17 Word 62: DMA information
ATAPI devices may require use of the DMADIR bit to indicate transfer direction for PACKET commands (see 7.18)
using the DMA data transfer protocol. Word 62 indicates if such support is required.
If word 62 bit 15 is set to one, then the DMADIR bit in the PACKET command is required by the device for PACKET
commands using the DMA data transfer protocol and the following bits in the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data
shall be cleared to zero:
a) word 63 bits 2:0;
b) word 49 bit 15;
c) word 49 bit 8; and
d) word 88 bits 6:0.
If word 62 bit 15 is cleared to zero, then:
a) the DMADIR bit in the PACKET command is not required; and
b) word 62 shall be cleared to zero.
Bits 14:11 of word 62 are reserved.
If word 62 bit 15 is set to one and word 62 bit:
a) 10 is set to one, then DMA is supported;
b) 10 is cleared to zero, then DMA is not supported;
c) 9 is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 2 is supported;
d) 9 is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 2 is not supported;
e) 8 is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 1 is supported;
f) 8 is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 1 is not supported;
g) 7 is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 0 is supported;
h) 7 is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 0 is not supported;
i) 6 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are supported;
j) 6 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are not supported;
k) 5 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are supported;
l) 5 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are not supported;
m) 4 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are supported;
n) 4 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are not supported;
o) 3 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are supported;
p) 3 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are not supported;
q) 2 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are supported;
r) 2 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are not supported;
s) 1 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are supported;
t) 1 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are not supported;
u) 0 is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is supported; and
v) 0 is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is not supported.
7.13.6.27 Word 75
Word 75 is obsolete.
7.13.6.28 Word 76: Serial ATA Capabilities
Bits 15 of word 76 is reserved for Serial ATA.
Bits 14:13 of word 76 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 bits 14:13
(see 7.12.7.34).
Bits 12:11 of word 76 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bits 10:9 of word 76 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 bits 10:9
(see 7.12.7.34).
Bits 8:4 of word 76 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bits 3:1 of word 76 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 bits 3:1 (see 7.12.7.34).
Bit 0 of word 76 shall be cleared to zero.
7.13.6.29 Word 77: Serial ATA Additional Capabilities
Bits 15:6 of word 77 are reserved for Serial ATA.
If bit 5 of word 77 is set to one, then the device supports the ability to detect whether or not the device is in a
manufacturing test or PC application environment (see SATA 3.1).
If bit 4 of word 77 is set to one, then the device supports the Device Attention capability in the slimline connector.
If the device does not use the slimline connector (see SATA 3.1), then the device shall clear this bit to zero.
Bits 3:1 of word 77 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 77 bits 3:1 (see 7.12.7.35)
Bit 0 of word 77 shall be cleared to zero.
7.13.6.30 Word 78: Serial ATA features supported
Bits 15:7 of word 78 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 6 of word 78 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 78 bit 6 (see 7.12.7.36).
If bit 5 of word 78 is set to one, then the device shall support initiating notification events. If bit 5 of word 78 is
cleared to zero, then the device shall not support initiating notification events (See SATA 3.1).
Bit 4 is reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 3 of word 78 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 78 bit 3 (see 7.12.7.36).
Bits 2:1 of word 78 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 0 of word 78 shall be cleared to zero.
7.13.6.31 Word 79: Serial ATA features enabled
Bits 15:7 of word 79 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 6 of word 79 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 79 bit 6 (see 7.12.7.37).
Bit 5 of word 79 indicates whether device support for asynchronous notification to indicate to the host that
attention is required is enabled (see SATA 3.1). If this bit is set to one, the device may initiate notification events
(e.g., a media change). If this bit is cleared to zero, the device shall not initiate notification events. This bit shall
be cleared to zero by default.
Bit 4 of word 79 is reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 3 of word 79 shall have the content described for IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 79 bit 3 (see 7.12.7.37).
Bits 2:1 of word 79 are reserved for Serial ATA.
Bit 0 of word 79 shall be cleared to zero.
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT Standby timer period (see table 52)
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A except when the Unload feature is requested, see 7.15.4
COUNT N/A except when the Unload feature is requested, see 7.15.4
LBA N/A except when the Unload feature is requested, see 7.15.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 44h
COUNT 00h
LBA 055_4E4Ch
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7:4 Subcommand specific
3:0 SUBCOMMAND field – See 7.16.3.2
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13:8 Reserved
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:3 Subcommand specific
2:0 Reserved
7.16.3.2 Subcommand
Table 56 defines the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT subcommands.
7.16.8.3 Inputs
7.16.8.3.1 Overview
See table 57 for the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7:4 ABORT TYPE field – See 7.16.8.3.2
3:0 Subcommand field – shall be set to 0h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13:8 Reserved
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:3 TTAG field – See 7.16.8.3.3
2:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 Shall be set to one
5 Reserved
4 Shall be cleared to zero
3:0 Reserved
7.16.9.3 Inputs
7.16.9.3.1 Overview
See table 59 for the DEADLINE HANDLING command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:6 Reserved
5 RDNC bit – See 7.16.9.3.3
4 WDNC bit – See 7.16.9.3.2
3:0 Subcommand (1h)
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13:8 Reserved
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:3 TTAG field – See SATA 3.1
2:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 Shall be set to one
5 Reserved
4 Shall be cleared to zero
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Subcommand Code (see table 61)
COUNT Value to be returned in the error outputs (see table 234)
LBA Value to be returned in the error outputs (see table 234)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Subcommand
Code Description Action
00h NOP Return command aborted.
01h..FFh Obsolete
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
7:3 Reserved
2 DMADIR bit – See 7.18.4
1 Obsolete
0 DMA bit – See 7.18.4
COUNT
Bit Description
7:3 Obsolete
2:0 N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 BYTE COUNT LIMIT field – See 7.18.5
7:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 10 — The amount of data transferred by this command is specified in the SCSI CDB.
If the transfer is to be in PIO mode, the byte count of the data to be transferred for this DRQ data block shall be:
a) not equal to zero;
b) less than or equal to the value in the BYTE COUNT LIMIT field received from the host;
c) less than or equal to FFFEh; and
d) even if this is not the last transfer of a command.
If this is the last transfer for a command in PIO mode, the byte count for the DRQ data block may be odd. If the
byte count for the DRQ data block is odd, the last byte transferred shall be a pad byte (i.e., to make the total
number of bytes transferred be even). The value of the pad byte is undefined.
7.18.6.3 Normal command completion
If the device has returned command completion without an error, the device returns the data structure found in
table 208. The INPUT/OUTPUT bit shall be set to one, and the COMMAND/DATA bit shall be set to one. The BYTE
COUNT field is reserved at command completion.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 11 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13:8 Reserved
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE If not defined by the log (see A.1) specified by the LOG ADDRESS field, this field is reserved.
COUNT LOG PAGE COUNT field – See 7.24.3.2
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 PAGE NUMBER field (15:8) – See 7.24.3.4.
31:16 Reserved
15:8 PAGE NUMBER field (7:0) – See 7.24.3.4.
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – See 7.24.3.3.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 12 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE If not defined by the log (see A.1) specified by the LOG ADDRESS field, this field is reserved.
COUNT Block Count – See 7.24.3.2
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 PAGE NUMBER field (15:8) – See 7.24.3.4.
31:16 Reserved
15:8 PAGE NUMBER field (7:0) – See 7.24.3.4.
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – See 7.24.3.3.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 13 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 14 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.28.4 Outputs
7.28.5 Normal Outputs
See table 202.
7.28.6 Outputs for ATAPI feature set devices
In response to this command, an ATAPI device shall report command aborted and place the ATAPI device
signature in the LBA field. See table 206 for the list of signatures.
7.28.7 Error Outputs
The validity of the data transferred is indeterminate. A device may return command completion with the ERROR bit
set to one if an Interface CRC error has occurred. See table 227.
NOTE 15 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 16 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 COMMAND CCTL field – See 7.30.3.2
7 Obsolete
6 READ CONTINUOUS bit – See 7.30.3.3
5 NOT SEQUENTIAL bit – See 7.30.3.4
4 Obsolete
3 Reserved
2:0 STREAM ID field – See 7.30.3.5
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
device shall return command completion within the time specified by the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3.4).
The result is vendor specific if:
a) the COMMAND CCTL field is cleared to zero, and the DEFAULT CCTL field was cleared to zero in the most
recent CONFIGURE STREAM command (see 7.4) for the stream specified by the STREAM ID field; or
b) the COMMAND CCTL field is cleared to zero and no previous CONFIGURE STREAM command was used
to specify a default CCTL for the stream specified by the STREAM ID field.
7.30.3.3 READ CONTINUOUS bit
If the READ CONTINUOUS bit is set to one, then:
a) the device shall not stop processing the command due to errors associated with reading the media;
b) if an error occurs during data transfer, while reading data from the media before command completion,
before the amount of time allowed for command completion based on the setting of the COMMAND CCTL
field (see 7.30.3.2), or the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3) is reached, then the device:
1) shall continue to transfer the amount of data requested;
2) may continue reading data from the media;
3) shall return command completion after all data for the command has been transferred; and
4) shall save the error information in the Read Streaming Error log;
and
c) if the amount of time allowed for command completion based on the setting of the COMMAND CCTL field
(see 7.30.3.2) or the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3) is reached, then the device:
1) shall stop processing the command;
2) shall return command completion; and
3) shall set the COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit in the Read Streaming Error log to one.
If the READ CONTINUOUS bit is cleared to zero and an error occurs, then the device:
a) may continue transferring data; and
b) shall return command completion after the data transfer has been completed.
7.30.3.4 NOT SEQUENTIAL bit
If the NOT SEQUENTIAL bit is set to one, the next read stream command that specifies the same stream in the
STREAM ID field may not be sequential in the LBA space. If the NOT SEQUENTIAL bit is cleared to zero, the device
may perform operations (e.g., read ahead operations) that anticipate the next read stream command with the
same stream in the STREAM ID field to be sequential in the LBA space. Any read of the device media or internal
device buffer management as a result of the state of the NOT SEQUENTIAL bit is vendor specific.
7.30.3.5 STREAM ID field
The STREAM ID field specifies the stream to be read. The device shall operate according to the parameters
specified by the most recent CONFIGURE STREAM command specifying this stream in the STREAM ID field
that returned command completion without an error.
7.30.4 Normal Outputs
See table 205 for the definition of Normal Outputs.
7.30.5 Error Outputs
If:
a) the READ CONTINUOUS bit was set to one in the read stream command, and
b) the device is able to return the amount of data requested for the read stream command (e.g., an error
occurred while reading from the media),
then the device shall set the STREAM ERROR bit to one and clear the ERROR bit to zero.
If:
a) the READ CONTINUOUS bit was set to one in the read stream command, and
b) the device is not able to return the amount of data requested for the read stream command (e.g., an
Interface CRC error is reported at command completion),
then the device shall clear STREAM ERROR bit to zero and set the ERROR bit to one.
If:
a) the READ CONTINUOUS bit was cleared to zero;
b) the COMMAND CCTL field (see 7.30.3.2) was not cleared to zero, or the COMMAND CCTL field was cleared
to zero and the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3) specified in the most recent CONFIGURE STREAM
command (see 7.4) for this stream was not cleared to zero; and
c) the time specified for command completion by the COMMAND CCTL field or the DEFAULT CCTL field has
been reached,
in the read stream command, then the device shall clear the STREAM ERROR bit to zero, set the ERROR bit to one,
and set:
a) the COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit to one; or
b) the ABORT bit to one.
If:
a) the READ CONTINUOUS bit was cleared to zero;
b) the COMMAND CCTL field was cleared to zero; and
c) the DEFAULT CCTL field was cleared to zero in the most recent CONFIGURE STREAM command
(see 7.4) for this stream,
in the read stream command, then the device shall clear the STREAM ERROR bit to zero, set the ERROR bit to one,
INTERFACE CRC bit to one, ID NOT FOUND bit to one, and/or ABORT bit to one (i.e., indicating the error type).
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 COMMAND CCTL field – See 7.30.3.2
7 Obsolete
6 READ CONTINUOUS bit – See 7.30.3.3
5 NOT SEQUENTIAL bit – See 7.30.3.4
4 Obsolete
3 Reserved
2:0 STREAM ID field – See 7.30.3.5
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.32.3 Inputs
See table 76 for the READ VERIFY SECTOR(S) command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be verified. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors are
to be verified
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be verified
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be verified. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical sectors
are to be verified
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be verified
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE The number of 512-byte blocks of data to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536
512-byte blocks of data are to be transferred
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13 Reserved
12:8 SUBCOMMAND field – See 7.34.3.2
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 Shall be set to one
5 Reserved
4 Shall be cleared to zero
3:0 Reserved
7.34.3.2 Subcommand
Table 79 defines the RECEIVE FPDMA QUEUED subcommands.
Errors that occur during the processing of this command are reported by returning a transport dependent
indicator (see table 242) with additional information available in the NCQ Command Error log (see A.14).
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Value Command
0000h SANITIZE STATUS EXT (see 7.36.7)
0001h..0010h Reserved
0011h CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT (see 7.36.3)
0012h BLOCK ERASE EXT (see 7.36.2)
0013h Reserved
0014h OVERWRITE EXT (see 7.36.4)
0015h..001Fh Reserved
0020h SANITIZE FREEZE LOCK EXT (see 7.36.6)
0021h..003Fh Reserved
0040h SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT (see 7.36.5)
0041h..FFFFh Reserved
7.36.2.3 Inputs
7.36.2.3.1 Overview
See table 82 for the BLOCK ERASE EXT command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE 0012h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:5 Reserved
4 FAILURE MODE bit – See 7.36.2.3.2
3:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:32 Reserved
31:0 shall be set to 426B_4572h (DWord)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0011h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:5 Reserved
4 FAILURE MODE bit – See 7.36.2.3.2
3:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:32 Reserved
31:0 shall be set to 4372_7970h (DWord)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.36.4.3 Inputs
7.36.4.3.1 Overview
See table 84 for the OVERWRITE EXT command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE 0014h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7 INVERT PATTERN BETWEEN OVERWRITE PASSES bit – See 7.36.4.3.2
6:5 Reserved
4 FAILURE MODE bit – See 7.36.2.3.2
3:0 OVERWRITE PASS COUNT field – See 7.36.4.3.3
LBA
Bit Description
47:32 shall be set to 4F57h (word)
31:0 OVERWRITE PATTERN field (DWord) – See 7.36.4.3.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0040h
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:32 Reserved
31:0 shall be set to 416E_7469h (DWord)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0020h
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:32 Reserved
31:0 shall be set to 4672_4C6Bh (DWord)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE 0000h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:1 Reserved
0 CLEAR SANITIZE OPERATION FAILED bit – See 7.36.7.3.2
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Word Description
0 Control word
Bit Field Name Description
15:1 Reserved
0 IDENTIFIER 0=compare User password
1=compare Master password
1..16 PASSWORD field (32 bytes)
17..255 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
ERASE Reallocated
MODE user data Data User data
bit Erase Mode erased a pattern b erased b
binary 0's or 0..
0 Normal No
binary 1's native
1 Enhanced c Yes vendor specific max address
a User data sectors that were previously written and are no longer in use due
to reallocation are written by the SECURITY ERASE UNIT command.
b The SECURITY ERASE UNIT command shall write the specified data
pattern to the specified LBA range.
c
The ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.3.3) indicates
whether the Enhanced Erase mode is supported.
The NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see A.11.8.5) gives an estimate of the time required to complete the
erasure.
The ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see A.11.8.4) gives an estimate of the time required to complete the
erasure.
On successful completion, this command shall disable Security (i.e., return the device to the SEC1: Security
Disabled/Not Locked/Not Frozen state (see 4.18.11.5)), and invalidate any existing User password. Any
previously valid Master password and the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.8.2) remain valid.
7.39.3 Inputs
See table 92 for the SECURITY ERASE UNIT command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Word Description
0 Control word
Bit Field Name Description
15:2 Reserved
1 ERASE MODE 0=Normal Erase mode
1=Enhanced Erase mode
0 IDENTIFIER 0=Compare User password
1=Compare Master password
1..16 PASSWORD field (32 bytes)
17..255 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
If the device supports the Master Password Identifier feature (see 4.18.10) and the NEW MASTER PASSWORD
IDENTIFIER field (see table 96) contains a value other than 0000h or FFFFh, then the device shall save the
contents of the NEW MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field in the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.8.2).
If the NEW MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field contains 0000h or FFFFh, the device shall preserve the existing
contents of the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field and return successful command completion.
If the device does not support the Master Password Identifier feature, then the device shall:
a) ignore the NEW MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field;
b) not alter the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field; and
c) not return command aborted based on the value supplied in the NEW MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field.
7.41.2.3 Setting the User Password
If the IDENTIFIER bit (see table 96) is cleared to zero (i.e., set User password), the device shall save the contents
of the NEW PASSWORD field (see table 96) as the stored User password in a non-volatile location. The MASTER
PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.8.2) shall not be changed.
Bits in the Security page (see A.11.8) of the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log shall be updated as follows:
a) the SECURITY ENABLED bit (see A.11.8.3.7) shall be set to one (i.e., security is enabled); and
b) the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see A.11.8.3.2) shall be set to the value in the NEW MASTER
PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see table 96).
7.41.3 Inputs
See table 95 for the SECURITY SET PASSWORD command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Word Description
0 Control word
Bit Bit Name Description
15:9 Reserved
8 NEW MASTER PASSWORD 0=High
CAPABILITY (see 7.41.2.3) 1=Maximum
7:1 Reserved
0 IDENTIFIER 0=set User password
(see 7.41.2.1) 1=set Master password
1..16 NEW PASSWORD field (32 bytes)
17 NEW MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see 7.41.2.2)
18..255 Reserved
7.42.3 Inputs
See table 97 for the SECURITY UNLOCK command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Word Description
0 Control word
Bit Bit Name Description
15:1 Reserved
0 IDENTIFIER 0=compare User password
1=compare Master password
Field Description
FEATURE The number of 512-byte blocks of data to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536
512-byte blocks of data are to be transferred
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13 Reserved
12:8 SUBCOMMAND field – See 7.43.3.2
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 Shall be set to one
5 Reserved
4 Shall be cleared to zero
3:0 Reserved
7.43.3.2 Subcommand
Table 100 defines the SEND FPDMA QUEUED subcommands
Field Description
FEATURE The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13 Reserved
12:8 SUBCOMMAND field – shall be set to 00h
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
LBA Reserved
AUXILIARY
Bit Description
15:1 Reserved
0 TRIM bit – See 7.5.3.2
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 Shall be set to one
5 Reserved
4 Shall be cleared to zero
3:0 Reserved
Errors that occur during the processing of this command are reported by returning a transport dependent
indicator (see table 242) with additional information available in the NCQ Command Error log (see A.14).
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:0 TIMESTAMP field
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE SET FEATURES SUBCOMMAND field (see 7.45.6)
COUNT Subcommand specific
LBA Subcommand specific
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Code Description
00h Reserved
01h Reserved for CFA
02h Enable volatile write cache (see 7.45.7)
03h Set transfer mode (see 7.45.8)
04h Obsolete
05h Enable the APM feature set (see 7.45.9)
06h Enable the PUIS feature set (see 7.45.10)
07h PUIS feature set device spin-up (see 7.45.11)
08h Reserved
If the device implements the CFA feature set, then this subcommand is reserved for
09h
CFA; otherwise, this subcommand is obsolete.
0Ah Reserved for CFA
0Bh Enable Write-Read-Verify feature set (see 7.45.12)
0Ch..0Fh Reserved
10h Enable use of SATA feature (see 7.45.17)
11h..1Fh Reserved
20h..21h Obsolete
22h..30h Reserved
31h Obsolete
32h Reserved
33h Obsolete
34h..40h Reserved
41h Enable the Free-fall Control feature set (see 7.45.16)
42h Obsolete
43h Set Maximum Host Interface Sector Times (see 7.45.13)
44h Obsolete
45h..49h Reserved
4Ah Extended Power conditions (see 7.45.20)
4Bh..53h Reserved
54h Obsolete
55h Disable read look-ahead feature (see 7.45.14)
56h..5Ch Vendor Specific
5Dh..5Eh Obsolete
5Fh Obsolete
60h..61h Reserved
62h Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control (see 7.45.19)
63h Enable/Disable the DSN feature set (see 7.45.21)
Code Description
64h..65h Reserved
66h Disable reverting to power-on defaults (see 7.45.15)
67h..68h Reserved
69h Reserved for CFA
6Ah..76h Reserved
77h Obsolete
78h..80h Reserved
81h Reserved for CFA
82h Disable volatile write cache (see 7.45.7)
83h Reserved
84h Obsolete
85h Disable the APM feature set (see 7.45.9)
86h Disable the PUIS feature set (see 7.45.10)
87h Reserved
88h Obsolete
If the device implements the CFA feature set, then this subcommand is reserved for
89h
CFA; otherwise, this subcommand is obsolete.
8Ah Reserved for CFA
8Bh Disable Write-Read-Verify feature set (see 7.45.12)
8Ch..8Fh Reserved
90h Disable use of SATA feature (see 7.45.17)
91h..94h Reserved
95h Obsolete
96h..98h Reserved
99h Obsolete
Code Description
9Ah Obsolete
9Bh..A9h Reserved
AAh Enable read look-ahead feature (see 7.45.14)
ABh Obsolete
ACh..BAh Reserved
BBh Obsolete
BCh..C0h Reserved
C1h Disable the Free-fall Control feature set (see 7.45.16)
C2h Obsolete
C3h Enable/Disable the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 7.45.18)
C4h..CBh Reserved
CCh Enable reverting to power-on defaults (see 7.45.15)
CDh..D5h Reserved
D6h..DCh Vendor Specific
DDh.DEh Obsolete
DFh Obsolete
E0h Vendor Specific
E1h..EFh Reserved
F0h..F3h Reserved for CFA
F4h..FFh Reserved
If a device receives a SET FEATURES command with a Set Transfer Mode subcommand and the COUNT field
value set to 0000_0000b, then the device shall set the default PIO mode. If the COUNT field is set to 0000_0001b
and the device supports disabling of IORDY (see ATA8-APT), then the device shall set the default PIO mode and
disable IORDY. A device shall support all PIO modes below the highest mode supported (e.g., if PIO mode 1 is
supported PIO mode 0 shall be supported).
Support of IORDY is mandatory if PIO mode 3 or above is the current mode of operation.
A device shall support all Multiword DMA modes below the highest mode supported (e.g., if Multiword DMA
mode 1 is supported Multiword DMA mode 0 shall be supported).
A device shall support all Ultra DMA modes below the highest mode supported (e.g., if Ultra DMA mode 1 is
supported Ultra DMA mode 0 shall be supported).
If an Ultra DMA mode is enabled any previously enabled Multiword DMA mode shall be disabled by the device. If
a Multiword DMA mode is enabled any previously enabled Ultra DMA mode shall be disabled by the device.
For PATA systems using a cable assembly, the host should determine that an 80-conductor cable assembly is
connecting the host with the device(s) before enabling any Ultra DMA mode greater than 2 in the device(s) (see
ATA8-APT).
The current transfer mode is indicated in the TRANSFER MODE field (see A.11.9.6.1).
Device performance may increase with increasing APM levels. Device power consumption may increase with
increasing power management levels. The APM levels may contain discrete bands (e.g., a device may
implement one APM method from 80h to A0h and a higher performance, higher power consumption method from
level A1h to FEh). APM levels 80h and higher do not permit the device to spin down, if possible, to save power.
Subcommand code 85h disables APM. Subcommand 85h may not be implemented on all devices that
implement subcommand 05h.
Support for the APM feature set is indicated by the APM SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.19). The enabled state of
the APM feature set is indicated by the APM ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.11). The current APM level is indicated in
the APM LEVEL field (see A.11.6.3.2).
7.45.10 Enable/disable the PUIS feature set
Subcommand code 06h enables the PUIS feature set (see 4.16). If this feature set is enabled, the device shall
power-up into the PM4: PUIS state (i.e., the device shall be ready to receive commands but shall not spin-up)
(see 4.16). After this feature set is enabled, it shall only be disabled by a subsequent subcommand code 86h that
disables this feature set. This feature set shall not be disabled by a power-on reset, a hardware reset, or a
software reset.
Subcommand code 86h disables the PUIS feature set. If this feature set is disabled, the device shall power-up
into Active mode. The factory default for this feature set shall be disabled.
Support for the PUIS feature set is indicated by the PUIS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.18).The enabled state of
the PUIS feature set is indicated in the PUIS ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.10).
7.45.11 PUIS feature set device spin-up
Subcommand code 07h shall cause a device that has powered-up into Standby mode to go to the Active mode
(see 4.16 and figure 8).
LBA field
Description
bits 7:0
00h a Write-Read-Verify Mode 0
Always enabled (i.e., the device shall perform a Write-Read-Verify for all logical
sectors for all write commands).
01h a Write-Read-Verify Mode 1
The device shall perform a Write-Read-Verify on the first 65 536 logical sectors
written after:
a) spin-up; or
b) the device completes a SET FEATURES command setting the
Write-Read-Verify mode without error.
02h a Write-Read-Verify Mode 2
The number of logical sectors on which a device performs a Write-Read-Verify
is vendor specific.
03h Write-Read-Verify Mode 3
The device shall perform a Write-Read-Verify on the first n logical sectors
written by the host after:
a) spin-up; or
b) the device completes a SET FEATURES command setting the
Write-Read-Verify mode without error.
n=x 1 024
where:
x=number specified by the COUNT field.
04h-FFh Reserved
a
The COUNT field shall be ignored.
Upon completion of SET FEATURES subcommand 43h, the device may adjust the following fields to allow for
the specified host interface sector time:
a) DMA SECTOR TIME (see A.11.6.4);
b) PIO SECTOR TIME (see A.11.6.5); and
c) STREAM ACCESS LATENCY (see A.11.6.7).
7.45.14 Enable/disable read look-ahead
Subcommand codes AAh and 55h enables or disables read look-ahead. Error recovery performed by the device
is vendor specific.
Support for the read look-ahead feature set is indicated by the READ LOOK-AHEAD SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.12). The enabled state of the read look-ahead feature set is indicated by the READ LOOK-AHEAD
ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.8).
COUNT
field Description
00h Reserved for Serial ATA
01h Non-zero Buffer Offsets
02h DMA Setup FIS Auto-Activate optimization
03h Device-initiated interface power state transitions
04h Guaranteed In-Order Data Delivery
05h Asynchronous Notification
06h Software Settings Preservation
07h Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions
08h Enable Hardware Feature Control
09h-FFh Reserved for Serial ATA
If device initiated interface power management is enabled, the device shall not attempt to initiate an interface
power state transition between reset and the delivery of the device reset signature (see table 206).
7.45.17.5 Enable/Disable Guaranteed in-Order Data Delivery
A COUNT field value of 04h is used to enable or disable guaranteed in-order data delivery for commands in the
NCQ feature set (see 4.14). This setting is only valid if non-zero buffer offsets are enabled. By default,
guaranteed in-order data delivery is disabled. See SATA 3.1 for more information. The enable/disable state for
guaranteed in-order data delivery shall be preserved across software reset. The enable/disable state for
guaranteed in-order data delivery shall be reset to its default state upon COMRESET.
7.45.17.6 Enable/Disable Asynchronous Notification
For ATAPI devices, a COUNT field value of 05h is used to enable or disable asynchronous notification. By default,
asynchronous notification is disabled. See SATA 3.1 for more information. The enable/disable state for
asynchronous notification shall be preserved across software reset. The enable/disable state for asynchronous
notification shall be reset to its default state upon COMRESET.
7.45.17.7 Enable/Disable Software Settings Preservation
See table 17 for a list of the preserved feature sets and settings. A COUNT field value of 06h is used to enable or
disable software settings preservation. By default, if the device supports software settings preservation the
feature is enabled when it processes a power-on reset. The enable/disable state for software settings
preservation shall persist across software reset. The enable/disable state for software settings preservation shall
be reset to its default state upon COMRESET. The host may disable software settings preservation in order to
cause software settings to revert to their power-on default state when the device receives a COMRESET.
7.45.17.8 Enable/Disable Device Automatic Partial to Slumber Transitions
A COUNT field (7:0) set to 07h is used by the host to enable or disable Device Automatic Partial to Slumber
transitions. By default, if the device supports Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions the feature is
disabled on power-up. The enable/disable state for Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions shall persist
across software reset. The enable/disable state for Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions shall be reset to its
default state upon hardware reset.
Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions shall not be enabled if Device-Initiated Interface Power State
transitions are disabled. Attempting to enable Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions while Device-Initiated
Interface Power State transitions are disabled results in the device aborting the Set Features command.
Attempting to disable Device Automatic Partial to Slumber transitions while it is already disabled has no effect
and the device shall return completion for the Set Features command without an error.
7.45.17.9 Enable Hardware Feature Control
See 4.22 for additional information about Hardware Feature Control.
This function enables Hardware Feature Control. The Hardware Feature Control feature shall be disabled by
processing a power-on reset.
A COUNT field (7:0) set to 08h is used by the host to enable Hardware Feature Control.
The LBA field (15:0) contains a function identifier (see table 110).
After a SET FEATURES Enable Hardware Feature Control command returns command completion without an
error:
a) the Current Hardware Feature Control Identifier (see the Serial ATA Settings page 08h in the IDENTIFY
DEVICE data log (log 30h), A.11) shall be set to the value in the LBA field (15:0);
b) the Hardware Feature Control features shall be enabled (i.e., IDENTIFY DEVICE word 79, bit 5 is set to
one); and
c) the behavior of Hardware Feature Control is specified by Table 110.
The device shall return command aborted if:
a) the Hardware Feature Control feature is not supported (i.e., IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 78 bit 5 is
cleared to zero);
b) the value in the LBA field (15:0) is not equal to the Supported Hardware Feature Control Identifier (see
the Serial ATA Settings page 08h in the IDENTIFY DEVICE data log (log 30h), A.11); or
c) the Current Hardware Feature Control Identifier (see the Serial ATA Settings page 08h in the IDENTIFY
DEVICE data log (log 30h), A.11) is non-zero.
7.45.18 Enable/Disable the Sense Data Reporting feature set
Subcommand code C3h allows the host to enable the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 4.20) by sending
this subcommand with the COUNT field (bit 0) set to one.
The Sense Data Reporting feature set is disabled by sending this subcommand with the COUNT field (bit 0)
cleared to zero.
All other sub-command specific fields are reserved.
Support for the Sense Data Reporting feature set is indicated by the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.28). The enabled state of the Sense Data Reporting feature set is indicated by the SENSE DATA
ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.6).
EPC
subcommands Description
0h Restore Power Condition Settings (see 7.45.20.2)
1h Go To Power Condition (see 7.45.20.3)
2h Set Power Condition Timer (see 7.45.20.4)
3h Set Power Condition State (see 7.45.20.5)
4h Enable the EPC feature set (see 7.45.20.6)
5h Disable the EPC feature set (see 7.45.20.7)
6h Set EPC Power Source (see 7.45.20.8)
7h..Fh Reserved
Table 112 describes the contents of the POWER CONDITION ID field that are specified in the COUNT field and select
the power condition or power conditions to be processed.
Support for the EPC feature set is indicated by the EPC SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.27). The enabled state of the
EPC feature set is indicated by the EPC ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.3).
Field Description
COUNT POWER CONDITION ID field (see table 112)
LBA
Bit Description
27:7 Reserved
6 DEFAULT bit
1 = Restore from Default settings
0 = Restore from Saved settings
5 Reserved
4 SAVE bit
1 = Save settings on completion
0 = Do not save settings on completion
3:0 0h (i.e., Restore Power Condition subcommand (see table 111))
Field Description
COUNT POWER CONDITION ID field (see table 112)
LBA
Bit Description
27:26 Reserved
25 DELAYED ENTRY bit – See 7.45.20.3.1
24 HOLD POWER CONDITION bit – See 7.45.20.3.1
23:4 Reserved
3:0 1h (i.e., Go To Power Condition subcommand (see table 111))
Field Description
COUNT POWER CONDITION ID field (see table 112)
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 TIMER field – See 7.45.20.4.3
7 TIMER UNITS bit – See 7.45.20.4.3
1 = TIMER field units of measure are 1 minute
0 = TIMER field units of measure are 100 milliseconds
6 Reserved
5 ENABLE bit
1 = Enable the selected power condition
0 = Disable the selected power condition
4 SAVE bit
1 = Save settings on completion
0 = Do not save settings on completion
3:0 2h (i.e., Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see table 111))
If the TIMER UNITS bit is cleared to zero, the new timer value shall be equal to the contents of the TIMER field. If the
TIMER UNITS bit is set to one, the new timer value shall be equal to the contents of the TIMER field multiplied by
600.
If the new timer value is greater than the value in the MAXIMUM TIMER SETTING field (see A.8.4.14) for the selected
power condition, then the device may set the new timer value to the maximum timer setting for the selected
power condition. If the new timer value is less than the value in the MINIMUM TIMER SETTING field (see A.8.4.13) for
the selected power condition, then the device may set the new timer value to the minimum timer setting for the
selected power condition.
7.45.20.4.4 Normal Outputs
See table 202.
7.45.20.4.5 Error Outputs
The device shall return command aborted If:
a) the new timer value is:
A) less than the maximum setting for the selected power condition;
B) greater than the minimum setting for the selected power condition; and
C) not supported by the device;
b) the POWER CONDITION ID field is invalid;
c) the selected power condition is not changeable;
d) the selected power condition is not supported;
e) the SAVE bit is set to one and the selected power condition is not saveable;
f) the new timer value is greater than the maximum setting (see A.8) for the selected power condition and
the device did not set the timer to the maximum setting; or
g) the new timer value is less than the minimum setting (see A.8) for the selected power condition and the
device did not set the timer to the minimum setting.
If command aborted is returned, then the device shall make no modifications to the power condition settings. See
table 219.
7.45.20.5.2 Inputs
See table 116 for the SET FEATURES command inputs.
Field Description
COUNT POWER CONDITION ID field (see table 112)
LBA
Bit Description
27:6 Reserved
5 ENABLE bit
1 = Enable the selected power condition
0 = Disable the selected power condition
4 SAVE bit
1 = Save settings on completion
0 = Do not save settings on completion
3:0 3h (i.e., Set Power Condition State subcommand (see table 111))
Field Description
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:4 Reserved
3:0 4h (i.e., Enable the EPC feature set (see table 111))
Field Description
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:4 Reserved
3:0 5h (i.e., Disable the EPC feature set (see table 111))
Field Description
COUNT
Bit Description
7:2 Reserved
1:0 POWER SOURCE field – See 7.45.20.8.2.2
LBA
Bit Description
27:4 Reserved
3:0 6h (i.e., Set EPC Power Source)
If the contents of the COUNT field are zero, then the device may:
a) disable multiple mode (i.e., respond with command aborted for all subsequent READ MULTIPLE
commands, READ MULTIPLE EXT commands, WRITE MULTIPLE commands, WRITE MULTIPLE EXT
commands, and WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT commands);
b) return command aborted for all SET MULTIPLE MODE commands; or
c) retain the previous multiple mode settings.
After a SET MULTIPLE command returns command completion without an error the device shall report the valid
value set by that command in IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 59 (see 7.12.7.21).
After a power-on reset or hardware reset, if IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 59 bit 8 is set to one and IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 59 bits 7:0 are cleared to zero, a SET MULTIPLE command is required before issuing a
READ MULTIPLE command, READ MULTIPLE EXT command, WRITE MULTIPLE command, or WRITE
MULTIPLE EXT command. If bit 8 is set to one and bits 7:0 are not cleared to zero, a SET MULTIPLE command
may be issued to change the multiple value required before issuing a READ MULTIPLE command, READ
MULTIPLE EXT command, WRITE MULTIPLE command, or WRITE MULTIPLE EXT command.
7.46.3 Inputs
See table 121 for the SET MULTIPLE MODE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT DRQ data block count
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.48 SMART
7.48.1 Overview
Individual SMART commands are identified by the value placed in the FEATURE field. Table 123 shows these
values.
Value Command
00h-CFh Reserved
D0h SMART READ DATA (see 7.48.6)
D1h Obsolete
D2h SMART ENABLE/DISABLE ATTRIBUTE AUTOSAVE (see 7.48.3)
D3h Obsolete
D4h SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE (see 7.48.5)
D5h SMART READ LOG (see 7.48.7)
D6h SMART WRITE LOG (see 7.48.9)
D7h Obsolete
D8h SMART ENABLE OPERATIONS (see 7.48.4)
D9h SMART DISABLE OPERATIONS (see 7.48.2)
DAh SMART RETURN STATUS (see 7.48.8)
DBh Obsolete
DCh-DFh Reserved
E0h-FFh vendor specific
Field Description
FEATURE D9h
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE D2h
COUNT
Value Description
00h Disable attribute autosave
01h-F0h Vendor specific
F1h Enable attribute autosave
F2h-FFh Vendor specific
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE D8h
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
5) if the device is in the process of performing the subcommand routine and is interrupted by a SMART
DISABLE OPERATIONS command, then the device shall suspend or abort the subcommand routine
and begin processing the new command within two seconds after receipt of the command. Upon receipt
of the next SMART ENABLE OPERATIONS command the device may, either re-initiate the
subcommand routine or resume the subcommand routine from where it had been previously suspended;
6) if the device is in the process of performing the subcommand routine and is interrupted by a SMART
EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command, then the device shall abort the subcommand routine and
begin processing the new command within two seconds after receipt of the command. The device shall
then process the new SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE subcommand;
7) if the device is in the process of performing the subcommand routine and is interrupted by a STANDBY
IMMEDIATE command or IDLE IMMEDIATE command, then the device shall suspend or abort the
subcommand routine, and begin processing the new command within two seconds after receipt of the
command. After receiving a new command that causes the device to exit a power saving mode, the
device shall initiate or resume the subcommand routine without any additional commands unless these
activities were aborted by the host;
8) while the device is performing the subcommand routine it shall not change power states (e.g., as a result
of its Standby timer (see 4.15.3) expiring); and
9) if a test failure occurs while a device is performing a self-test routine, then the device may discontinue
the testing and place the test results in the Self-test execution status byte (see table 130).
7.48.5.2.3 Captive mode
While processing a self-test in captive mode, the device processes the self-test routine after receipt of the
command. At the end of the self-test routine the device places the results of this self-test routine in the Self-test
execution status byte (see table 130) and reports command completion. If an error occurs while a device is
performing the self-test routine, then the device may discontinue its testing, place the results of this self-test
routine in the Self-test execution status byte, and complete the command.
7.48.5.2.4 SMART off-line routine
The SMART off-line routine shall only be processed in the off-line mode (see 7.48.5.2.2). The results of this
routine are placed in the Off-line data collection status byte (see table 131).
7.48.5.2.5 SMART Short self-test routine
Depending on the value in the LBA field (7:0) (see table 127), the SMART Short self-test routine may be
processed in either the captive mode or the off-line mode. The SMART Short self-test routine should take on the
order of minutes to complete (see table 130).
7.48.5.2.6 SMART Extended self-test routine
Depending on the value in the LBA field (7:0) (see table 127), the SMART Extended self-test routine may be
processed in either the captive mode or the off-line mode. The SMART Extended self-test routine should take
on the order of tens of minutes to complete (see table 130).
7.48.5.2.7 SMART Conveyance self-test routine
Depending on the value in the LBA field (7:0) (see table 127), the SMART Conveyance self-test routine may be
processed in either the captive mode or the off-line mode. The SMART Conveyance self-test routine may identify
damage incurred during transporting of the device. The SMART Conveyance self-test routine should take on the
order of minutes to complete (see table 130).
7.48.5.2.8 SMART Selective self-test routine
If the SMART Selective self-test routine is implemented, then all features of this self-routine shall be
implemented. Support for the SMART Selective self-test routine is indicated in off-line data collection capabilities
(see 7.48.6.9). If the value in the LBA field (7:0) is 4 or 132, the SMART Selective self-test routine shall be
processed. This self-test routine shall include the initial tests performed by the Extended self-test routine plus
a selectable read scan. The host should not write the Selective Self-Test log while the processing of a SMART
Selective self-test routine is in progress.
A read scan of the specified areas of the media is requested by setting the test spans to be read scanned in the
Selective Self-Test log (see A.19). The device shall process the specified test spans and they shall be read
scanned in their entirety. If bit 1 in the Feature flags word of the Selective Self-Test log (see A.19) is cleared to
zero, then the device shall not perform an off-line scan following the Selective self-test.
The Selective Self-Test log is updated as the self-test proceeds indicating test progress. After all specified test
spans have been completed, the test is terminated and the appropriate self-test execution status is reported in
the SMART READ DATA response depending on the occurrence of errors. Figure 12 shows an example of a
Selective self-test definition with three test spans defined. In this example, the test terminates when all three test
spans have been scanned.
If bit 1 of the Feature flags word in the Selective Self-Test log (see A.19) is set to one, then after the scan of the
selected spans described in this subclause, the device shall scan the rest of media in an off-line mode. If an error
occurs during the scanning of the test spans, the error is reported in the self-test execution status in the SMART
READ DATA response and the off-line scan is not processed. If the test spans defined have been scanned, the
device shall:
a) set the off-line scan pending and active flags in the Selective Self-Test log to one;
b) set the span under test to a value greater than five;
c) set the self-test execution status in the SMART READ DATA response to 00h;
d) set a value of 03h in the off-line data collection status in the SMART READ DATA response; and
e) proceed to process an off-line read scan through all areas not included in the test spans.
This off-line read scan shall be completed with no pauses between block reads. Any errors encountered shall not
be reported to the host. Error locations may be logged for future reallocation. If the device is powered-down
before the off-line scan is completed, then the off-line scan shall resume when the device is powered up. From
power-up, the resumption of the scan shall be delayed the time indicated in the Selective self-test pending time
field in the Selective Self-Test log (see A.19). During this delay time the pending flag shall be set to one and the
active flag shall be cleared to zero in the Selective Self-Test log. Once the time expires, the active flag shall be
set to one, and the off-line scan shall resume. When the entire media has been scanned, the off-line scan shall
terminate, both the pending and active flags shall be cleared to zero, and the off-line data collection status in the
SMART READ DATA response shall be set to 02h indicating completion.
The time to complete off-line testing and the self-test polling times do not apply to the selective self-test.
Progress through the test spans is indicated in the Selective Self-Test log.
If bit 3 in the Selective self-test Feature flags word is set to one (see A.19), a device shall continue processing
the Selective self-test after processing a hardware reset or a software reset. If bit 3 in the Selective self-test
Feature flags word is cleared to zero, a device shall abort the Selective self-test during processing a hardware
reset or a software reset.
If the device receives a SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command with the Abort off-line test routine
subcommand, then the device shall abort the Selective self-test.
If the device receives a SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command specifying that the device perform
a self-test while a selective self-test is in progress, the device shall abort the selective self-test and process the
specified self-test.
7.48.5.3 Inputs
See table 128 for the SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE D4h
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 Table 127 defines the subcommand that shall be processed
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE D0h
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
NOTE 17 — There is no defined mechanism for a device to return an Interface CRC error status that may have
occurred during the last data block of a PIO Data-In transfer. There may be other mechanisms in which a host
may verify that an Interface CRC error occurred in these cases.
Value Description
00h or 80h Off-line data collection activity was never started.
01h Reserved
02h or 82h Off-line data collection activity was completed without error.
03h Off-line activity in progress.
04h or 84h Off-line data collection activity was suspended by an interrupting command from host.
05h or 85h Off-line data collection activity was aborted by an interrupting command from host.
06h or 86h Off-line data collection activity was aborted by the device with a fatal error.
07h-3Fh Reserved
40h-7Fh Vendor specific
81h Reserved
83h Reserved
87h-BFh Reserved
C0h-FFh Vendor specific
Value Description
0h Indicates a previous self-test routine completed without error or no self-test status is available
1h The self-test routine was aborted by the host
2h The self-test routine was interrupted by the host with a hardware or software reset
A fatal error or unknown test error occurred while the device was executing its self-test routine and
3h
the device was unable to complete the self-test routine.
The previous self-test completed having a test element that failed and the test element that failed
4h
is not known.
5h The previous self-test completed having the electrical element of the test failed.
6h The previous self-test completed having the servo and/or seek test element of the test failed.
7h The previous self-test completed having the read element of the test failed.
The previous self-test completed having a test element that failed and the device is suspected of
8h
having handling damage.
9h-Eh Reserved.
Fh Self-test routine in progress.
Bit Description
7 Reserved
6 SELECTIVE SELF-TEST IMPLEMENTED bit – If this bit is cleared to zero, the device does not implement the
Selective self-test routine. If this bit is set to one, the device implements the Selective self-test routine.
5 CONVEYANCE SELF-TEST IMPLEMENTED bit – If this bit is cleared to zero, the device does not implement the
Conveyance self-test routines. If this bit is set to one, the device implements the Conveyance self-test
routines.
4 SELF-TEST IMPLEMENTED bit – If this bit is cleared to zero, the device does not implement the Short and
Extended self-test routines. If this bit is set to one, the device implements the Short and Extended
self-test routines.
3 OFF-LINE READ SCANNING IMPLEMENTED bit – If this bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support
off-line read scanning. If this bit is set to one, the device supports off-line read scanning.
2 ABORT/RESTART OFF-LINE BY HOST bit – If this bit is set to one, then the device shall abort all off-line data
collection activity initiated by a SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command upon receipt of a
new command within 2 seconds of receiving the new command. If this bit is cleared to zero, the device
shall suspend off-line data collection activity after an interrupting command and resume off-line data
collection activity after some vendor-specified event.
1 Vendor specific.
0 EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE IMPLEMENTED bit – If this bit is set to one, then the SMART EXECUTE
OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command is implemented by this device. If this bit is cleared to zero, then the
SMART EXECUTE OFF-LINE IMMEDIATE command is not implemented by this device.
Field Description
FEATURE D5h
COUNT Specifies the number of log pages to be read from the specified log. The log transferred by the
ATA device shall start at the first page in the specified log, regardless of the Count requested
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – specifies the log to be read (see 7.24.3.3)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE DAh
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE D6h
COUNT Specifies the number of log pages that shall be written. The data transferred to the device shall be
stored starting at the first block in the specified log. If the device receives a value of zero in this
field, then the device shall report command aborted
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – See 7.48.9.3.2
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT Standby timer period (see table 52)
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE SECURITY PROTOCOL field (see 7.51.3.2)
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:25 Reserved
24 TRUSTED NON-DATA SEND/RECEIVE bit
0 = Non-Data TRUSTED SEND
1 = Non-Data TRUSTED RECEIVE
23:8 SP SPECIFIC field – Security Protocol specific (word) (see 7.51.3.3)
7:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.52.3 Inputs
7.52.3.1 Overview
See table 140 for the TRUSTED RECEIVE command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE SECURITY PROTOCOL field (see 7.52.3.2)
COUNT TRANSFER LENGTH field (7:0) – See 7.52.3.4
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 SP SPECIFIC field – Security Protocol specific (word) (see 7.52.3.3)
7:0 TRANSFER LENGTH field (15:8) – See 7.52.3.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Value Description
00h Return security protocol information (see 7.52.6)
01h..06h Reserved for TCG
07h Reserved for T10
08h..1Fh Reserved
20h..21h Reserved for T10
22h..3Fh Reserved
40h..41h Reserved for T10
42h..EBh Reserved
ECh Reserved for JEDEC
EDh Reserved for SDCard
EEh Reserved for IEEE 1667
EFh Reserved for T10
F0h..FFh Vendor Specific
If the SP SPECIFIC field is set to a reserved value, then the command shall be aborted.
Each time a TRUSTED RECEIVE command with the SECURITY PROTOCOL field set to 00h is received, the device
shall transfer the data starting with byte 0.
Bit
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Byte
0 Reserved
1 Reserved
2 Reserved
3 Reserved
4 Reserved
5 Reserved
6
LIST LENGTH (word) (M–7)
7
8
… Supported Security Protocol List
M
M+1
… Pad bytes, if any (see 7.52.6.1)
511
The LIST LENGTH field indicates the total length, in bytes, of the supported security protocol list.
The Supported Security Protocol List shall contain a list of all supported SECURITY PROTOCOL field values. Each
byte indicates a supported SECURITY PROTOCOL field value. The values shall be in ascending order starting with
00h.
The total data length shall be 512 bytes. Pad bytes are appended as needed to meet this requirement. Pad bytes
shall have a value of 00h.
Bit
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Byte
0 Reserved
1 Reserved
2
CERTIFICATES LENGTH (word) (M–3)
3
4
… Certificates (zero or more)
M
M+1
… Pad bytes, if any (see 7.52.6.1)
(512t)–1
The CERTIFICATES LENGTH field indicates the total length, in bytes, of the certificates. This length includes one or
more certificates. If the device has no certificate to return, the certificate length is set to 0000h, the 4 byte header,
and 508 pad bytes are returned.
The contents of the Certificates are defined in 7.52.6.3.2 and 7.52.6.3.3.
The total data length shall conform to the TRANSFER LENGTH field (see 7.52.3.4) requirements described in
7.52.6.2.
7.52.6.3.2 Public Key certificate description
RFC 3280 defines the certificate syntax for certificates consistent with the X.509v3 Public Key Certificate
Specification.
7.52.6.3.3 Attribute certificate description
RFC 3281 defines the certificate syntax for certificates consistent with the X.509v2 Attribute Certificate
Specification.
Bit
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Byte
0
… LENGTH OF COMPLIANCE DESCRIPTORS (DWord) (M–3)
3
4
… Compliance Descriptors (see 7.52.6.4.3)
M
M+1
… Pad bytes, if any (see 7.52.6.1)
(512t)-1
Compliance Compliance
Description Reference
Descriptor Type Descriptor
0000h Reserved
0001h Security requirements for cryptographic modules FIPS 140-2, 7.52.6.4.3.3
FIPS 140-3
0002h..FFFFh Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE SECURITY PROTOCOL field (see 7.52.3.2)
COUNT TRANSFER LENGTH field (7:0) – See 7.52.3.4
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 SP SPECIFIC field – Security Protocol specific (word) (see 7.52.3.3)
7:0 TRANSFER LENGTH field (15:8) – See 7.52.3.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
See 7.52.3.
7.53.4 Normal Outputs
See 7.52.4.
7.53.5 Error Outputs
See 7.52.5.
Field Description
FEATURE SECURITY PROTOCOL field (see 7.54.3.2)
COUNT TRANSFER LENGTH field (7:0) – See 7.54.3.4
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 SP SPECIFIC field – Security Protocol specific (word) (see 7.54.3.3)
7:0 TRANSFER LENGTH field (15:8) – See 7.54.3.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Value Description
00h Reserved
01h..06h Reserved for TCG
07h Reserved for T10
08h..1Fh Reserved
20h..21h Reserved for T10
22h..40h Reserved
41h Reserved for T10
42h..EBh Reserved
ECh Reserved for JEDEC
EDh Reserved for SDCard
EEh Reserved for IEEE 1667
EFh Reserved for T10
F0h..FFh Vendor Specific
Field Description
FEATURE SECURITY PROTOCOL field (see 7.54.3.2)
COUNT Transfer Length (7:0) – See 7.54.3.4
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 SP SPECIFIC field – Security Protocol specific (word) (see 7.54.3.3)
7:0 Transfer Length (15:8) – See 7.54.3.4
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
COUNT
Bit Description
15:14 PRIO field – See 4.14.2
13:8 Reserved
7:3 NCQ TAG field – See 7.16.3.3
2:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT LOG PAGE COUNT field – See 7.62.3.2
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 PAGE NUMBER field (15:8) – See 7.62.3.3
31:16 Reserved
15:8 PAGE NUMBER field (7:0) – See 7.62.3.3
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – specifies the log to be written (see 7.48.9.3.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT LOG PAGE COUNT field – See 7.62.3.2
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 PAGE NUMBER field (15:8) – See 7.62.3.3
31:16 Reserved
15:8 PAGE NUMBER field (7:0) – See 7.62.3.3
7:0 LOG ADDRESS field – specifies the log to be written (see 7.48.9.3.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE N/A
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 00h indicates that 256 logical sectors
are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 COMMAND CCTL field – See 7.30.3.2.
7 Obsolete
6 WRITE CONTINUOUS bit – See 7.69.3.2
5 FLUSH bit – See 7.69.3.3
4 Obsolete
3 Reserved
2:0 STREAM ID field – See 7.69.3.4
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
3) shall return command completion after all data for the command has been transferred; and
4) shall save the error information in the Write Streaming Error log (see A.22);
or
c) if the amount of time allowed for command completion based on the setting of the COMMAND CCTL field
or the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3) is reached, then the device:
1) shall stop processing the command;
2) shall return command completion;
3) shall set the COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit in the Write Streaming Error log to one; and
4) may continue writing data to the media.
If the WRITE CONTINUOUS bit is cleared to zero and an error occurs, then the device:
a) shall stop processing the command and return command completion; and
b) may continue writing data to the media.
7.69.3.3 FLUSH bit
If the FLUSH bit is set to one, the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3.4) is cleared to zero in the most recent
CONFIGURE STREAM command (see 7.4) for the Stream ID, and the COMMAND CCTL field (see 7.30.3.2)
is cleared to zero, then the device shall write all data for the specified stream to the media before command
completion is reported.
If the FLUSH bit is set to one and the DEFAULT CCTL field was not cleared to zero in the most recent CONFIGURE
STREAM command for the Stream ID, then the device shall return command completion within the time specified
by the DEFAULT CCTL field.
If the FLUSH bit is set to one and the COMMAND CCTL field is not cleared to zero, then the device shall return
command completion within ((the contents of the COMMAND CCTL field) (the contents of the STREAM
GRANULARITY field (see A.11.6.8))) µs.
If the FLUSH bit is set to one and either the DEFAULT CCTL field was not cleared to zero in the most recent
CONFIGURE STREAM command (see 7.4) for the Stream ID, or the COMMAND CCTL field is not cleared to zero,
then the device:
a) shall measure the time before reporting command completion from command acceptance;
b) shall set the COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit (see 6.3.3) to one if all of the data for the command has
been received by the device, but the device has not yet written all of the data to its media; and
c) should continue writing data to its media after reporting command completion.
7.69.3.4 STREAM ID field
The STREAM ID field specifies the stream to be written. The device shall operate according to the parameters
specified by the most recent CONFIGURE STREAM command specifying this Stream ID that returned command
completion without an error. Any write to the device media or internal device buffer management as a result of
the Stream ID is vendor specific.
7.69.4 Normal Outputs
See table 205 for the definition of Normal Outputs.
7.69.5 Error Outputs
If:
a) The WRITE CONTINUOUS bit was set to one in the command; and
b) the device is able to accept the amount of data requested for the command (e.g., an error occurred while
writing to the media),
then the device shall set the STREAM ERROR bit to one and clear the ERROR bit to zero.
If:
a) The WRITE CONTINUOUS bit was set to one in the command; and
b) the device is not able to return the amount of data requested for the command (e.g., an Interface CRC
error shall be reported at command completion),
then the device shall clear the STREAM ERROR bit to zero and set the ERROR bit to one.
If:
a) the WRITE CONTINUOUS bit was cleared to zero in the command;
b) the COMMAND CCTL field (see 7.30.3.2) was not cleared to zero in the command, or the COMMAND CCTL
field was cleared to zero in the command and the DEFAULT CCTL field (see 7.4.3) specified in the most
recent CONFIGURE STREAM command (see 7.4) for the STREAM ID field was not cleared to zero; and
c) the time specified for command completion by the COMMAND CCTL field or the DEFAULT CCTL field has
been reached,
then the device shall clear the STREAM ERROR bit to zero, set the ERROR bit to one, and set the ABORT bit to one
whether or not all data has been flushed to media.
If:
a) the WRITE CONTINUOUS bit was cleared to zero in the command;
b) the COMMAND CCTL field was cleared to zero in the command; and
c) the DEFAULT CCTL field was cleared to zero in the most recent CONFIGURE STREAM command
(see 7.4) for the STREAM ID field,
then the device shall clear the STREAM ERROR bit to zero, set the ERROR bit to one, and set the INTERFACE CRC bit
to one, ID NOT FOUND bit to one, and/or ABORT bit to one (i.e., indicating the error type).
A device may return command completion with the ERROR bit set to one if an Interface CRC error has occurred.
See table 233.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 COMMAND CCTL field – See 7.30.3.2.
7 Obsolete
6 WRITE CONTINUOUS bit – See 7.69.3.2
5 FLUSH bit – See 7.69.3.3
4 Obsolete
3 Reserved
2:0 STREAM ID field – See 7.69.3.4
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be transferred. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be transferred
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be transferred
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
7.71.3 Inputs
See table 168 for the WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT command inputs.
Field Description
FEATURE
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7:0 Uncorrectable options
Value Description
00h-54h Reserved
55h Create a pseudo-uncorrectable error with logging
56h-59h Reserved
5Ah Vendor specific
5Bh-A4h Reserved
A5h Vendor Specific
A6h-A9h Reserved
AAh Create a flagged error without logging
ABh-FFh Reserved
COUNT The number of logical sectors to be marked. A value of 0000h indicates that 65 536 logical
sectors are to be marked
LBA LBA of first logical sector to be marked
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 Shall be set to one
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
8.1 Introduction
8.1.1 Overview
The SCT Command Transport uses logs (see table 169) to provide transport methods for:
a) a host to send an SCT Command and data to a device; and
b) a device to send data and SCT Status to a host.
Table 170 — Summary of ATA commands used by the SCT Command Transport
Sending a 512-byte block of data (i.e., key page) to the SCT Command/Status log starts the SCT command
process. The key page contains the SCT command's ACTION CODE field, FUNCTION CODE field, and parameters,
if any, that are required to process the SCT command. If the combination of action code and function code
requires data transfer, then the data is transferred by reading or writing the SCT Data Transfer log. The SCT
Status (i.e., error or command) is read from the SCT Command/Status log.
SCT commands (see 8.2.3) are processed like other ATA commands, therefore they take precedence over any
background activity the device may be performing when the SCT command is processed (e.g., a function
initiated by a SMART EXECUTE OFFLINE IMMEDIATE command). Some SCT commands indicate ATA
command completion and return status while the SCT command is still processing. Information about the SCT
command that is still processing may be retrieved by reading the SCT Command/Status log (see 8.2.5).
A device supporting the SCT Command Transport should report a length of one in the General Purpose Log
Directory (see A.2) and the SMART Log Directory (see A.3) for the SCT Command/Status log and the SCT Data
Transfer log, respectively. The length of the SCT Data Transfer log does not indicate the length of an SCT
Command Transport data transfer. This differs from the requirement in this standard that the GPL Directory
(see A.2) and the SMART Log Directory (see A.3) report the actual length of the specified log pages.
8.1.2 SCT command interactions with ATA commands
If the value in the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field is FFFFh (i.e., the SCT command is processing in background
(see table 175)) and the device processes:
a) an ATA command that reads from the SCT Data Transfer log (see 8.1.1), then the device shall process
the command to read the SCT Data Transfer log as described in 8.2.4;
b) an ATA command that writes to the SCT Data Transfer log, then the device shall process the command
to write the SCT Data Transfer log as described in 8.2.4;
c) an ATA command that reads from the SCT Command/Status log, then the device shall process the
command to read the SCT Command/Status log; or
d) any other ATA command, then:
1) if the SCT command being processed in the background is SCT Write Same command, the device
shall terminate the SCT Write Same command with the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field set to 0008h
(i.e., Background SCT command was aborted because of an interrupting host command);
2) if the SCT command being processed in the background is not the SCT Write Same command, the
device shall terminate the SCT command with the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field set to 0000h (i.e.,
Command complete without error); and
3) the device shall begin processing the new ATA command.
8.1.3 Resets
A device shall terminate processing an SCT command during the processing of a software reset, hardware
reset, or power-on reset. Premature termination of SCT command processing may cause data loss or other
indeterminate results. There is no indication after the device becomes ready that the previous command was
terminated.
If the device processes a power-on reset or a hardware reset, then the device shall clear the following fields in
the SCT Status Response (see table 186) to zero:
a) EXTENDED STATUS CODE;
b) ACTION CODE; and
c) FUNCTION CODE.t
The device shall clear the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to zero during processing of a software reset. The other
content of the SCT Status Response fields shall not be affected by the device processing a software reset.
Table 171 — Fields to send an SCT Command using SMART WRITE LOG
Field Description
FEATURE D6h (i.e., SMART WRITE LOG (see 7.48.9))
COUNT 01h (i.e., one page is transferred)
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 172 defines the SCT command format contained in the input data of the WRITE LOG EXT command
(see 7.62) and WRITE LOG DMA EXT command (see 7.63).
Table 172 — Fields to send an SCT Command using GPL write logs
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT 0001h
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 00h a
31:16 Reserved
15:8 00h a
7:0 E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 173 defines how a device shall set the fields for a write to the SCT Command/Status log that returns
command completion without an error.
Field Description
ERROR 00h
COUNT SCT command dependent
LBA SCT command dependent
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 174 defines how a device shall set the fields after an error occurred during processing of an SCT
Command/Status in response to writing the SCT command log.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 SCT command dependent.
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (15:8) (see table 175)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Code Description
0000h Command complete without error
0001h Invalid function code
0002h Input LBA out of range
0003h Request 512-byte data block count overflow. The number of data blocks requested to transfer
(COUNT field) in the log command is larger than specified by the SCT command
0004h Invalid function code in SCT Error Recovery command
0005h Invalid selection code in SCT Error Recovery command
0006h Host read command timer is less than minimum value
0007h Host write command timer is less than minimum value
0008h Background SCT operation was terminated because of an interrupting host command
0009h Background SCT operation was terminated because of unrecoverable error
000Ah Obsolete
000Bh SCT data transfer command was issued without first issuing an SCT command
000Ch Invalid function code in SCT Feature Control command
000Dh Invalid feature code in SCT Feature Control command
000Eh Invalid state value in SCT Feature Control command
000Fh Invalid option flags value in SCT Feature Control command
0010h Invalid SCT action code
0011h Invalid table ID (table not supported)
0012h Operation was terminated due to device security being locked
0013h Invalid revision code in SCT data
0014h Foreground SCT operation was terminated because of unrecoverable error
0015h The most recent non-SCT command returned command completion with an error due to the
SCT Error Recovery Control Read Command Timer or SCT Error Recovery Control Write
Command Timer expiring.
0016h-BEFFh Reserved
BF00h-BFFFh Reserved for Serial ATA
C000h-FFEFh Vendor specific
FFF0h-FFFEh Reserved
FFFFh SCT command processing in background
Table 176 — SCT data transfer using the SMART feature set
Field Description
FEATURE D6h (i.e., SMART WRITE LOG (see 7.48.9))
D5h (i.e., SMART READ LOG (see 7.48.7))
COUNT Number of 512-byte data blocks to transfer
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 E1h (i.e., SCT Data Transfer)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 177 defines an SCT data transfer using GPL feature set commands.
Table 177 — SCT data transfer using the GPL feature set
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT Number of 512-byte data blocks to transfer
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 00h a
31:16 Reserved
15:8 00h a
7:0 E1h (i.e., SCT Data Transfer)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
ERROR 00h
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field – See 8.2.4.2.2
7:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 179 defines the SCT data transfer response for GPL feature set commands (see table 170) that return
command completion without an error.
Field Description
ERROR 00h
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:24 Reserved
23:8 NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field – See 8.2.4.2.2
7:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
Bit Description
27:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (15:8) (see table 175)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 181 defines an SCT data transfer error response for GPL feature set commands (see table 170) that read
from or write to the SCT Data Transfer log.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (7:0) (see table 175)
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (15:8) (see table 175)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 182 — SCT status request using the SMART feature set
Field Description
FEATURE D5h (i.e., SMART READ LOG (see 7.48.7))
COUNT 01h (i.e., one page is transferred)
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 183 defines the GPL feature set commands (see table 170) that read the SCT Command/Status log for
status.
Table 183 — SCT status request using the GPL feature set
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT 0001h (i.e., one page is transferred)
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 00h a
31:16 Reserved
15:8 00h a
7:0 E0h (i.e., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Table 184 defines the SCT Status response for commands from the SMART feature set (see table 170) that
return command completion without an error.
Field Description
ERROR 00h
COUNT EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (7:0) (see table 175)
LBA
Bit Description
27:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (15:8) (see table 175)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 185 defines the SCT Status response for GPL feature set commands (see table 170) that return command
completion without an error.
Field Description
ERROR 00h
COUNT
Bit Description
15:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (7:0) (see table 175)
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:0 EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (15:8) (see table 175)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 186 defines the format of the status response information that shall be set by the device in response to a
read of the SCT Command/Status log.
Table 187 defines the error response for a read of the SCT Command/Status log.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 189 defines the contents of the ACTION CODE field in an SCT key page.
Code Description
0000h Reserved
0001h Obsolete
0002h SCT Write Same command (see 8.3.2)
0003h SCT Error Recovery Control command (see 8.3.3)
0004h SCT Feature Control command (see 8.3.4)
0005h SCT Data Tables command (see 8.3.5)
0006h Vendor specific
0007h Reserved for Serial ATA
0008h..BFFFh Reserved
C000h..FFFFh Vendor specific
If the FUNCTION CODE field is set to 0003h or the FUNCTION CODE field is set to 0103h, the host writes a multiple
logical sector sized pattern to the SCT Data Transfer log. The device indicates the number of log pages it expects
to receive for the multiple logical sector pattern in the NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see 8.2.4.2) of the
status response.
8.3.2.3 Foreground vs. Background Processing
8.3.2.3.1 Background Processing
8.3.2.3.1.1 Get the background pattern from the key page
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) is set to 0001h, the device shall:
1) return command completion for the command that wrote to the SCT Command/Status log (see 8.1.1);
and
2) write the logical sector sized pattern data defined in 8.3.2.3.1.3.
8.3.2.3.1.2 Get the background pattern from the SCT Data Transfer log
To perform a background SCT Write Same command with a data pattern that is not in the key page PATTERN field:
1) if the device processes a key page write log command without error, and the key page FUNCTION CODE
field (see table 190) is set to 0002h or 0003h, then the device shall return command completion for the
command that wrote the key page to the SCT Command/Status log (see 8.1.1) with the:
A) NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see 8.2.4.2) set to the number of log pages to be written to the
SCT Data Transfer log; and
B) EXTENDED STATUS CODE field (see 8.2.3) set to:
a) FFFFh (see table 175), if the device is ready to receive data; or
b) a value other than FFFFh or 0000h, if the device becomes unable to receive the data;
2) while the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field is set to FFFFh, if the device processes a command that writes to
the SCT Data Transfer log, then:
A) if the number of pattern blocks written (i.e., the 512-byte data blocks written to the SCT Data
Transfer log by previous commands plus the data blocks being written by the current command)
is equal to what is required (see 8.3.2.2), then the device shall:
1) return command completion for the command that wrote to the SCT Data Transfer log
(see 8.1.1); and
2) write that the pattern data (see 8.3.2.3.1.3) n the specified logical sectors;
B) if the number of pattern blocks written is more than what is required, the device shall:
1) terminate the SCT Write Same command;
2) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0009h (see table 175); and
3) return command aborted for the command that wrote to the SCT Data Transfer log;
and
C) if the number of pattern blocks written is less than what is required (see 8.3.2.2), the device shall:
1) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to FFFFh;
2) set the NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see 8.2.4.2) to the number of log pages remaining;
and
3) return command completion without error for the command that wrote to the SCT Data Transfer
log.
8.3.2.3.1.3 Write the pattern to the specified logical sectors
While the device is writing the logical sector sized pattern data to the specified logical sectors if the key page
FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) is set to 0001h, 0002h, or 0003h, then:
a) if the device indicates command acceptance for a command to read from the SCT Command/Status log
(i.e., an SCT Status request (see 8.1.1)), then the device shall process the SCT Status request and shall
set:
A) the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to FFFFh (see table 175); and
B) the LBA field (see 8.2.5) to the LBA of the last logical sector that was written;
b) if the device indicates command acceptance for any command other than a read from the SCT
Command/Status log, then the device shall:
1) abort background processing for the SCT Write Same command;
2) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0008h (see table 175); and
3) process the new command;
and
c) if writing to any of the specified logical sector fails, the device shall:
1) abort background processing for the SCT Write Same command; and
2) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0009h (see table 175).
If all specified logical sectors have been written without error, the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field shall be set to
0000h.
8.3.2.3.2 Foreground Processing
8.3.2.3.2.1 Get the foreground pattern from the key page
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) is set to 0101h, then the device shall write the logical sector
sized pattern data as defined in 8.3.2.2 (see 8.3.2.3.2.3).
8.3.2.3.2.2 Get the foreground pattern from the SCT Data Transfer log
To perform a foreground SCT Write Same command with a data pattern:
1) if the device processes a write log command to the SCT command log without error and the key page
FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) is set to 0102h or 0103h, then the device shall return command
completion for the command that wrote to the SCT Command/Status log (see 8.1.1) with the:
A) NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see 8.2.4.2) set to the number of log pages to be written to the
SCT Data Transfer log; and
B) EXTENDED STATUS CODE field set to:
a) FFFFh (see table 175), if the device is ready to receive data; or
b) a value other than FFFFh or 0000h, if the device becomes unable to receive the data;
2) while the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field is set to FFFFh, if the device processes a command that writes to
the SCT Data Transfer log, then:
A) if the number of pattern blocks written (i.e., the 512-byte data blocks written to the SCT Data
Transfer log by previous commands plus the data blocks being written by the current command) is
equal to what is required (see 8.3.2.2), then the device shall write that logical sector sized pattern
data (see 8.3.2.3.2.3);
B) if the number of pattern blocks written is more than what is required (see 8.3.2.2), then the device
shall:
1) terminate the SCT Write Same command;
2) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0014h (see table 175); and
3) return command aborted for the command that wrote to the SCT Data Transfer log;
and
C) if the number of number of pattern blocks written is less than what is required (see 8.3.2.2), then the
device shall:
1) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to FFFFh (see table 175);
2) set the NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see 8.2.4.2) to the number of log pages remaining;
and
3) return command completion without error for the command that wrote to the SCT Data Transfer
log.
8.3.2.3.2.3 Write the pattern to the specified logical sectors
While the device is writing the pattern data to the specified logical sectors, if the key page FUNCTION CODE field is
set to 0101h, 0102h, or 0103h then:
1) if writing to any of the specified logical sectors fails, the device shall:
1) abort processing for the SCT Write Same command;
2) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0014h (see table 175); and
3) return command completion for the command that wrote to the SCT Command/Status log or the
SCT Data Transfer log, indicating the failure (see 8.1.1) of the SCT Write Same command;
and
2) if all specified logical blocks are written without error, the device shall:
1) set the EXTENDED STATUS CODE field to 0000h (see table 175); and
2) return command completion without error for the command that wrote to the SCT Command/Status
log or the SCT Data Transfer log, indicating the success (see 8.1.1) of the SCT Write Same
command.
8.3.2.4 Status Reporting
If the SCT Command returns an error in response to writing the SCT Command/Status log, then table 174
describes the error return.
If the SCT Command returns an error in response to writing the SCT Data log, then:
a) if the error is in response to a SMART read log or write log command, then table 180 describes the error;
or
b) if the error is in response to a GPL read log or write log command, then table 181 describes the error;
8.3.2.5 SEGMENT INITIALIZED bit
The SCT Write Same command may change the SEGMENT INITIALIZED bit in the SCT Status response
(see table 186). If the SCT Write Same command writes all of the user data without error, the SEGMENT
INITIALIZED bit shall be set to one. A write to any user addressable logical sector on the device, except a write
caused by another SCT Write Same command with the START field and the FILL COUNT field cleared to zero
(i.e., an SCT Write Same command causing the device to write to all logical sectors), shall cause the SEGMENT
INITIALIZED bit to be cleared to zero. Reallocations as a result of reading data, either in the foreground or
background, shall not clear the SEGMENT INITIALIZED bit.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field:
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) was set to 0001h or 0101h, this
field shall be set to 0000h.
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field was set to 0002h 0003h, 0102h, or 0103h, this
field shall be set to the number of log pages the device expects for the pattern data.
7:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
NOTE 18 — A failed logical sector may be recovered if the Recovery Time Limit is increased.
NOTE 19 — A host implementor should use the Write Command Timer with caution as a very small timer value
may cause a device to permanently reallocate good logical sectors as the result of temporary, external conditions
(e.g., induced vibration).
The EXTENDED STATUS CODE field shall be cleared when the next non-SCT command is processed by the device,
except when processing a read of the NCQ Command Error log (see A.14).
Read Command Timer value and Write Command Timer value are set to default values after processing a
power-on reset but may be altered by an SCT command at any time. A device shall not change these settings
while processing a hardware reset or a software reset.
Table 193 defines the format of the status response for a SCT Error Recovery Control command.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) was set to 0002h, this is the requested
recovery limit (7:0). Otherwise, this field is reserved.
LBA
Bit Description
27:8 Reserved
7:0 If the key page FUNCTION CODE field was 0002h, this is the requested recovery limit
(15:8). Otherwise, this field is reserved.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
If the FUNCTION CODE field is set to 0001h, the processing performed by the SCT Feature Control command is
defined in table 195 based on the contents of the FEATURE CODE field and the STATE field.
FEATURE
CODE STATE
field field State definition
0000h Reserved
0001h 0001h The SET FEATURES command (see 7.45) shall determine the state of the volatile write
cache (see 7.45.7). This is the default value (see 8.3.4.2) for feature code 0001h.
0002h a Volatile write cache shall be enabled.
0003h a Volatile write cache shall be disabled.
0002h 0001h b Volatile Write Cache Reordering shall be enabled (i.e., disk write scheduling may be
reordered by the device), regardless of the enabled or disabled state of the volatile write
cache. This is the default value (see 8.3.4.2) for feature code 0002h.
0002h b Volatile Write Cache Reordering shall be disabled, and disk write scheduling is
processed on a first-in-first-out (FIFO) basis, regardless of the enabled or disabled state
of the volatile write cache.
0003h 0000h Reserved
0001h.. Set the INTERVAL FIELD in the HDA Temperature History table (see 8.3.5.2) to the larger
FFFFh of:
a) the value in the STATE field; or
b) the contents of the SAMPLE PERIOD field in the HDA Temperature History table.
Clear the HDA Temperature History table as described in 8.3.5.2.2.For feature code
0003h, the default value (see 8.3.4.2) is the value in the SAMPLE PERIOD field in the
HDA Temperature History table (see 8.3.5.2)
0004h.. Reserved for Serial ATA
0005h
0006h.. Reserved
CFFFh
D000h.. Vendor Specific
FFFFh
a
Volatile write cache shall be set to the specified state, and any attempt to change the volatile write cache
settings using a SET FEATURES command shall not result in an error and shall not change the
operational state of the volatile write cache. The VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.4) shall
reflect the current operational state of the volatile write cache (i.e., if set to one, the volatile write cache is
enabled, and if cleared to zero, the volatile write cache is disabled).
b
If volatile write cache is disabled, then the current volatile Write Cache Reordering state has no effect on
writes. The state of volatile Write Cache Reordering has no effect on NCQ commands (see 4.14).
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) was set to 0002h, this field contains the
Feature State (7:0) associated with the Feature Code specified in the key page.
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field was set to 0003h, this field contains the Option Flags (7:0)
associated with the Feature Code specified in the key page.
Otherwise, this field is reserved.
LBA
Bit Description
27:8 Reserved
7:0 If the key page FUNCTION CODE field (see table 190) was set to 0002h, this field
contains the Feature State (15:8) associated with the Feature Code specified in the
key page.
If the key page FUNCTION CODE field was set to 0003h, this field contains the Option
Flags (15:8) associated with the Feature Code specified in the key page.
Otherwise, this field is reserved.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Code Description
0000h Invalid
0001h Reserved
0002h HDA Temperature History table (in degrees Celsius) – See 8.3.5.2
0003h-0004h Reserved for Serial ATA
0005h-CFFFh Reserved
D000h-FFFFh Vendor Specific
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 Reserved
23:8 If the key page TABLE ID field (see table 198) was set to 0002h, this field shall be set
to 0001h (i.e., number of pages requested). Otherwise this field is reserved.
7:0 Reserved.
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
9.1 Overview
The commands listed in clause 7 each have subclauses labeled Normal Outputs and Error Outputs. Subclauses
9.2 and 9.3 document the return data format for all the commands described in clause 7. Each command in
clause 7 may provide additional information about a normal or error output, however, all the information specified
in clause 9 shall also apply to the command.
The references preceding each table indicate each command that generates the output in the table.
Table 202 — Generic Normal Output (No LBA Return Value) for Normal Output
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 203 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.7 and 7.8.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT If Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use was specified (see 7.7),
then this field contains a value as specified in table 38. Otherwise, this field is N/A.
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 204 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.3.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT
Value Description
00h Device is in the:
a) PM2:Standby state (see 4.15.4) and the EPC feature set (see 4.9) is not
enabled; or
b) PM2:Standby state, the EPC feature set is enabled, and the device is in the
Standby_z power condition (see 4.9.2).
01h Device is in the PM2:Standby state, the EPC feature set is enabled, and the device is
in the Standby_y power condition (see 4.9.2).
02h..3Fh Reserved
40h..41h Obsolete
42h..7Fh Reserved
80h Device is in the
a) PM1:Idle state (see 4.15.4) and EPC feature set is not supported; or
b) PM1:Idle state and EPC feature set is supported and the EPC feature set is
disabled.
81h Device is in the PM1:Idle state, the EPC feature set is enable, and the device is in the
Idle_a power condition (see 4.9.2).
82h Device is in the PM1:Idle state, the EPC feature set is enabled, and the device is in
the Idle_b power condition (see 4.9.2).
83h Device is in the PM1:Idle state, the EPC feature set is enabled, and the device is in
the Idle_c power condition (see 4.9.2).
84h..FEh Reserved
FFh Device is in the PM0:Active state or PM1:Idle state.
Field Description
LBA If the LOW POWER STANDBY SUPPORTED bit is set to one (see A.11.5.2.36), then this field is as
described in this table. Otherwise this field is N/A.
Bit Description
27:20 Device is waiting to enter a lower power condition:
Value Description
00h Standby_z
01h Standby_y
02h..80h Reserved
81h Idle_a
81h Idle_b
82h Idle_c
83h..FEh Reserved
FFh Device is not waiting to enter a lower power condition
19 Device is held in the current power condition
18:0 Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 205 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.4, 7.30, and 7.69.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 STREAM ERROR bit – See 6.2.11
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 206 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.6, 7.9, 7.12, and 7.28.
Field Description
ERROR Diagnostic Results – The diagnostic code as described in table 41 is returned.
This field shall be reserved for the DEVICE RESET command (see 7.6). For the READ
SECTOR(S) command (see 7.28), the IDENTIFY DEVICE command (see 7.12), and the
EXECUTE DEVICE DIAGNOSTIC command (see 7.9), bit 2 of this field (i.e., the ABORT bit
(see 6.3.2)) shall be set to one and the remaining bits are N/A.
COUNT
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 For ATAPI devices, the CHECK CONDITION bit – See 6.2.4
For ATA devices, shall be cleared to zero
a
Values not specified in one of these columns are reserved.
Table 207 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.15.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:8 N/A
7:0 C4h
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 208 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.18.6.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
INTERRUPT
REASON
Bit Description
7:2 Obsolete
1 INPUT/OUTPUT bit – See 6.4.3
0 COMMAND/DATA bit – See 6.4.2
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 BYTE COUNT field – See 7.16.5 and 7.16.6
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
6 N/A
5:4 Obsolete
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9. Shall be cleared to zero
Table 209 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.48.5.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8
Value Description
C24Fh The subcommand specified a captive self-test that has completed
without error.
All Other The subcommand specified an off-line routine including an off-line
Values self-test routine.
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 210 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.48.8.
Field Description
ERROR N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8
Value Description
C24Fh The subcommand specified a captive self-test that has completed
without error.
2CF4h The device has detected a threshold exceeded condition
All Other Undefined
Values
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 211 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.2.2, 7.2.3, 7.2.4, 7.5, 7.11, 7.22, 7.24,
7.27, 7.29, 7.33, 7.43, 7.52, 7.54, 7.59, 7.60, 7.62, 7.65, 7.66, and 7.68.
Field Description
ERROR Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 212 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.23.4, 7.43.4 and 7.61.4.
Field Description
ERROR Shall be cleared to zero
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:4 N/A
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 213 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.23.5 and 7.61.5.
Field Description
SATA Transport Dependent
STATUS
ERROR Shall be cleared to zero
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A or ALIGNMENT ERROR bit – See 6.2.2
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
SACTIVE
Bit Description
31:0 Transport dependent completion indicator
Table 214 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.35.
Field Description
ERROR Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:24 Vendor Specific
23:20 Reserved
19:16 SENSE KEY field (see 7.35.4)
15:8 ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE field (see 7.35.4)
7:0 ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE QUALIFIER field (see 7.35.4)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 Reserved
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 215 specifies the normal outputs for the GET NATIVE MAX ADDRESS command defined in 7.2.2.
Field Description
ERROR Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA Maximum LBA
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:4 N/A
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 216 specifies the normal outputs for the commands defined in 7.36.
Field Description
ERROR Reserved
COUNT
Bit Description
15 SANITIZE OPERATION COMPLETED WITHOUT ERROR bit – the contents of the Sanitize
Operation Completed Without Error value (see 4.17.6)
14 1 = the device is in the SD2: Sanitize Operation In Progress state (see 4.17.9.4)
0 = the device is not in the SD2: Sanitize Operation In Progress state
13 1 = the device is in the SD1: Sanitize Frozen state (see 4.17.9.3)
0 = the device is not in the SD1: Sanitize Frozen state
12 SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE bit – the contents of the Sanitize Antifreeze value (see 4.17.8)
11:0 Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:16 Reserved
15:0 SANITIZE PROGRESS INDICATION field – This value indicates the fraction complete of
the sanitize operation while the device is in the SD2: Sanitize Operation In Progress
state (see 4.17.9.4). The value is a numerator that has 65 536 (1_0000h) as its
denominator. This value shall be set to FFFFh if the device is not in the SD2: Sanitize
Operation In Progress state (i.e., a sanitize operation is not in process).
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 217 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.1.9.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:4 N/A
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 218 specifies the error outputs for the command defined in 7.3.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4:2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 219 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.2.2, 7.2.4, 7.14, 7.15, 7.35, 7.38, 7.40,
7.43.4, 7.45.5, 7.45.20.2.4, 7.45.20.3.4, 7.45.20.4.5, 7.45.20.5.4, 7.46, 7.47, 7.48.2, 7.48.3, 7.48.4, 7.48.8, 7.49,
7.50, and 7.71.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 220 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.7, 7.12.6, 7.13, 7.19, 7.37, 7.39, 7.41, 7.42,
7.43.4, and 7.56.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 221 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.52 and 7.54.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 222 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.4.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 STREAM ERROR bit – See 6.2.11
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 223 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.10.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 224 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.11.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
COUNT Reserved
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 225 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.22.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9.
5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 226 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.24.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9
5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 227 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.21, 7.26, 7.28, and 7.32.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9
5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 Obsolete
COUNT N/A
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 228 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.30.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9.
5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 Obsolete
0 COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit – See 6.3.3
COUNT Length of stream error – number of contiguous logical sectors containing potentially bad data,
beginning with the LBA indicated in the LBA field.
LBA LBA of the lowest numbered unrecoverable error
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 STREAM ERROR bit – See 6.2.11.
4 DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit – See 6.2.6.
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 229 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.48.9.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 230 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.5 and 7.62.
Table 230 — Write Log Ext Error or Data Set Management Error
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 231 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.48.5.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8
Value Description
C24Fh Subcommand specified a captive self-test and some error other than a
self-test routine failure occurred (i.e., if the sub-command is not
supported or field values are invalid)
2CF4h the subcommand specified a captive self-test routine that has failed
during processing.
All Other the subcommand specified an off-line routine including an off-line
Values self-test routine.
7:0 N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 232 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.59, 7.60, 7.65, 7.66 and 7.68.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 Obsolete.
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 Obsolete
0 N/A
COUNT Reserved
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 233 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.69.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 Obsolete
0 COMMAND COMPLETION TIME OUT bit – See 6.3.3
COUNT Length of stream error – number of contiguous logical sectors containing potentially bad data,
beginning with the LBA indicated in the LBA field.
LBA LBA of the lowest numbered unrecoverable error
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 STREAM ERROR bit – See 6.2.11
4 DEFERRED WRITE ERROR bit – See 6.2.6
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9.
Table 234 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.17.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 N/A
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 235 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.18.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:4 Sense Key – See 6.3.8
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 END OF MEDIA bit – See 6.3.4
0 ILLEGAL LENGTH INDICATOR bit – See 6.3.6
INTERRUPT
REASON
Bit Description
7:2 Obsolete
1 Input/Output – See 6.4.3. Shall be set to one
0 Command/Data – See 6.4.2. Shall be set to one
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 N/A
4 Obsolete.
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 CHECK CONDITION bit – See 6.2.4.
Table 236 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.48.6 and 7.48.7.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9
5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 237 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.27, 7.29 and 7.33.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9.
5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 238 specifies the error outputs for the command defined in 7.2.3.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:5 N/A
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1 N/A
0 Obsolete
COUNT Reserved
LBA Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 239 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.64 and 7.67.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2.
1 Obsolete
0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 240 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.58.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2.
1:0 Obsolete
COUNT N/A
LBA LBA of First Unrecoverable Error (see 6.8.2)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 241 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.23.6 and 7.61.6.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7.
6:3 N/A
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2.
1:0 N/A
COUNT N/A
LBA N/A
DEVICE
Bit Description
7:4 N/A
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Table 242 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.61.6.
Field Description
SATA Transport Dependent
STATUS
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6:5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 Obsolete
STATUS
Bit Description
7 Shall be cleared to zero
6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Shall be cleared to zero.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
SACTIVE
Bit Description
31:0 Transport dependent completion indicator
Table 243 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.23.6.
Field Description
SATA Transport Dependent
STATUS
ERROR
Bit Description
7 INTERFACE CRC bit – See 6.3.7
6 UNCORRECTABLE ERROR bit – See 6.3.9
5 Obsolete
4 ID NOT FOUND bit – See 6.3.5
3 Obsolete
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2
1:0 Obsolete
STATUS
Bit Description
7 Shall be cleared to zero
6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Shall be cleared to zero.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
SACTIVE
Bit Description
31:0 Transport dependent completion indicator
Table 244 specifies the error outputs for the commands defined in 7.36.
Field Description
ERROR
Bit Description
7:3 Reserved
2 ABORT bit – See 6.3.2.
1:0 Reserved
COUNT Reserved
LBA
Bit Description
47:8 Reserved
7:0 SANITIZE DEVICE ERROR REASON field
Value Description
00h Reason not reported or sanitize device command failed
01h Sanitize Command Unsuccessful – The sanitize operation completed with
physical sectors that are available to be allocated for user data that were
not successfully sanitized.
02h Invalid or unsupported value in the Sanitize Device FEATURE field
03h Device is in the SD1: Sanitize Frozen state (see 4.17.9.3)
04h SANITIZE FREEZE LOCK command failed as a result of the Sanitize
Antifreeze Lock value (see 4.17.8) being set to one
05h..FFh Reserved
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
STATUS
Bit Description
7:6 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
5 DEVICE FAULT bit – See 6.2.7
4 N/A
3 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12.
2 N/A
1 SENSE DATA AVAILABLE bit – See 6.2.10
0 ERROR bit – See 6.2.9
Annex A
(Normative)
Log Definitions
A.1 Overview
This Annex provides a description of all logs. All logs are optional unless otherwise specified. These logs are
accessible via commands (see 7.24, 7.25, 7.48.7, 7.48.9, 7.62, 7.63). Table A.2 is a summary of these logs. The
following terms are associated with logs:
a) name: the log name is a term that describes the data in the associated log;
b) address: each log name has an associated numeric value that is the log address; and
c) log page: each log is composed or one or more log pages and each page has a page number.
The LOG ADDRESS field is used by read log commands and write log commands to access a specific log.
Table A.1 shows an example layout of logs. Data transfer associated with the SMART READ LOG command and
the SMART WRITE LOG command starts from the first log page (i.e., log page number zero). GPL feature set
(see 4.11) commands allow the host to specify the starting log page number using the PAGE NUMBER field.
Log
Log Name Address Log pages
Log Directory 00h log page 0 (the Log Directory only has one 512-byte log
page)
Host Specific 80h Log page 0 (first 512-byte log page)
(see A.10) Log page 1 (second 512-byte log page)
…
Log page 15 (last 512-byte log page)
Host Specific 81h Log page 0 (first 512-byte log page)
Log page 1 (second 512-byte log page)
…
Log page 15 (last 512-byte log page)
…
Host Specific 9Fh Log page 0 (first 512-byte log page)
Log page 1 (second 512-byte log page)
…
Log page 15 (last 512-byte log page)
The contents of the General Purpose Log Directory shall only change after the device processes a:
a) power-on reset;
b) hardware reset;
c) DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command (see 7.7); or
d) DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command (see 7.8).
Table A.3 defines the 255 words contained in the General Purpose Log Directory.
Word Description
0 General Purpose Logging Version a
1 Number of log pages at log address 01h
2 Number of log pages at log address 02h
3 Number of log pages at log address 03h
4 Number of log pages at log address 04h
…
128 Number of log pages at log address 80h
129 Number of log pages at log address 81h
…
255 Number of log pages at log address FFh
a
This word shall be set to 0001h.
The contents of the SMART Log Directory shall only change after the device processes a:
a) power-on reset;
b) hardware reset;
c) DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command (see 7.7); or
d) DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command (see 7.8).
Table A.4 defines the 512-bytes that make up the SMART Log Directory. The SMART Log Directory is defined as
one log page.
Offset Description
0..1 SMART Logging Version (word)
2 Number of log pages at log address 1
3 Reserved
4 Number of log pages at log address 2
5 Reserved
… …
510 Number of log pages at log address 255
511 Reserved
The value of the SMART Logging Version word shall be 0001h if the device supports multi-block SMART logs.
If the device does not support multi-block SMART logs, then log address 00h is defined as reserved.
A.4.1 Overview
Table A.5 defines the format of each of the log pages that are part of the Comprehensive SMART Error log. The
Comprehensive SMART Error log provides logging for 28-bit addressing only. For 48-bit addressing, see A.7.
The maximum size of the Comprehensive SMART Error log shall be 51 log pages. Devices may support fewer
than 51 log pages. The comprehensive error log data structures:
a) shall include Uncorrectable errors;
b) shall include ID Not Found errors for which the LBA requested was valid;
c) shall include servo errors;
d) shall include write fault errors; and
e) other error conditions.
Comprehensive SMART Error log data structures shall not include errors attributed to the receipt of faulty
commands (e.g., command codes not supported by the device or requests with invalid parameters or invalid
LBAs).
The value of the SMART error log version byte shall be set to 01h.
The error log index indicates the error log data structure representing the most recent error. If there have been no
error log entries, then the error log index shall be cleared to zero. Valid values for the error log index are zero to
255.
The error log is a circular buffer (i.e., when the last supported error log block has been filled, the next error shall
create an error log data structure that replaces the first error log data structure in log page zero. The next error
after that shall create an error log data structure that replaces the second error log data structure, etc.).
The device may support from two to 51 error log blocks.
The error log index indicates the most recent error log data structure. Unused error log data structures shall be
filled with zeros.
The content of the error log data structure entries is defined in A.21.4.
A.5.1 Overview
Each device statistic shall be one QWord in length and have the format shown in table A.7.
Bits Description
63:56 DEVICE STATISTICS FLAGS field (see table A.8)
55:0 The device statistic's value that is comprised of one
to 56 bits with the least significant bit in bit zero
59 MONITORED V 1 = The monitored condition set for this device statistic is met (see A.25).
CONDITION 0 = The monitored condition set for this device statistic is not met.
MET
58..56 Reserved
Key:
F/V – Fixed/variable content
F – The content of the field is fixed and does not change.
V – The contents of the field is variable and may change depending on the state of the device
or the commands processed by the device.
The following update criteria apply to all supported statistics unless explicitly stated otherwise:
a) a set of all statistics shall reside in a non-volatile location;
b) the device may maintain a set of current statistics that is volatile. The current statistics may differ from
those saved in non-volatile locations;
c) unless otherwise stated, if a device statistic's value (see table A.7) that increments reaches its
maximum, then the device statistic's value shall remain at the maximum;
d) for the Device Statistics log pages read, the device shall save all statistics whose values have changed
to a non-volatile location when the device processes a command to read the Device Statistics log;
e) the device shall save all statistics whose values have changed to a non-volatile location before entering
PM2:Standby state (see 4.15.4) or any power management state (see 4.15.4) where the media is not
accessible to the host;
f) there may be a statistic update timer that periodically causes a statistic to be copied to a non-volatile
location (i.e., update interval);
g) while the device is in the PM3:Sleep state (see 4.15.4):
A) the current statistics shall not be updated to the non-volatile locations;
B) the associated statistic update timers shall not continue operation; and
C) the device shall not exit PM3:Sleep state to update the non-volatile statistics;
h) while the device is in the PM2:Standby state (see 4.15.4):
A) the current statistics may be saved to the non-volatile locations;
B) if the statistics are saved to the non-volatile locations, then the associated statistic update timers
shall be re-initialized and shall continue operation while in the PM2:Standby state;
C) if the statistics are not saved to the non-volatile locations, then the associated statistic update timers
shall not continue operation while in the PM2:Standby state; and
D) the device shall not exit PM2:Standby state to update the non-volatile statistics;
and
i) while the device is in the PM0:Active state (see 4.15.4) or PM1:Idle state (see 4.15.4), if the statistics
update timer expires and:
A) a statistic value has not changed, then the device shall:
a) save the statistic to a non-volatile location; and
b) re-initialize the associated statistic update timer;
or
B) a statistic’s value has changed and:
a) a command is not being processed, then the device shall save the updated statistic to a
non-volatile location and re-initialize the associated statistic update timer; or
b) a command is being processed, then the device:
A) should save the updated statistic to a non-volatile location during command processing, and
if the statistic is saved, then the device server shall re-initialize the associated statistic
update timer; and
B) shall, before processing the next command, save the updated statistic to a non-volatile
location and re-initialize the associated statistic update timer.
A.5.2 List of Supported Device Statistics log pages (log page 00h)
The List of Supported Device Statistics log pages contains a list of the supported Device Statistics log pages as
described in table A.9. If the Device Statistics log is supported and any Device Statistics log page other than the
General Statics log page (see A.5.4) is supported, then this Device Statistics log page shall be implemented.
Entries shall be in order of ascending log page number. Every log page for which there is at least one supported
statistic shall be listed.
A.5.3.1 Overview
The Free Fall Statistics log page contains free-fall information as described in table A.10.
The Free Fall statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Number of Free-Fall Events Detected; and
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.10) for this log page.
A.5.3.3.1 Description
The Number of Free-Fall Events Detected statistic is a counter that records the number of free-fall events
detected by the device. This statistic is incremented by one for each free-fall event detected.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.3.3.4 Initialization
A.5.3.4.1 Description
The Overlimit Shock Events statistic is a counter that records the number of shock events detected by the device
with the magnitude higher than the maximum rating of the device. This statistic is incremented by one for each
event detected.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.3.4.4 Initialization
A.5.4.1 Overview
The General Statistics log page contains general information about the device as described in table A.11.
The General Statistics statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Lifetime Power-on Resets;
c) Power-on Hours;
d) Logical Sectors Written;
e) Number of Write Commands;
f) Logical Sectors Read; and
g) Number of Read Commands.
The Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.11) for this log page.
A.5.4.3.1 Description
Lifetime Power-On Resets is a counter that records the number of times that the device has processed a
power-on reset.
Lifetime Power-On Resets is incremented by one after processing each Power-On Reset and the device is
capable of recording this statistic.
Events.
A.5.4.3.4 Initialization
A.5.4.4.1 Description
The Power-on Hours statistic is a value that records the amount of time that the device has been operational
since the device was manufactured. The device:
a) shall increment this statistic while it is in PM0:Active state (see 4.15.4);
b) shall increment this statistic while it is in PM1:Idle state (see 4.15.4);
c) should increment this statistic while it is in the PM2:Standby state (see 4.15.4); and
d) shall not increment this statistic while it is in PM3:Sleep state (see 4.15.4).
This statistic is incremented in a volatile location with a resolution of one minute or less. This volatile value is
accumulated into a non-volatile location per the update interval.
One hour.
Hours.
A.5.4.4.4 Initialization
A.5.4.5.1 Description
The Logical Sectors Written statistic is a value that records the number of logical sectors received from the host.
This statistic is incremented by one for each logical sector that was received from the host without an error.
One hour.
Logical sectors.
A.5.4.5.4 Initialization
A.5.4.6.1 Description
The Number of Write Commands statistic is the number of write commands that returned command completion
without an error. This statistic is incremented by one for each write command that returns command completion
without an error.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.4.6.4 Initialization
A.5.4.7.1 Description
The Logical Sectors Read statistic is a value that records the number of logical sectors sent to the host. This
statistic is incremented by one for each logical sector that was sent to the host without an error.
One hour.
Logical sectors.
A.5.4.7.4 Initialization
A.5.4.8.1 Description
The Number of Read Commands statistic is the number of read commands that returned command completion
without an error. This statistic is incremented by one for each read command that returns command completion
without an error.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.4.8.4 Initialization
A.5.4.9.1 Description
None.
Milliseconds.
A.5.4.9.4 Initialization
After each power-on reset, this statistic shall be set to the value in the Power-on Hours statistic (see A.5.4.4) with
the hours unit of measure changed to milliseconds.
A.5.5.1 Overview
General Errors Statistics log page contains general error information about the device as described in table A.12.
The General Errors Statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Number of Reported Uncorrectable Errors; and
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.12) for this log page.
A.5.5.3.1 Description
The Number of Reported Uncorrectable Errors statistic is a counter that records the number of errors that are
reported as an Uncorrectable Error (see 6.3.9). This statistic shall be incremented by one for each event.
Uncorrectable errors that occur during background activity shall not be counted. Uncorrectable errors reported by
reads to flagged uncorrectable (see 7.71.2) logical blocks should not be counted.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.5.3.4 Initialization
A.5.5.4.1 Description
The Number of Resets Between Command Acceptance and Command Completion statistic is a counter that
records the number of software reset or hardware reset events that occur while one or more commands have
been accepted by the device but have not reached command completion. This statistic shall be incremented by
one for each event.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.5.4.4 Initialization
A.5.6.1 Overview
The Rotating Media Statics log page contains device rotating media information as described in table A.13.
The Rotating Media Statics statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Spindle Motor Power-on Hours;
c) Head Flying Hours;
d) Head Loaded Events;
e) Number of Reallocated Logical Sectors;
f) Read Recovery Attempts;
g) Number of Mechanical Start Failures;
h) Number of Reallocation Candidate Logical Sectors; and
i) Number of High Priority Unload Events.
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.13) for this log page.
A.5.6.3.1 Description
The Spindle Motor Power-on Hours statistic is a value that records the amount of time that the spindle motor has
been powered on since the device was manufactured. This statistic is incremented in a volatile location with a
resolution of one minute or less. This volatile value is accumulated into a non-volatile location per the update
interval.
One hour.
Hours.
A.5.6.3.4 Initialization
A.5.6.4.1 Description
The Head Flying Hours statistic is a value that records number of hours that the device heads have been flying
over the surface of the media since the device was manufactured. This statistic is incremented in a volatile
location with a resolution of one minute or less. This volatile value is accumulated into a non-volatile location per
the update interval.
One hour.
Hours.
A.5.6.4.4 Initialization
A.5.6.5.1 Description
The Head Load Events statistic is a value that records the number of head load events. A head load event is
defined as:
a) when the heads are loaded from the ramp to the media for a ramp load device; or
b) when the heads take off from the landing zone for a contact start stop device.
This statistic is incremented by one each time a head load event occurs.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.6.5.4 Initialization
The Number of Reallocated Logical Sectors statistic is a counter that records the number of logical sectors that
have been reallocated after device manufacture. This statistic shall incremented by one for each logical sector.
One hour.
Logical sectors.
A.5.6.6.3 Initialization
A.5.6.7.1 Description
Read Recovery Attempts is a counter that records the number of logical sectors that require three or more
attempts to read the data from the media for each read command. This statistic shall be incremented by one for
each logical sector that encounters a read recovery attempt. These events may be caused by external
environmental conditions (e.g., operating in a moving vehicle).
One hour.
Events.
A.5.6.7.4 Initialization
A.5.6.8.1 Description
The Number of Mechanical Start Failures statistic is a counter that records the number of mechanical start
failures after device manufacture. A mechanical start failure is a failure that prevents the device from achieving a
normal operating condition. This statistic shall be incremented by one for each mechanical start failure event
encountered.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.6.8.4 Initialization
A.5.6.9.1 Description
The number of Reallocation Candidate Logical Sectors statistic is a counter that records the number of logical
sectors that are candidates for reallocation. A reallocation candidate sector is a logical sector that the device has
determined may need to be reallocated. This statistic is incremented by one for each logical sector that is
determined to be a candidate for reallocation. The counter shall be decremented by one for each logical sector
that is removed from the candidate sector list (e.g., by reallocation, repair, or transient condition). Logical sectors
marked as pseudo uncorrectable (see 7.71) shall be considered reallocation candidates. Logical sectors marked
as flagged uncorrectable (see 7.71) should not be considered reallocation candidates.
One hour.
Logical sectors.
A.5.6.9.4 Initialization
A.5.6.10.1 Description
The Number of High Priority Load Events statistic is a value that records the number of emergency head unload
events. An emergency head unload event is defined as:
a) when the heads are loaded from the ramp to the media for a ramp load device; or
b) when the heads take off from the landing zone for a contact start stop device,
in response to one of the following events:
a) processing an IDLE IMMEDIATE command with the unload feature (see 7.15.4);
b) unexpected power loss;
c) device initiated self-protection (e.g., Free-fall Control feature set (see 4.10)); or
d) other notification from the host (e.g. SATA pin P11, SATA Direct Head Unload (see SATA 3.1).
This statistic is incremented by one each time an high priority head unload event occurs.
One hour.
Events.
A.5.6.10.4 Initialization
A.5.7.1 Overview
The Solid State Device Statistics log page contains solid state device information about the device as described
in table A.14.
The Solid State Device Statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header; and
b) Percentage Used Endurance Indicator.
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.14) for this log page.
A.5.7.3.1 Description
The Percentage Used Endurance Indicator is an vendor specific estimate of the percentage of device life used
based on the actual device usage and the manufacturer's prediction of device life. A value of 100 indicates that
the estimated endurance of the device has been consumed, but may not indicate a device failure (e.g., minimum
power-off data retention capability reached for devices using NAND flash technology). The value is allowed to
exceed 100. The volatile value shall be updated once per power-on hour independent of the update interval
specified below. Percentages greater than 254 shall be represented as 255.
One hour.
Percent.
A.5.7.3.4 Initialization
A.5.8.1 Overview
The Temperature Statistics log page contains general information about the device as described in table A.15.
The value in the temperature field is a two’s complement integer in degrees Celsius.
The Temperature Statistics are as followed:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Current Temperature;
c) Average Short Term Temperature;
d) Average Long Term Temperature;
e) Highest Temperature;
f) Lowest Temperature;
g) Highest Average Short Term Temperature;
h) Lowest Average Short Term Temperature;
i) Highest Average Long Term Temperature;
j) Lowest Average Long Term Temperature;
k) Time in Over-Temperature;
l) Specified Maximum Operating Temperature;
m) Time in Under-Temperature; and
n) Specified Minimum Operating Temperature.
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.15) for this log page.
A.5.8.3.1 Description
The Current Temperature statistic is the temperature measured by the device at the time this log page is read.
None.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.3.4 Initialization
None.
A.5.8.4.1 Description
The Average Short Term Temperature statistic is a value based on the most recent 144 temperature samples in a
24 hour period. The device enters the current temperature sample into the Average Short Term Temperature
FIFO once every nominal ten minutes period. The Average Short Term Temperature FIFO consists of at least
144 temperature entries (i.e., 24 recorded hours). This statistic is calculated by averaging the last 144 Average
Short Term Temperature FIFO entries.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.4.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 144 temperature samples.
A.5.8.5.1 Description
The Average Long Term Temperature statistic is a value based on the most recent 42 Average Short Term
Temperature values. The device enters the current value of the Average Short Term Temperature into the
Average Long Term Temperature FIFO once every nominal 24 hour period. The Average Long Term
Temperature FIFO consists of at least 42 temperature entries (i.e., 1 008 recorded hours). This statistic is
calculated by averaging the last 42 Average Long Term Temperature FIFO entries.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius
A.5.8.5.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 42 Average Short Term Temperature data
samples.
A.5.8.6.1 Description
The Highest Temperature statistic is the highest temperature measured after the device is manufactured. This
data is calculated by comparing the current temperature value and the Highest Temperature value and storing
the higher value. The comparison shall occur when a new temperature value is entered into the Average Short
Term Temperature FIFO.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.6.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects the first Average Short Term Temperature
data sample.
A.5.8.7.1 Description
The Lowest Temperature statistic is the lowest temperature measured after the device is manufactured. This
data is calculated by comparing the current temperature value and the Lowest Temperature value and storing the
lower value. The comparison shall occur when a new temperature value is entered into the Average Short Term
Temperature FIFO.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.7.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects the first Average Short Term Temperature
data sample.
A.5.8.8.1 Description
The Highest Average Short Term Temperature statistic is a value that records the highest device Average Short
Term Temperature after the device is manufactured. This data is calculated by comparing the current Average
Short Term Temperature value and the Highest Average Short Term Temperature value and storing the higher
value.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.8.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 144 temperature samples.
A.5.8.9.1 Description
The Lowest Average Short Term Temperature statistic is a value that records the lowest device Average Short
Term Temperature after the device is manufactured. This data is calculated by comparing the current Average
Short Term Temperature value and the Lowest Average Short Term Temperature value and storing the lower
value.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.9.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 144 temperature samples.
A.5.8.10.1 Description
The Highest Average Long Term Temperature statistic is a value that records the highest device Average Long
Term Temperature after the device is manufactured. This data is calculated by comparing the current Average
Long Term Temperature value and the Highest Average Long Term Temperature value and storing the higher
value.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius
A.5.8.10.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 42 Average Short Term Temperature data
samples.
A.5.8.11.1 Description
The Lowest Average Long Term Temperature statistic is a value that records the lowest device Average Long
Term Temperature after the device is manufactured. This data is calculated by comparing the current Average
Long Term Temperature value and the Lowest Average Long Term Temperature value and storing the lower
value.
One hour.
Degrees Celsius
A.5.8.11.4 Initialization
This statistic is not initialized at the time of manufacture. The VALID VALUE bit (see table A.8) shall not be set to
one and the data in bits 7:0 are not valid until after the device collects 42 Average Short Term Temperature data
samples.
A.5.8.12.1 Description
The Time in Over-Temperature statistic is a value that records the nominal amount of time that the device has
been operational in an environment that exceeds the device’s specified Maximum Operating Temperature
(see A.5.8.13) since the device was manufactured.
The nominal sampling time of the temperature is ten minutes. This statistic is calculated by adding ten minutes
for each sample taken that exceeds the temperature limit. This statistic is recorded in minutes of
over-temperature operation. This statistic records the number of minutes that the device has been operational
while the device temperature specification has been exceeded.
One hour.
Minutes.
A.5.8.12.4 Initialization
A.5.8.13.1 Description
The Specified Maximum Operating Temperature is a value that reports the maximum operating temperature
device is designed to operate. This value is used for the calculation of the Time in Over-Temperature statistic.
None.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.13.4 Initialization
A.5.8.14.1 Description
The Time in Under-Temperature statistic is a value that records the nominal amount of time that the device has
been operational in an environment that goes below the device’s specified minimum operating temperature
(see A.5.8.15) since the device was manufactured.
The nominal sampling time of the temperature is ten minutes. This statistic is calculated by adding ten minutes
for each sample taken that goes below the temperature limit. This statistic is recorded in minutes of
over-temperature operation. This statistic records the number of minutes that the device has been operational
while the temperature is lower than the device minimum temperature specification.
One hour.
Minutes.
A.5.8.14.4 Initialization
A.5.8.15.1 Description
The Specified Minimum Operating Temperature is a value that reports the minimum operating temperature
device is designed to operate. This value is used for the calculation of the Time in Under-Temperature statistic.
None.
Degrees Celsius.
A.5.8.15.4 Initialization
A.5.9.1 Overview
The Transport Statistics log page contains interface transport information about the device as described in
table A.16.
The Transport Statistics are as follows:
a) Device Statistics Information Header;
b) Number of hardware resets;
c) Number of ASR Events; and
d) Number of Interface CRC Errors.
Device Statistics Information Header indicates the format of the structure (see table A.16) for this log page.
A.5.9.3.1 Description
The Number of hardware resets statistic is the number of hardware resets received by the device. This statistic is
incremented by one for each hardware reset. For SATA devices, this includes all COMRESETs regardless of
whether the Software Settings Preservation feature set (see 4.21) is enabled or not.
Ten minutes.
Events.
A.5.9.3.4 Initialization
A.5.9.4.1 Description
The Number of ASR Events statistic is a counter that records the number of ASR events (see SATA 3.1). This
statistic is incremented by one for each ASR event detected.
Ten minutes.
Events.
A.5.9.4.4 Initialization
A.5.9.5.1 Description
The Number of Interface CRC Errors statistic is a counter that records the number of Interface CRC errors
(see 6.3.7) reported in the ERROR field since the device was manufactured. This statistic is incremented by one
for each Interface CRC error reported in the ERROR field.
Ten minutes.
Events.
A.5.9.5.4 Initialization
Device Vendor Specific logs may be used by the device vendor to store any data and need only be implemented
if used.
A.7.1 Overview
Table A.17 defines the format of each of the log pages that define the Extended Comprehensive SMART Error
log. The maximum size of the Extended Comprehensive SMART Error log is 16 383 log pages. Devices may
support fewer than 16 383 log pages. Error log data structures shall include, but are not limited to, Uncorrectable
errors (see 6.3.9), ID Not Found errors (see 6.3.5) for which the LBA requested was valid, servo errors, and write
fault errors. Error log data structures shall not include errors attributed to the receipt of faulty commands (e.g.,
command codes not implemented by the device or requests with invalid parameters or invalid LBAs).
All 28-bit entries contained in the Comprehensive SMART log (see A.4), shall also be included in the Extended
Comprehensive SMART Error log with the 48-bit entries.
The value of the SMART error log version byte shall be 01h.
The error log index is the error log data structure number representing the most recent error. If there have been
no error log entries, the error log index is cleared to zero.
A.7.4.1 Overview
The Extended Comprehensive SMART Error log is viewed as a circular buffer. The error log index indicates the
most recent error log data structure. Unused error log data structures shall be filled with zeros.
The content of the error log data structure entries is defined in Table A.18.
Offset Description
n..n+17 First command data structure
n+18..n+35 Second command data structure
n+36..n+53 Third command data structure
n+54..n+71 Fourth command data structure
n+72..n+89 Fifth command data structure
n+90..n+123 Error data structure
content of byte n shall be FFh, the content of bytes n+1 through n+13 are vendor specific, and the content of
bytes n+14 through n+17 shall contain the timestamp.
Offset Description
n Content of the Device Control field when the Command was initiated.
n+1 Content of the FEATURE field (7:0) when the Command was initiated.
n+2 Content of the FEATURE field (15:8) when the Command was initiated.
n+3 Content of the COUNT field (7:0) when the Command was initiated.
n+4 Content of the COUNT field (15:8) when the Command was initiated.
n+5 Content of the LBA field (7:0) when the Command was initiated.
n+6 Content of the LBA field (31:24) when the Command was initiated.
n+7 Content of the LBA field (15:8) when the Command was initiated.
n+8 Content of the LBA field (39:32) when the Command was initiated.
n+9 Content of the LBA field (23:16) when the Command was initiated.
n+10 Content of the LBA field (47:40) when the Command was initiated.
n+11 Content of the DEVICE field when the Command was initiated.
n+12 Content written to the Command field when the command was initiated
n+13 Reserved
n+14..n+17 Timestamp (DWord) shall be the time since power-on in milliseconds
when command acceptance occurred. This timestamp may wrap.
The error data structure shall contain the error description of the command for which an error was reported as
described in Table A.20. If the error was logged for a hardware reset, the content of bytes n+1 through n+11 shall
be vendor specific and the remaining bytes shall be as defined in Table A.20.
Offset Description
Transport specific value when the Command was initiated. See the
n
appropriate transport standard, reference Device Control field.
n+1 Content of the ERROR field (7:0) after command completion occurred.
n+2 Content of the COUNT field (7:0) after command completion occurred.
n+3 Content of the COUNT field (15:8) after command completion occurred.
n+4 Content of the LBA field (7:0) when the command completion occurred.
n+5 Content of the LBA field (31:24) when the command completion occurred.
n+6 Content of the LBA field (15:8) when the command completion occurred.
n+7 Content of the LBA field (39:32) when the command completion occurred.
n+8 Content of the LBA field (23:16) when the command completion occurred.
n+9 Content of the LBA field (47:40) when the command completion occurred.
n+10 Content of the DEVICE field after command completion occurred.
n+11 Content written to the STATUS field after command completion occurred.
n+12..n+30 Extended error information
n+31 State
n+32..n+33 Life timestamp (word)
Value a State
x0h Unknown
x1h Sleep
x2h Standby
x3h Active/Idle
x4h Executing SMART off-line or self-test
x5h-xAh Reserved
xBh-xFh Vendor specific
a
The value of x is vendor specific and may be different for each
state.
Sleep indicates the reset for which the error being reported was received when the device was in the Sleep
mode.
Standby indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported was received when the device was in
the Standby mode.
Active/Idle indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported was received when the device was
in the Active or Idle mode.
Executing SMART off-line or self-test indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported was
received when the device was processing a SMART off-line or self-test.
Life timestamp shall contain the power-on lifetime of the device in hours when command completion occurred.
The Device error count word shall contain the total number of errors attributable to the device that have been
reported by the device during the life of the device (e.g., Uncorrectable errors (see 6.3.9), ID Not Found errors
(see 6.3.5) for which the LBA requested was valid, servo errors, write fault errors). This device error count shall
not include errors attributed to the receipt of faulty commands (e.g., command codes not implemented by the
device or requests with invalid parameters or invalid LBAs). If the maximum value for this field is reached, then
the count shall remain at the maximum value if additional errors are encountered and logged.
The data structure checksum is the two’s complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with unsigned arithmetic, and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes shall be
zero when the checksum is correct. The checksum is placed in byte 511.
A.8.1 Overview
If the Extended Power Conditions feature set is supported, then the Power Conditions log shall be supported. If
the Extended Power Conditions feature set (see 4.9) is not supported, then the Power Conditions log shall not be
supported.
The Power Conditions log is non-volatile.
Table A.22 defines log page 00h of the Power Conditions log. The format of each Idle power condition descriptor
is shown in table A.24.
Table A.23 defines log page 01h of the Power Conditions log. The format of each Standby power condition
descriptor is shown in table A.24.
Table A.24 defines the Power Conditions log descriptor. Each power condition has its own descriptor.
The POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit is valid if the EPC feature set is supported, regardless of whether EPC is
enabled or disabled.
If the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the power condition is supported. If the POWER
CONDITION SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the power condition is not supported.
The POWER CONDITION SAVEABLE bit is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
If the POWER CONDITION SAVEABLE bit is set to one, then the power condition is saveable if EPC is enabled. If the
POWER CONDITION SAVEABLE bit is cleared to zero, then the power condition is not saveable.
The POWER CONDITION CHANGEABLE bit is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
If the POWER CONDITION CHANGEABLE bit is set to one, then the power condition is changeable if EPC is enabled.
If the POWER CONDITION CHANGEABLE bit is cleared to zero, then the power condition is not changeable
The DEFAULT TIMER ENABLED bit is set at the time of manufacture. The DEFAULT TIMER ENABLED bit may be copied
to the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit (see A.8.4.7) during the processing of a SET FEATURES command with:
a) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
b) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The DEFAULT TIMER ENABLED bit is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
The SAVED TIMER ENABLED bit may be set to the value in the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit (see A.8.4.7) during the
processing of a SET FEATURES command with:
a) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
b) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The SAVED TIMER ENABLED bit:
a) is copied to the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit during the processing of a power-on reset (see 4.9.4); and
b) may be copied to the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit during the processing of a SET FEATURES command
with:
A) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
B) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The SAVED TIMER ENABLED bit is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
If EPC is disabled, then the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero.
If EPC is enabled and the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field (see A.8.4.11) is non-zero and the CURRENT TIMER
ENABLED bit is set to one, then the power condition timer is enabled.
If EPC is enabled and the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the power condition timer is
disabled.
The HOLD POWER CONDITION NOT SUPPORTED bit is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set
to one and the LOW POWER STANDBY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.36) is set to one, whether EPC is enabled or
disabled.
If the HOLD POWER CONDITION NOT SUPPORTED bit is valid and cleared to zero, then the device supports the Hold
Power Condition parameter of the EPC Go To Power Condition subcommand (see 7.45.20.3) for this power
condition.
If the HOLD POWER CONDITION NOT SUPPORTED bit is valid and set to one, then the device does not support the
Hold Power Condition parameter of the EPC Go To Power Condition subcommand for this power condition.
The DEFAULT TIMER SETTING field is set at the time of manufacture. The DEFAULT TIMER SETTING field may be
copied to the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field during the processing of a SET FEATURES command with:
a) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
b) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The DEFAULT TIMER SETTING field is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that the time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
The SAVED TIMER SETTING field has may be set to the value in the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field (see A.8.4.11)
during the processing of a SET FEATURES command with:
a) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
b) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The SAVED TIMER SETTING field:
a) is copied to the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field during the processing of a power-on reset (see 4.9.4); and
b) may be copied to the CURRENT TIMER SETTING field during the processing of a SET FEATURES command
with:
A) the Set Power Condition Timer subcommand (see 7.45.20.4); or
B) the Restore Power Condition Settings subcommand (see 7.45.20.2).
The SAVED TIMER SETTING field is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that the time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
The CURRENT TIMER SETTING field contains the minimum time that the device shall wait after command completion
before entering this power condition if the EPC feature set is enabled.
The CURRENT TIMER SETTING field shall be cleared to zero if:
a) EPC is disabled;
b) the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is cleared to zero; or
c) the CURRENT TIMER ENABLED bit (see A.8.4.7) is cleared to zero.
A value of zero indicates that this power condition is disabled if the EPC feature set is enabled.
A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that the time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
The NOMINAL RECOVERY TIME TO PM0:ACTIVE field contains the nominal time required to transition from this power
condition to PM0:Active state (see 4.15.4) if the EPC feature set is enabled. This time does not include
processing time for the command that caused this transition to occur.
The NOMINAL RECOVERY TIME TO PM0:ACTIVE field is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is
set to one, regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
A value of zero indicates that the nominal recovery time is not specified. A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that
the recovery time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
This value shall be preserved over all resets.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
The MINIMUM TIMER SETTING field contains the minimum timer value allowed by the Set Power Condition Timer
subcommand (see 7.45.20.4) for this power condition if the EPC feature set is enabled.
The MINIMUM TIMER SETTING field is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
A value of zero indicates that the nominal recovery time is not specified. A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that
the recovery time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
This value shall be preserved over all resets.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
The MAXIMUM TIMER SETTING field contains the maximum timer value allowed by the Set Power Condition Timer
subcommand (see 7.45.20.4) for this power condition if the EPC feature set is enabled.
The MAXIMUM TIMER SETTING field is valid if the POWER CONDITION SUPPORTED bit (see A.8.4.2) is set to one,
regardless of whether EPC is enabled or disabled.
A value of zero indicates that the nominal recovery time is not specified. A value of FFFF_FFFFh indicates that
the recovery time is greater than or equal to 429_496_729_500 milliseconds.
This value shall be preserved over all resets.
Measurement Units: 100 milliseconds.
A.9.1 Overview
Table A.25 defines the format of each of the log pages that define the Extended SMART Self-Test log. The
maximum size of the self-test log is 3 449 log pages. Devices may support fewer than 3 449 log pages.
The Extended SMART Self-Test log shall support 48-bit and 28-bit addressing. All 28-bit entries contained in the
SMART Self-Test log, defined in A.20 shall also be included in the Extended SMART Self-Test log with all 48-bit
entries.
The Extended Self-test log is a circular buffer. All unused self-test descriptors shall be filled with zeros.
The Self-test descriptor index indicates the most recent self-test descriptor. If there have been no self-tests, the
Self-test descriptor index is cleared to zero.
The value of the self-test log data structure revision number shall be 01h.
Offset Description
n Content of the LBA field (7:0)
n+1 Content of the self-test execution status byte
n+2..n+3 Life timestamp (word)
n+4 Content of the self-test failure checkpoint byte
n+5 Failing LBA (7:0)
n+6 Failing LBA (15:8)
n+7 Failing LBA (23:16)
n+8 Failing LBA (31:24)
n+9 Failing LBA (39:32)
n+10 Failing LBA (47:40)
n+11..n+25 Vendor specific.
Content of the LBA field (7:0) shall be the content of the LBA field (7:0) when the nth self-test subcommand was
issued (see 7.48.5.2).
Content of the self-test execution status byte shall be the content of the self-test execution status byte when the
nth self-test was completed (see 7.48.6.8).
Life timestamp shall contain the power-on lifetime of the device in hours when the nth self-test subcommand was
completed.
Content of the self-test failure checkpoint byte may contain additional information about the self-test that failed.
The failing LBA shall be the LBA of the logical sector that caused the test to fail. If the device encountered more
than one failed logical sector during the test, this field shall indicate the LBA of First Unrecoverable Error
(see 6.8.2). If the test passed or the test failed for some reason other than a failed logical sector, the value of this
field is undefined.
The data structure checksum is the two's complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with unsigned arithmetic, and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes is zero
when the checksum is correct. The checksum is placed in byte 511.
The Host Specific logs are mandatory for ATA devices and shall each contain sixteen log pages. The content of
the Host Specific logs shall be common to all log commands (e.g., if the host places data in a Host Specific log
page using the SMART WRITE LOG command and issues a READ LOG EXT command to the same log page,
then the host receives the same data that was originally stored by SMART WRITE LOG command).
Host Specific logs may be used by the host to store any data. If a Host Specific log has never been written by the
host, when read the content of the log shall be zeros.
A.11.1 Overview
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data log is mandatory for ATA devices and reports device configuration information. This
log shall be read-only. See table A.27 for a list of defined pages. Each page shall consist of a header field that
may be followed by defined statistics fields. If the Revision Number field in the page header is 0000h, then that
page is not supported. All page data following the last defined statistic for that page is reserved.
If an unsupported page is requested, then 512 bytes of all zeros shall be returned for that page.
A.11.2 List of Supported IDENTIFY DEVICE data log pages (Page 00h)
IDENTIFY DEVICE data log page 00h contains a list of the supported pages as described in table A.28. Entries
shall be in order of ascending page number (e.g., 00h, 01h, 07h).
A.11.4.1 Overview
The Capacity log page (see table A.29) provides information about the capacity of the device.
The ACCESSIBLE CAPACITY field (see table A.29) is a mandatory field which contains a value that is one greater
than the maximum LBA in user accessible space. The maximum value that shall be placed in the ACCESSIBLE
CAPACITY field is FFFF_FFFF_FFFFh. The contents of the ACCESSIBLE CAPACITY field may be affected by
commands in the Accessible Max Address Configuration feature set (see 4.5).
A.11.4.3.1 Device has multiple logical sectors per physical sector (LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR
RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit)
If the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit (see table A.29) is set to one, then:
a) the device has more than one logical sector per physical sector; and
b) the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field (see A.11.4.3.4) is valid.
See A.11.4.3.5 for information on the alignment of logical sectors within a physical sector.
If the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then
a) the device has only one logical sector per physical sector; and
b) the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field is invalid.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit
(see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 106 in table 45).
A.11.4.3.2 Device has a logical sector size greater than 256 words (LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit)
If the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.29) is set to one, then
a) the device has been formatted with a logical sector size larger than 256 words; and
b) the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field (see A.11.4.4) is valid.
If the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then
a) the logical sector size is 256 words; and
b) the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field is invalid.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 106 in table 45).
If the LPS MISALIGNMENT REPORTING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.3) is set to one (i.e., if Long Physical Sector
Alignment Error Reporting Control is supported), then the ALIGNMENT ERROR REPORTING field (see table A.29)
indicates the current Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting setting as follows:
a) 00b indicates that Long Physical Sector Alignment Error reporting is disabled;
b) 01b indicates that Long Physical Sector Alignment Error reporting is enabled;
c) 10b indicates that the device shall report command aborted if an Alignment Error occurs; and
d) 11b is reserved.
The Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control subcommand of the SET FEATURES command
(see 7.45.19) is the method for changing the ALIGNMENT ERROR REPORTING field.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ALIGNMENT ERROR REPORTING field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 49 in table 45).
A.11.4.3.4 2x logical sectors per physical sectors (LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field)
The LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field (see table A.29) indicates the size of the device physical
sectors in power of two logical sectors.
Example:
Bits 3:0: 0 = 20 = 1 logical sector per physical sector
P
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 106 in table 45).
A.11.4.3.5 Logical sector offset within the first physical sector where the first logical sector is placed
(LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field)
The LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see table A.29) shall report the location of logical sector zero within the first
physical sector of the media. See Annex D for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 209 in table 45).
The LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field (see table A.29) indicates the size of device's logical sectors in words. If the
LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.4.3.2) is set to one, then:
a) the value in the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field shall be greater than or equal to 256; and
b) all logical sectors on a device shall be the length indicated by the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field.
If the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field shall be cleared to
zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
words 117..118 in table 45).
The BUFFER SIZE field (see table A.29) reports the size, in bytes, of the buffer supported by the device. The
partitioning of the buffer is vendor specific.
A.11.5.1 Overview
The Supported Capabilities log page (see table A.30) provides a mechanism for the device to report support for
feature sets, features, commands and other device capabilities.
A.11.5.2.1 Overview
If the TRIM SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.9.1) is set to one and the DRAT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is cleared to
zero, then the Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT command (see 7.5.3.2) supports indeterminate
read after trim behavior. If the TRIM SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.9.1) is set to one and the DRAT SUPPORTED bit is
set to one, the Trim function of the DATA SET MANAGEMENT command supports deterministic read after trim
behavior. If the TRIM SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.9.1) is cleared to zero, then the DRAT SUPPORTED bit shall be
cleared to zero.
Table 33 (see 7.5.3.2) provides additional information about the RZAT SUPPORTED bit and the DRAT SUPPORTED bit.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DRAT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 69 in
table 45).
A.11.5.2.3 Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control is supported (LPS MISALIGNMENT
REPORTING SUPPORTED bit)
If the LPS MISALIGNMENT REPORTING SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the device supports the
SET FEATURES command with the Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control subcommand
(see 7.45.19). If the LPS MISALIGNMENT REPORTING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support
the SET FEATURES command with the Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control subcommand.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the LPS MISALIGNMENT REPORTING SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 69 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.4 READ BUFFER DMA is supported (READ BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit)
If the READ BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the READ BUFFER DMA command is
supported. If the READ BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the READ BUFFER DMA command is not
supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the READ BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 69 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.5 WRITE BUFFER DMA is supported (WRITE BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit)
If the WRITE BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the WRITE BUFFER DMA command is
supported. If the WRITE BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the WRITE BUFFER DMA command is not
supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRITE BUFFER DMA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 69 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.6 DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA is supported (DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA SUPPORTED bit)
If the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE
DMA command is supported. If the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the
DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 69 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.7 Optional ATA device 28-bit commands supported (28-BIT SUPPORTED bit)
The 28-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) shall be cleared to zero if all of the following commands are
supported:
a) FLUSH CACHE;
b) READ DMA;
c) READ MULTIPLE;
d) READ SECTOR(S);
e) READ VERIFY SECTOR(S);
f) SET MULTIPLE MODE;
g) WRITE DMA;
h) WRITE MULTIPLE; and
i) WRITE SECTOR(S).
The 28-BIT SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one if any of the following commands are not supported:
a) FLUSH CACHE;
b) READ DMA;
c) READ MULTIPLE;
d) READ SECTOR(S);
e) READ VERIFY SECTOR(S);
f) SET MULTIPLE MODE;
g) WRITE DMA;
h) WRITE MULTIPLE; or
i) WRITE SECTOR(S).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the 28-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 69
in table 45).
A.11.5.2.8 Trimmed LBA range(s) returning zeroed data is supported (RZAT SUPPORTED bit)
If the DRAT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.2) is set to one and the RZAT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to
one, then a read operation after a Trim operation returns data from trimmed LBAs as all words cleared to zero. If
the DRAT SUPPORTED bit is set to one and the RZAT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then a read operation after a
Trim operation may have words set to any value. If the DRAT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the RZAT
SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
Table 33 (see 7.5.3.2) provides additional information about the RZAT SUPPORTED bit and the DRAT SUPPORTED bit.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the RZAT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 69 in
table 45).
If the NOP SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the NOP command (see 7.17) is supported. If the NOP
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the NOP command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NOP SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 82 in
table 45).
A.11.5.2.10 The READ BUFFER command is supported (READ BUFFER SUPPORTED bit)
If the READ BUFFER SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the READ BUFFER command is supported. If
the READ BUFFER SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the READ BUFFER command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the READ BUFFER SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 82 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.11 The WRITE BUFFER command is supported (WRITE BUFFER SUPPORTED bit)
If the WRITE BUFFER SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is supported is set to one, the WRITE BUFFER command is
supported. If the WRITE BUFFER SUPPORTED bit is supported is cleared to zero, the WRITE BUFFER command is
not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRITE BUFFER SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 82 in table 45).
If the READ LOOK-AHEAD SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, read look-ahead is supported. If the READ
LOOK-AHEAD SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, read look-ahead is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the READ LOOK-AHEAD SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 82 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.13 The volatile write cache is supported (VOLATILE WRITE CACHE SUPPORTED bit)
If the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, volatile write cache is supported. If the
VOLATILE WRITE CACHE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, volatile write cache is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 82 in table 45).
If the SMART bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the SMART feature set is supported. If the SMART bit is cleared to
zero, the SMART feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SMART bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 82 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.15 The FLUSH CACHE EXT command is supported (FLUSH CACHE EXT SUPPORTED bit)
If the FLUSH CACHE EXT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the FLUSH CACHE EXT command
(see 7.11) is supported. If the FLUSH CACHE EXT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the FLUSH CACHE EXT
command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the FLUSH CACHE EXT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 83 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.16 The 48-bit Address feature set is supported (48-BIT SUPPORTED bit)
If the 48-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the 48-bit Address feature set (see 4.4) is supported. If
the 48-BIT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the 48-bit Address feature set (see 4.4) is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the 48-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 83
in table 45).
A.11.5.2.17 SET FEATURES subcommand is required to spin-up after power-up (SPIN-UP SUPPORTED bit)
If the SPIN-UP SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the device requires the SET FEATURES
subcommand to spin-up after power-up if the PUIS feature set is enabled (see 7.45.11). If the SPIN-UP
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not require the SET FEATURES subcommand to spin-up
after power-up.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SPIN-UP SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
83 in table 45).
If the PUIS SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the PUIS feature set (see 4.16) is supported. If the PUIS
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the PUIS feature set (see 4.16) is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the PUIS SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 83 in
table 45).
If the APM SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the APM feature set (see 4.6) is supported. If the APM
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the APM feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the APM SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 83 in
table 45).
A.11.5.2.20 The DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported (DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit)
If the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE
command is supported. If the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the DOWNLOAD
MICROCODE command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 83 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.21 The IDLE IMMEDIATE command with UNLOAD feature is supported (UNLOAD SUPPORTED bit)
If the UNLOAD SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the IDLE IMMEDIATE command with unload feature
(see 7.15.2.2) is supported. If the UNLOAD SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the IDLE IMMEDIATE command with
unload feature (see 7.15.2.2) is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UNLOAD SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
84 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.22 The WRITE DMA FUA EXT and WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT commands are supported (WRITE
FUA EXT SUPPORTED bit)
The WRITE FUA EXT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) shall be set to one if:
a) the 48-BIT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.16) bit is set to one; and
b) the WRITE DMA FUA EXT command (see 7.60) and WRITE MULTIPLE FUA EXT command (see 7.66)
are supported.
Otherwise, the WRITE FUA EXT SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRITE FUA EXT SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 84 in table 45).
If the GPL SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the GPL feature set (see 4.11) is supported. If the GPL
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the GPL feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the GPL SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 84 in
table 45).
If the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Streaming feature set (see 4.23) is supported.
If the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Streaming feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 84 in table 45).
If the SMART SELF-TEST SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, SMART self-test is supported. If the SMART
SELF-TEST SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, SMART self-test is not supported.
This bit is valid if the SMART bit (see A.11.5.2.14) is set to one indicating that the SMART feature set is supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SMART SELF-TEST SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 84 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.26 SMART error logging is supported (SMART ERROR LOGGING SUPPORTED bit)
If the SMART ERROR LOGGING SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, SMART error logging is supported.
If the SMART ERROR LOGGING SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is cleared to zero, SMART error logging is not
supported.
This bit is valid if the SMART bit (see A.11.5.2.14) is set to one indicating that the SMART feature set is supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SMART ERROR LOGGING SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 84 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.27 Extended Power Conditions feature set is supported (EPC SUPPORTED bit)
If the EPC SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Extended Power Conditions feature set (see 4.9)
is supported. If the EPC SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Extended Power Conditions feature set is not
supported.
If the EPC SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then:
a) the LOW POWER STANDBY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.36) shall be cleared to zero; and
b) the SET EPC POWER SOURCE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.35) shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the EPC SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 119 in
table 45).
A.11.5.2.28 Sense Data Reporting feature set is supported (SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit)
If the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 4.20) is
supported. If the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Sense Data Reporting feature set is not
supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SENSE DATA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 119 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.29 The Free-fall Control feature set is supported (FREE-FALL SUPPORTED bit)
If the FREE-FALL SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Free-fall Control feature set (see 4.10) is
supported. If the FREE-FALL SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Free-fall Control feature set (see 4.10) is
not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the FREE-FALL SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
119 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.30 The DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command with mode 3 is supported (DM MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit)
If the DM MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command
(see 7.7) and the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command (see 7.8) requesting the offset transfer method
are supported. Otherwise, the DM MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DM MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 119 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.31 The READ LOG DMA EXT and WRITE LOG DMA EXT commands are supported (GPL DMA
SUPPORTED bit)
If the GPL DMA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the READ LOG DMA EXT command (see 7.25) and
WRITE LOG DMA EXT command (see 7.63) are supported. Otherwise, the GPL DMA SUPPORTED bit is cleared to
zero.
If the GPL SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.23) is cleared to zero, the GPL DMA SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the GPL DMA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
119 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.32 The WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT command is supported (WRITE UNCORRECTABLE SUPPORTED
bit)
If the WRITE UNCORRECTABLE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the WRITE UNCORRECTABLE EXT
command (see 7.71) is supported. If the WRITE UNCORRECTABLE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the WRITE
UNCORRECTABLE EXT command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRITE UNCORRECTABLE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 119 in table 45).
If the WRV SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Write-Read-Verify feature set (see 4.25) is supported.
If the WRV SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Write-Read-Verify feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRV SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 119
in table 45).
A.11.5.2.34 Accessible Max Address Configuration feature set is supported (AMAX ADDR SUPPORTED bit)
If the AMAX ADDR SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Accessible Max Address Configuration feature
set (see 4.5) is supported. If the AMAX ADDR SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Accessible Max Address
Configuration feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the AMAX ADDR SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 119 in table 45).
A.11.5.2.35 Set EPC Power Source is supported (SET EPC POWER SOURCE SUPPORTED bit)
If the SET EPC POWER SOURCE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the Set EPC Power Source function
(see 7.45.20.8) is supported. If the SET EPC POWER SOURCE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Set EPC Power
Source function is not supported.
A.11.5.2.36 Low Power Standby is supported (LOW POWER STANDBY SUPPORTED bit)
If the LOW POWER STANDBY SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the HOLD POWER CONDITION bit and
the DELAYED ENTRY bit in the EPC Go To Power Condition subcommand (see 7.45.20.3). If the LOW POWER
STANDBY SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the HOLD POWER CONDITION bit and the
DELAYED ENTRY bit in the EPC Go To Power Condition subcommand.
If the DSN SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the DSN feature set (see 4.8) is supported. If the DSN
SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is cleared to zero, the DSN feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DSN SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 119 in
table 45).
A.11.5.2.38 Request Sense Device Fault Support (REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit)
If the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the device supports returning
normal outputs for the REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command (see 7.35) while the device is in a device fault
condition (see 6.2.7).
If the REQUEST SENSE DEVICE FAULT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support returning
normal outputs for the REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT command while the device is in a device fault condition.
A.11.5.3.1 Subcommands 0Eh and 0Fh are supported (DM OFFSETS DEFERRED SUPPORTED bit)
If the DM OFFSETS DEFERRED SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, then:
a) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.20) is set to one), then the device supports subcommands 0Eh and 0Fh (see 7.7.2.4 and
7.7.2.5) of the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command; and
b) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6) is set to one), then the device supports subcommands 0Eh and 0Fh (see
7.7.2.4 and 7.7.2.5) of the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command.
Otherwise, the DM OFFSETS DEFERRED SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero.
If the DM IMMEDIATE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, then:
a) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.20) is set to one), then the device supports subcommand 07h (see 7.7.2.3) of the
DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command; and
b) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6) is set to one), then the device supports subcommand 07h (see 7.7.2.3) of
the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command.
Otherwise, the DM IMMEDIATE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero.
If the DM OFFSETS IMMEDIATE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, then:
a) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.5.2.20) is set to one), then the device supports subcommand 03h (see 7.7.2.2) of the
DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command; and
b) if the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command is supported (i.e., the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6) is set to one), then the device supports subcommand 03h (see 7.7.2.2) of
the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command.
Otherwise, the DM OFFSETS IMMEDIATE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero.
If:
a) the value of the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see table A.30) is greater than zero;
b) the value of the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field is less than FFFFh;
c) the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.20) is set to one or the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE
DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6) is set to one; and
d) the DM OFFSETS DEFERRED SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.3.1) is set to one, or the DM OFFSETS IMMEDIATE
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.3.3) is set to one,
then the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field indicates the maximum number of 512-byte data blocks permitted by a
DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command (see 7.7) or a DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command (see 7.8) that
specifies a subcommand of:
a) Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use (i.e., 03h); or
b) Download with offsets and save microcode for future use (i.e., 0Eh).
Otherwise, no maximum is indicated (i.e., there is no maximum number of 512-byte data blocks).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DM MAXIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 235 in table 45).
If:
a) the value of the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see table A.30) is greater than zero;
b) the value of the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field is less than FFFFh;
c) the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.20) is set to one or the DOWNLOAD MICROCODE
DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.6) is set to one; and
d) the DM OFFSETS DEFERRED SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.3.1) is set to one, or the DM OFFSETS IMMEDIATE
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.3.3) is set to one,
then the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field indicates the minimum number of 512-byte data blocks permitted by a
DOWNLOAD MICROCODE command (see 7.7) or a DOWNLOAD MICROCODE DMA command (see 7.8) that
specifies a subcommand of:
a) Download with offsets and save microcode for immediate and future use (i.e., 03h); or
b) Download with offsets and save microcode for future use (i.e., 0Eh).
Otherwise, no minimum is indicated (i.e., there is no minimum number of 512-byte data blocks).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DM MINIMUM TRANSFER SIZE field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 234 in table 45).
The NOMINAL MEDIA ROTATION RATE field (see table A.30) indicates the nominal media rotation rate of the device
and is defined in table A.31.
Value Description
0000h Rate not reported
0001h Non-rotating media (e.g., solid state device)
0002h-0400h Reserved
0401h-FFFEh Nominal media rotation rate in rotations per minute (rpm) (e.g., 7 200 rpm = 1C20h)
FFFFh Reserved
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NOMINAL MEDIA ROTATION RATE field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 217 in table 45).
The NOMINAL FORM FACTOR field (see table A.30) indicates the nominal form factor of the device and is defined in
table A.32.
Value Description
0h Nominal form factor not reported
1h 5.25 inch nominal form factor
2h 3.5 inch nominal form factor
3h 2.5 inch nominal form factor
4h 1.8 inch nominal form factor
5h Less than 1.8 inch nominal form factor
6h..Fh Reserved
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NOMINAL FORM FACTOR field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 168 in table 45).
The WRV MODE 3 COUNT field (see table A.30) shall indicate the number of logical sectors to be verified after every
spin-up, if Write-Read-Verify feature set mode 3 is selected (i.e., Current mode of the Write-Read-Verify feature
set (see A.11.6.3.3) is 03h). This field is valid if the WRV ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.13) is set to one and Current
mode of the Write-Read-Verify feature set (see A.11.6.3.3) is 03h.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRV MODE 3 COUNT field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
210..211 in table 45).
The WRV MODE 2 COUNT field (see table A.30) is valid if the WRV ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.13) is set to one. The
WRV MODE 2 COUNT field shall indicate the number of logical sectors to be verified after every spin-up, with
Write-Read-Verify feature set mode 2 selected (i.e., Current mode of the Write-Read-Verify feature set
(see A.11.6.3.3) is 02h).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRV MODE 2 COUNT field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
212..213 in table 45).
A.11.5.8.1 Introduction
The World Wide Name (WWN) uses the NAA IEEE Registered designator format defined in SPC-4 with the NAA
field set to 5h.
When shown as a series of four contiguous words, the world wide name has the format shown in table A.33.
Note: Specified bit numbers (e.g., "(LSB) bit 0") are in relationship to the field in which they appear.
The NAA field indicates the format of the world wide name (see SPC-4) and shall be set as shown in table A.33.
The IEEE OUI field shall contain the 24-bit canonical form company identifier (i.e., OUI) that the IEEE has assigned
to the device manufacturer.
The UNIQUE ID field shall contain a value assigned by the device manufacturer that is unique for the device within
the OUI domain.
In the Supported Capabilities log page (see table A.30), the WORLD WIDE NAME field shall have the format defined
in A.11.5.8.2.
A.11.5.8.4 IDENTIFY DEVICE data and IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data WWN
In the IDENTIFY DEVICE data (see 7.12.7) and the IDENTIFY PACKET DEVICE data (see 7.13.6):
a) Word 108 bits 15:12 shall contain the NAA field (see A.11.5.8.2);
b) Word 108 bits 11:0 and word 109 bits 15:4 shall contain the IEEE OUI field (see A.11.5.8.2); and
c) Word 109 bits 3:0, word 110, and word 111 shall contain the UNIQUE ID field (see A.11.5.8.2).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data WWN is shown by word number in table A.34.
Note: Specified bit numbers (e.g., "(LSB) bit 0") are in relationship to the field in which they appear.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data WWN is shown by byte number in table A.35.
Word Offset 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Note: Specified bit numbers (e.g., "(LSB) bit 0") are in relationship to the field in which they appear.
If the TRIM SUPPORTED bit (see table A.30) is set to one, the device supports the TRIM bit of the DATA SET
MANAGEMENT command. See 7.12.7.30 and 7.5.3.2 for reporting Trim methods.
If the TRIM SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the TRIM bit in the DATA SET MANAGEMENT command is not
supported and:
a) the RZAT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.8) shall be cleared to zero; and
b) the DRAT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.2) shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the TRIM SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 169
in table 45).
A.11.6.1 Overview
The Current Settings log page (see table A.36) provides a mechanism for the device to report the current
settings for feature sets, features, and other device capabilities.
A.11.6.2.1 Overview
Current Settings indicate features, feature sets and command sets that are enabled.
If the DSN ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the DSN feature set (see 4.8) is enabled
(see 7.45.21.2). If the DSN ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the DSN feature set is disabled.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DSN ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 120 in
table 45).
If the EPC ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the EPC feature set is enabled (see 7.45.20.6). If the
EPC ENABLED bit is enabled is cleared to zero, then the EPC feature set is disabled (see 7.45.20.7).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the EPC ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 120 in
table 45).
A.11.6.2.4 Volatile write cache is enabled (VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit)
If the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then volatile write cache is enabled
(see 7.45.7). If the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then volatile write cache is disabled.
The VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit is only valid if the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.13)
is set to one (i.e., write cache is supported).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the VOLATILE WRITE CACHE ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 85 in table 45).
If the REVERTING TO DEFAULTS ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then Reverting to defaults is enabled
(see 7.45.15). If the REVERTING TO DEFAULTS ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Reverting to defaults is disabled.
If the SENSE DATA ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, the Sense Data Reporting feature set (see 4.20) is
enabled. If the SENSE DATA ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, the Sense Data Reporting feature set is disabled.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SENSE DATA ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
120 in table 45).
If the NON-VOLATILE WRITE CACHE bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then all of the write cache on the device is
non-volatile. If the NON-VOLATILE WRITE CACHE bit is cleared to zero, then the write cache may be volatile.
If the write cache changes from non-volatile to volatile, then the device should disable the volatile write cache.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NON-VOLATILE WRITE CACHE bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 69 in table 45).
If the READ LOOK-AHEAD ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then read look-ahead is enabled (see 7.45.14).
If the READ LOOK-AHEAD ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then read look-ahead is disabled. The READ LOOK-AHEAD
ENABLED bit is valid if the READ LOOK-AHEAD SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.12) is set to one indicating read
look-ahead is supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the READ LOOK-AHEAD ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 85 in table 45).
If the SMART ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the SMART feature set is enabled (see 7.48.4). If the
SMART ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the SMART feature set is disabled (see 7.48.2). The SMART ENABLED
bit is valid if SMART bit (see A.11.5.2.14) is set to one indicating SMART feature set is supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SMART ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 85 in
table 45).
If the PUIS ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the PUIS feature set is enabled (see 7.45.10). If the
PUIS ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the PUIS feature set is disabled.
The PUIS ENABLED bit is only valid if the PUIS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.18) is set to one (i.e., the PUIS feature
set is supported).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the PUIS ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 86 in
table 45).
If the APM ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the APM feature set is enabled (see 7.45.9). If the APM
ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, the APM feature set is disabled.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the APM ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 86 in
table 45).
A.11.6.2.12 The Free-fall Control feature set is enabled (FREE-FALL ENABLED bit)
If the FREE-FALL ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the Free-fall Control feature set (see 4.10) is
enabled. If the FREE-FALL ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the Free-fall Control feature set is disabled.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the FREE-FALL ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
120 in table 45).
If the WRV ENABLED bit (see table A.36) is set to one, then the Write-Read-Verify feature set (see 4.25) is enabled.
If the WRV ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the Write-Read-Verify feature set is disabled.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRV ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 120 in
table 45).
The POWER SOURCE field (see table A.37) indicates the current source of power set by the host.
Value Description
00b Unknown
01b Battery
10b Not Battery
11b Reserved
If the device has not processed a SET FEATURES command with the EPC Subcommand and the Set EPC
Power Source function (see 7.45.20.8), then the device shall indicate a value of 00b (i.e., Unknown).
The APM LEVEL field (see table A.36) contains the current APM level setting (see table 106). Support of the APM
LEVEL field is mandatory if the APM feature set (see 4.6) is supported. The APM LEVEL field is only valid if the APM
SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.19) is set to one and the APM ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.11) is set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the APM LEVEL field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 91 in
table 45).
A.11.6.3.3 Current mode of the Write-Read-Verify feature set (WRV MODE field)
The WRV MODE field (see table A.36) contains the current mode of the Write-Read-Verify feature set, as set by the
SET FEATURES Enable/Disable Write-Read-Verify subcommand. See 7.45.12 for more information on setting
Write-Read-Verify mode.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the WRV MODE field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 220 in
table 45).
A.11.6.4 DMA Host Interface Sector Times (DMA SECTOR TIME field)
The DMA SECTOR TIME field (see table A.36) defines the Streaming Transfer Time for DMA mode. The worst-case
sustainable transfer time per logical sector for the device is calculated as follows:
x y-
Worst Case Sustainable Transfer Time = -----------------
65 536
Where:
x = the contents of the STREAM GRANULARITY field (see A.11.6.8); and
y = Streaming Transfer Time for DMA mode.
The content of the DMA SECTOR TIME field may be affected by the host issuing a Set Maximum Host Interface
Sector Times command (see 7.45.13). As a result, the host should determine the current contents of the DMA
SECTOR TIME field after issuing a SET FEATURES command that may affect this field.
The DMA SECTOR TIME field is valid if the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.24) is set to one. If the
STREAMING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the DMA SECTOR TIME field shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DMA SECTOR TIME field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 96
in table 45).
A.11.6.5 PIO Host Interface Sector Times (PIO SECTOR TIME field)
The PIO SECTOR TIME field (see table A.36) defines the Streaming Transfer Time for PIO mode. The worst-case
sustainable transfer time per logical sector for the device is calculated as follows:
xy
Worst Case Sustainable Transfer Time = ------------------
65 536
Where:
x = the contents of the STREAM GRANULARITY field (see A.11.6.8); and
y = Streaming Transfer Time for PIO mode.
The content of the PIO SECTOR TIME field may be affected by the host issuing a Set Maximum Host Interface
Sector Times command (see 7.45.13). As a result, the host should determine the current contents of the PIO
SECTOR TIME field after issuing a SET FEATURES command that may affect this field.
The PIO SECTOR TIME field is valid if the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.24) is set to one. If the STREAMING
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the PIO SECTOR TIME field shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the PIO SECTOR TIME field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 104
in table 45).
A.11.6.6 Streaming minimum request size (STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field)
The STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field (see table A.36) contains the number of logical sectors that provides optimum
performance in a streaming environment. This number shall be a power of two, with a minimum of eight logical
sectors. The starting LBA value for each streaming command should be evenly divisible by this request size.
The STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field is valid if the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.24) is set to one. If the
STREAMING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the STREAM MIN REQUEST SIZE field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 95 in table 45).
The STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field (see table A.36) defines the Streaming Access Latency for DMA and PIO
mode. The worst-case access latency of the device for a streaming command is calculated as follows:
x y-
Worst Case Access Latency = -----------
256
Where:
x = the contents of the STREAM GRANULARITY field (see A.11.6.8); and
y = Streaming Access Latency for DMA and PIO mode.
The content of the STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field may be affected by the host issuing a Set Maximum Host
Interface Sector Times command (see 7.45.13). As a result, the host should determine the current contents
of the STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field after issuing a SET FEATURES command that may affect this field.
The STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field is valid if the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.24) is set to one. If the
STREAMING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the STREAM ACCESS LATENCY field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 97 in table 45).
The STREAM GRANULARITY field (see table A.36) defines the fixed unit of time that is used:
a) by the SET FEATURES subcommand Set Maximum Host Interface Sector Times (see 7.45.13) to
compute the:
A) DMA SECTOR TIME field (see A.11.6.4);
B) PIO SECTOR TIME Field (see A.11.6.5); and
The contents of the STREAM GRANULARITY field is vendor specific and fixed for a device.
The STREAM GRANULARITY field is valid if the STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.24) is set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the STREAM GRANULARITY field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
words 98..99 in table 45).
The FREE-FALL SENSITIVITY field (see table A.36) indicates sensitivity of the free-fall detection in the Free-fall
Control feature set (see 4.10). The sensitivity is selected on a scale from 00h to FFh. A value of zero selects the
device manufacturer's recommended setting. Other values are vendor specific. The higher the sensitivity value,
the more sensitive the device is to changes in acceleration.
The FREE-FALL SENSITIVITY field is valid if the FREE-FALL SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.29) is set to one and the
FREE-FALL ENABLED bit (see A.11.6.2.12) is set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the FREE-FALL SENSITIVITY field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 53 in table 45).
The device shall set the TIME SCHEDULED FOR DEVICE MAINTENANCE field (see table A.36) to the number of
cumulative seconds that the host should avoid sending commands. This field indicates the total number of
seconds that the device is requesting for internal maintenance.
The device shall set the TIME TO PERFORMANCE DEGRADATION field (see table A.36) to the estimated number of
minutes until performance degradation may occur due to insufficient idle time to perform internal maintenance.
This field indicates the minimum number of minutes before the device may begin performance degrading internal
maintenance.
The device shall set the MINIMUM INACTIVE TIME field (see table A.36) to the minimum number of continuous
seconds that the host should avoid sending commands. This field indicates the minimum number of seconds
that the device requires to make progress on internal maintenance.
A.11.7.1 Overview
The Strings log page (see table A.38) provides a mechanism for the device to report ATA String based
information.
The SERIAL NUMBER field contains the serial number of the device. The contents of the SERIAL NUMBER field is an
ATA string of twenty bytes in the format defined by 3.3.10. The device shall pad the string with spaces (i.e., 20h),
if necessary, to ensure that the string is the proper length. The combination of the serial number and model
number (see A.11.7.4) shall be unique for a given manufacturer.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SERIAL NUMBER field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
10..19 in table 45).
The FIRMWARE REVISION field contains the firmware revision of the device. The contents of the FIRMWARE REVISION
field is an ATA string of eight bytes in the format defined by 3.3.10. The device shall pad the string with spaces
(20h), if necessary, to ensure that the string is the proper length.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the FIRMWARE REVISION field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
23..26 in table 45).
The MODEL NUMBER field contains the model number of the device. The contents of the MODEL NUMBER field is an
ATA string of forty bytes in the format defined by 3.3.10. The device shall pad the string with spaces (i.e., 20h), if
necessary, to ensure that the string is the proper length. The combination of the serial number (see A.11.7.2) and
the model number shall be unique for a given manufacturer.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MODEL NUMBER field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data words
27..46 in table 45).
The ADDITIONAL PRODUCT IDENTIFIER field contains the additional product identifier for the device. The contents
of the ADDITIONAL PRODUCT IDENTIFIER field is an ATA string of eight bytes in the format defined by 3.3.10. The
device shall pad the string with spaces (i.e., 20h), if necessary, to ensure that the string is the proper length. If the
additional product identifier is not present, then the ADDITIONAL PRODUCT IDENTIFIER field is reserved.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ADDITIONAL PRODUCT IDENTIFIER field (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data words 170..173 in table 45).
A.11.8.1 Overview
The Security log page (see table A.39) provides a mechanism for the device to report Security based
information.
If the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.3.1) is cleared to zero (i.e., if the Security feature set (see 4.18) is not
supported) or the Master Password Identifier feature is not supported, then the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER
field shall contain 0000h or FFFFh.
If the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit is set to one and the Master Password Identifier feature is supported, then the
processing of a SECURITY SET PASSWORD command with the IDENTIFIER bit set to one (see 7.41), alters
the contents of the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field as described in 7.41.2.2 based on the model described
in 4.18.10.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MASTER PASSWORD IDENTIFIER field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 92 in table 45).
If the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, then the Security feature set (see 4.18) is supported.
If the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the Security feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
128 in table 45).
The MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see table A.39) indicates the Master Password Capability. If security is
enabled (see A.11.8.3.7), then:
a) the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit cleared to zero indicates that the Master Password Capability is
High; and
b) the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit set to one indicates that the Master Password Capability is
Maximum.
If security is disabled, then the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MASTER PASSWORD CAPABILITY bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 128 in table 45).
A.11.8.3.3 Enhanced security erase supported (ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE SUPPORTED bit)
If the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the enhanced mode of the
SECURITY ERASE UNIT command (see 7.39) is supported. If the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE SUPPORTED bit
is cleared to zero, the enhanced mode of the SECURITY ERASE UNIT command is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 128 in table 45).
If the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the password attempt counter (see 4.18.9) has
decremented to zero. If the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit is cleared to zero, the password attempt counter is
greater than zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SECURITY COUNT EXPIRED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 128 in table 45).
If the SECURITY FROZEN bit (see table A.39) is set to one, security is frozen (see 4.18.5). If the SECURITY FROZEN
bit is cleared to zero, security is not frozen.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SECURITY FROZEN bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 128
in table 45).
If the SECURITY LOCKED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, security is locked. If the SECURITY LOCKED bit is cleared
to zero, security is not locked.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SECURITY LOCKED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 128
in table 45).
If the SECURITY ENABLED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, security has been enabled by setting a User password
(see 4.18.3.2) via the SECURITY SET PASSWORD command (see 7.41). If the SECURITY ENABLED bit is cleared
to zero, there is no valid User password.
If the Security feature set is not supported, the SECURITY ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero. The SECURITY
ENABLED bit is valid if the SECURITY SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.8.3.1) is set to one indicating Security feature set is
supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SECURITY ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
128 in table 45).
A.11.8.4 Time required for an Enhanced Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT command (ENHANCED
SECURITY ERASE TIME field)
The ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see table A.39) specifies the estimated time required for the
SECURITY ERASE UNIT command to complete its enhanced mode erasure.
The ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit (see table A.39) indicates the format used to express the time as
follows:
a) if the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit is cleared to zero, then the estimated time is defined in
table A.40; and
b) if the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit is set to one, then the estimated time is defined in
table A.41.
Support of the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field is mandatory if support of the Security feature set is
supported (see 4.18). If the Security feature set is not supported, the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field
shall be cleared to zero.
Value Time
0 Value not specified
1..254 (Value2) minutes
255 >508 minutes
Value Time
0 Value not specified
1..32766 (Value2) minutes
32767 >65532 minutes
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ENHANCED SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 90 in table 45).
A.11.8.5 Time required for a Normal Erase mode SECURITY ERASE UNIT command (NORMAL SECURITY
ERASE TIME field)
The NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see table A.39) specifies the estimated time required for the SECURITY
ERASE UNIT command to complete its normal mode erasure.
The NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit (see table A.39) indicates the format used to express the time as
follows:
a) if the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit is cleared to zero, then the estimated time is defined in
table A.42; and
b) if the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME FORMAT bit is set to one, then the estimated time is defined in
table A.43.
Support of the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field is mandatory if the Security feature set (see 4.18) is supported.
If the Security feature set is not supported, the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field shall be cleared to zero.
Value Time
0 Value not specified
1..254 (Value2) minutes
255 >508 minutes
Value Time
0 Value not specified
1..32766 (Value2) minutes
32767 >65532 minutes
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NORMAL SECURITY ERASE TIME field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 89 in table 45).
A.11.8.6 Trusted Computing feature set supported (TRUSTED COMPUTING SUPPORTED bit)
If the TRUSTED COMPUTING SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the Trusted Computing feature set
(see 4.24) is supported. If the TRUSTED COMPUTING SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the Trusted Computing
feature set is not supported.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the TRUSTED COMPUTING SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 48 in table 45).
A.11.8.7.1 BLOCK ERASE EXT command is supported (BLOCK ERASE SUPPORTED bit)
If the BLOCK ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device supports the Sanitize Device feature
set BLOCK ERASE EXT command (see 7.36.2). If the BLOCK ERASE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device
does not support the Sanitize Device feature set BLOCK ERASE EXT command.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the BLOCK ERASE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 59 in table 45).
If the OVERWRITE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device supports the Sanitize Device feature set
OVERWRITE EXT command (see 7.36.4). If the OVERWRITE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does
not support the Sanitize Device feature set OVERWRITE EXT command.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the OVERWRITE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 59 in table 45).
A.11.8.7.3 CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT command is supported (CRYPTO SCRAMBLE SUPPORTED bit)
If the CRYPTO SCRAMBLE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device supports the Sanitize Device
feature set CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT command (see 7.36.3). If the CRYPTO SCRAMBLE SUPPORTED bit is cleared
to zero, the device does not support the Sanitize Device feature set CRYPTO SCRAMBLE EXT command.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the CRYPTO SCRAMBLE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 59 in table 45).
If SANITIZE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device supports the Sanitize Device feature set
(see 4.17). If SANITIZE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the Sanitize Device feature
set.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SANITIZE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
59 in table 45).
A.11.8.7.5 SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK EXT command is supported (SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE SUPPORTED bit)
If the SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device supports the Sanitize
Device feature set SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK command (see 7.36.5). If the SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the Sanitize Device feature set SANITIZE
ANTIFREEZE LOCK command.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SANITIZE ANTIFREEZE LOCK SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 59 in table 45).
A.11.8.7.6 Device Encrypts All User Data (ENCRYPT ALL SUPPORTED bit)
If the ENCRYPT ALL SUPPORTED bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device encrypts all user data on the device.
If the ENCRYPT ALL SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device may not encrypt all user data on the device.
NOTE 20 — This standard does not provide a method to cryptographically authenticate the state of the ENCRYPT
ALL SUPPORTED bit.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ENCRYPT ALL SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 69 in table 45).
If the ACS-3 COMMANDS ALLOWED BY SANITIZE bit (see table A.39) is set to one, the device allows processing of
the commands listed in 4.17.5 during a sanitize operation. If the ACS-3 COMMANDS ALLOWED BY SANITIZE bit is
cleared to zero, the device allows processing of the commands listed in ACS-2 during a sanitize operation.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the ACS-3 COMMANDS ALLOWED BY SANITIZE bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 59 in table 45).
A.11.9.1 Overview
The Parallel ATA log page (see table A.44) provides information about the Parallel ATA Transport.
For PATA devices, if the IORDY SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then the device supports the IORDY
signal (see ATA8-APT). All PATA devices, except CFA-APT devices, shall set the IORDY SUPPORTED bit to one.
For SATA devices, the IORDY SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the IORDY SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 49
in table 45).
For PATA devices, if the IORDY DISABLE SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then the device supports the
disabling of IORDY (see ATA8-APT) via the SET FEATURES command.
For SATA devices, the IORDY DISABLE SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the IORDY DISABLE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 49 in table 45).
If the DMA SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then the device supports the DMA data transfer protocols.
All devices, except CFA-APT devices, shall set the DMA SUPPORTED bit to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DMA SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 49 in
table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.1 Overview
Multiword DMA identifies the Multiword DMA transfer modes supported by the device and indicates the mode
that is currently selected. Only one DMA mode shall be selected at any given time. If an Ultra DMA mode is
enabled, then no Multiword DMA mode shall be enabled. If a Multiword DMA mode is enabled, then no Ultra
DMA mode shall be enabled.
A.11.9.2.4.2 Multiword DMA mode 2 is selected (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit)
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 2 is selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 2 is not selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.3) is set to one or the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED
bit (see A.11.9.2.4.4) is set to one, then the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.3 Multiword DMA mode 1 is selected (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit)
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 1 is selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 1 is not selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.2) is set to one or the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED
bit (see A.11.9.2.4.4) is set to one, then the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.4 Multiword DMA mode 0 is selected (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit)
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Multiword DMA mode 0 is selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 0 is not selected.
If the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.2) is set to one or MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit
(see A.11.9.2.4.3) is set to one, then the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.5 Multiword DMA mode 2 and below are supported (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices, if the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is:
a) set to one, then Multiword DMA modes 2 and below are supported (i.e., if Multiword DMA mode 2 is
supported, then Multiword DMA modes 1 and 0 shall be supported);
b) cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 2 is not supported; and
c) set to one, then the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.7) shall be set to one and the
MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.6) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.6 Multiword DMA mode 1 and below are supported (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices, if the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is:
a) set to one, then Multiword DMA modes 1 and below are supported (i.e., if Multiword DMA mode 1 is
supported, then Multiword DMA mode 0 shall also be supported);
b) cleared to zero, then Multiword DMA mode 1 is not supported; and
c) set to one, then the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.7) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.4.7 Multiword DMA mode 0 is supported (MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices, if the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Multiword
DMA mode 0 is supported.
For SATA devices, the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 63 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.1 Overview
Ultra DMA identifies the Ultra DMA transfer modes supported by the device and indicates the mode that is
currently selected. Only one DMA mode shall be selected at any given time. If an Ultra DMA mode is selected,
then no Multiword DMA mode shall be selected. If a Multiword DMA mode is selected, then no Ultra DMA mode
shall be selected. Support of this word is mandatory if any Ultra DMA mode is supported.
If the UDMA MODE 6 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 6 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 6 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 6 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 6 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
If the UDMA MODE 5 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 5 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 5 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 5 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 5 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
If the UDMA MODE 4 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 4 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 4 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 4 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 4 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
If the UDMA MODE 3 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 3 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 3 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 3 is not selected.
If the UDMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 2 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 2 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 2 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 2 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
If the UDMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 1 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 1 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 1 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 1 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
If the UDMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is selected. If the UDMA
MODE 0 ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is not selected.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 0 ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word
88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.9 Ultra DMA mode 6 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 6
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 6 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 6 is supported, then Ultra DMA modes 5, 4, 3, 2, 1 and 0 shall also be supported.
If the UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the:
a) UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.10) shall be set to one;
b) UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.11) shall be set to one;
c) UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.12) shall be set to one;
d) UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.13) shall be set to one;
e) UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.14) shall be set to one; and
f) UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.15) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit are supported may be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 6 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.10 Ultra DMA mode 5 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 5
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 5 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 5 is supported, then Ultra DMA modes 4, 3, 2, 1 and 0 shall also be supported. If
the UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the:
a) UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.11) shall be set to one;
b) UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.12) shall be set to one;
c) UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.13) shall be set to one;
d) UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.14) shall be set to one; and
e) UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.15) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 5 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.11 Ultra DMA mode 4 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 4
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 4 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 4 is supported, then Ultra DMA modes 3, 2, 1 and 0 shall also be supported. If the
UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the:
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 4 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.12 Ultra DMA mode 3 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 3
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 3 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 3 is supported, then Ultra DMA modes 2, 1 and 0 shall also be supported. If the
UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the:
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 3 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.13 Ultra DMA mode 2 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 2
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 2 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 2 is supported, then Ultra DMA modes 1 and 0 shall also be supported. If the UDMA
MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the:
a) UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.14) shall be set to one; and
b) UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.15) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 2 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
A.11.9.2.5.14 Ultra DMA mode 1 and below are supported (UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit)
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA modes 1
and below are supported. If the UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 1 is not
supported. If Ultra DMA mode 1 is supported, then Ultra DMA mode 0 shall also be supported. If the UDMA MODE
1 SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.5.15) shall be set to one.
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
For PATA devices if the UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is
supported. If the UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Ultra DMA mode 0 is not supported.
For SATA devices, the UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UDMA MODE 0 SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 88 in table 45).
If the device is a PATA device and the CBLID bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then the device detected the CBLID– below ViL (see ATA8-APT); or
b) set to one, then the device detected the CBLID– above ViHB (see ATA8-APT).
The CBLID bit shall be set to one or cleared to zero by the selected device to indicate whether the device detected
the CBLID– signal (see ATA8-APT) above VIH or the CBLID– signal below VIL at any time during the processing
B B
of each IDENTIFY DEVICE command or SMART READ LOG command after receiving the command from the
host but before returning data to the host. This test may be repeated by the device during command processing
(see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the CBLID bit shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware reset.
For SATA devices, the CBLID bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the CBLID bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 93 in table 45).
If the device is a PATA device and the D1 PDIAG bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then Device 1 did not detect the assertion of PDIAG–; or
b) set to one, then Device 1 detected the assertion of PDIAG–.
PATA Device 0 shall clear the D1 PDIAG bit to zero and Device 1 shall set it as described in this subclause as the
result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D1 PDIAG bit shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware reset.
For SATA devices, the D1 PDIAG bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D1 PDIAG bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 93 in
table 45).
For PATA devices, the contents of the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see table A.44) indicate how the device
number of Device 1 were detected using the coded values shown in table A.45.
Code Meaning
00b Reserved
01b a jumper was used
10b the CSEL signal was used
11b some other method was used or the method is unknown
PATA Device 0 shall clear the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field to zero and Device 1 shall set it as described in this
subclause as the result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware
reset.
For SATA devices, the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field shall be set to 00b.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 93 in table 45).
If the device is a PATA device and the D0 PDIAG bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then Device 0 did not detect the assertion of PDIAG–; or
b) set to one, then Device 0 detected the assertion of PDIAG–.
PATA Device 1 shall clear the D0 PDIAG bit to zero and Device 0 shall set it as described in this subclause as the
result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D0 PDIAG bit shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware reset.
For SATA devices, the D0 PDIAG bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D0 PDIAG bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 93 in
table 45).
If the device is a PATA device and the D0 DASP bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then Device 0 did not detect the assertion of DASP–; or
If the device is a PATA device and the D0/D1 SELECTION bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then Device 0 does not respond when Device 1 is selected; or
b) set to one, then Device 0 responds when Device 1 is selected.
PATA Device 1 shall clear the D0/D1 SELECTION bit to zero and Device 0 shall set it as described in this subclause
as the result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D0/D1 SELECTION bit shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware reset.
For SATA devices, the D0/D1 SELECTION bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D0/D1 SELECTION bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 93 in
table 45).
If the device is a PATA device and the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit (see table A.44) is:
a) cleared to zero, then Device 0 did not detect the assertion of DASP–; or
b) set to one, then Device 0 detected the assertion of DASP–.
PATA Device 1 shall clear the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit to zero and Device 0 shall set it as described in this subclause
as the result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware reset.
For SATA devices, the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D0 DIAGNOSTICS bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 93 in
table 45).
For PATA devices, The contents of the D1 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see table A.44) indicate how the device
number of Device 0 were detected using the coded values shown in table A.45 (see A.11.9.2.6.3).
PATA Device 1 shall clear the D0 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field to zero and Device 0 shall set it as described in this
subclause as the result of a hardware reset (see ATA8-APT).
The contents of the D0 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field shall changed only during the processing of a PATA hardware
reset.
For SATA devices, the D0 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field shall be set to 00b.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the D0 DEVICE NUMBER DETECT field (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 93 in table 45).
For PATA devices, if the PIO MODE 4 IS SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then the device supports PIO
mode 4. See ATA8-APT for more information.
For SATA devices, the PIO MODE 4 IS SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the PIO MODE 4 IS SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 64 in table 45).
For PATA devices, if the PIO MODE 3 IS SUPPORTED bit (see table A.44) is set to one, then the device supports PIO
mode 3. All devices except CFA-APT devices shall support PIO mode 3 and shall set the PIO MODE 3 IS
SUPPORTED bit to one. See ATA8-APT for more information.
For SATA devices, the PIO MODE 3 IS SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the PIO MODE 3 IS SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 64 in table 45).
A.11.9.4.1 Manufacturer’s recommended Multiword DMA transfer cycle time (RECOMMENDED MULTIWORD
CYCLE TIME field)
A.11.9.4.2 Minimum Multiword DMA transfer cycle time (MIN MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field)
For PATA devices, the MIN MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field (see table A.44) is defined as the minimum Multiword
DMA transfer cycle time per word. The MIN MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field defines, in nanoseconds, the minimum
cycle time that the device supports when performing Multiword DMA transfers on a per word basis.
For SATA devices, the MIN MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field shall be set to 78h (i.e., 120 ns).
Any PATA device that sets the MULTIWORD DMA MODE 1 SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.9.2.4.6) to one shall support this
field, and the value in the RECOMMENDED MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field shall not be less than the minimum cycle
time for the fastest DMA mode supported by the device.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the RECOMMENDED MULTIWORD CYCLE TIME field (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 65 in table 45).
A.11.9.5.1 Minimum PIO transfer cycle time with IORDY flow control (MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY
field)
For PATA devices, the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field (see table A.44) is defined as the minimum PIO
transfer with IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control cycle time. The MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field defines,
in nanoseconds, the minimum cycle time that the device supports while performing data transfers while utilizing
IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control.
For SATA devices, the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field shall be set to 78h (i.e., 120 ns).
All devices except CFA-APT devices shall support PIO mode 3 and shall support the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH
IORDY field, and the value in the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field shall be the fastest defined PIO mode
supported by the device (i.e., PIO mode 3 or PIO mode 4). The maximum value reported in this field shall be B4h
(i.e., 180 ns).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 68 in table 45).
A.11.9.5.2 Minimum PIO transfer cycle time without flow control (MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY
field)
For PATA devices, the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY field (see table A.44) is defined as the minimum
PIO transfer without IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control cycle time. The MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY
field defines, in nanoseconds, the minimum cycle time that, if used by the host, the device guarantees data
integrity during the transfer without utilization of IORDY (see ATA8-APT) flow control.
For SATA devices, the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field shall be set to 78h (i.e., 120 ns).
Any device that supports PIO mode 3 or PIO mode 4 shall support the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY
field. The value in the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY field shall not be less than the value reported in the
MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITH IORDY field (see A.11.9.5.1).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the MIN PIO TRANSFER TIME WITHOUT IORDY field (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 67 in table 45).
The TRANSFER MODE field (see table A.44) is set by the set transfer mode subcommand (see 7.45.8) of the SET
FEATURES command. The contents of the TRANSFER MODE field indicate the current transfer mechanism used
by the device (see table 105).
The Serial ATA log page (see table A.44) provides information about the Serial ATA Transport.
If the SATA GEN1 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports the Gen1 signaling rate
of 1.5 Gb/s (see SATA 3.1).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SATA GEN1 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the SATA GEN2 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports the Gen2 signaling rate
of 3.0 Gb/s (see SATA 3.1).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SATA GEN2 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the SATA GEN3 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports the Gen3 signaling rate
of 6.0 Gb/s (see SATA 3.1).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SATA GEN3 SIGNALLING SPEED SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the NCQ feature set.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE
data word 76 in table 45).
If the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports
Partial and Slumber interface power management states that are initiated by the host (see SATA 3.1).
If the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the DEVICE
INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.17) shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS
SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the SATA PHY EVENT COUNTERS LOG SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the SATA Phy Event
Counters log (see A.16).
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SATA PHY EVENT COUNTERS LOG SUPPORTED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the UNLOAD WHILE NCQ COMMANDS ARE OUTSTANDING SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports
moving the heads to a safe position upon reception of the IDLE IMMEDIATE command (see 7.15) with the
Unload Feature specified while NCQ commands are outstanding. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the UNLOAD WHILE NCQ COMMANDS ARE OUTSTANDING SUPPORTED bit
shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the UNLOAD WHILE NCQ COMMANDS ARE OUTSTANDING SUPPORTED
bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the NCQ PRIORITY INFORMATION SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the PRIO field in the READ
FPDMA QUEUED command (see 7.23) and WRITE FPDMA QUEUED command (see 7.61), and optimization
based on this information. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the
NCQ PRIORITY INFORMATION SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NCQ PRIORITY INFORMATION SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the HOST AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports
host automatic partial to slumber transitions. If the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS
SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then the HOST AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit shall
be cleared to zero. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the HOST
AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the HOST AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS
SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports device
automatic partial to slumber transitions and may asynchronously transition from Partial to Slumber, if enabled
(see 7.45.17.8). If the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero (i.e.,
device initiating interface power management is not supported), then the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER
TRANSITIONS ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.8) shall be cleared to zero. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS SUPPORTED
bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DEVICE AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS
SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
A.11.10.2.11 READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit
If the READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the READ LOG DMA
EXT command (see 7.25) and the READ LOG EXT command (see 7.24) may be used in all cases with identical
results. If the GPL DMA SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.5.2.31) is cleared to zero, then the READ LOG DMA EXT AS
EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit
(see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit
shall be cleared to zero.
If the READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero and the device
indicates command acceptance for a READ LOG DMA EXT command to read the NCQ Command Error log
(see A.14) or the SATA Phy Event Counters log (see A.16), then the device shall return command aborted.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the READ LOG DMA EXT AS EQUIVALENT TO READ LOG EXT
SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 76 in table 45).
If the NCQ STREAMING SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports NCQ Streaming. See SATA 3.1 for
additional details. If the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the NCQ
STREAMING SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NCQ STREAMING SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 77 in table 45).
If the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT COMMAND SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports the NCQ QUEUE
MANAGEMENT command (see 7.16). If if the NCQ FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to
zero, then the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT COMMAND SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT COMMAND SUPPORTED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 77 in table 45).
If the SEND AND RECEIVE QUEUED COMMANDS SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports the RECEIVE
FPDMA QUEUED command (see 7.34) and the SEND FPDMA QUEUED command (see 7.43). If the NCQ
FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, then the SEND AND RECEIVE QUEUED COMMANDS
SUPPORTED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SEND AND RECEIVE QUEUED COMMANDS SUPPORTED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 77 in table 45).
If the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS SUPPORTED bit is set to one the device supports the use of non-zero buffer
offsets for commands in the NCQ feature set (see 4.14). See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION SUPPORTED bit is set to one the device supports the use of the DMA Setup FIS
Auto-Activate optimization. See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports device initiated
power management (DIPM) requests. If the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to
zero, the device does not support device initiated power management requests.
Devices shall support either host-initiated interface power management or device-initiated interface power
management. If the RECEIPT OF HOST INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT REQUESTS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.5)
is cleared to zero, then the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit shall be set to one.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports guaranteed in-order data delivery
for non-zero buffer offsets in commands in the NCQ feature set (see 4.14). See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL SUPPORTED bit is set to one, then the device supports Hardware Feature
Control (see 4.22). If the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, then Hardware Feature
Control is not supported and the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IS ENABLED bit (see A.11.10.3.6) shall be cleared
to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the SSP feature set
(see 4.21). If the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not
support the SSP feature set.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION SUPPORTED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 78 in table 45).
If the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports NCQ Autosense (see A.14). If the NCQ
AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support NCQ Autosense (see A.14). If the NCQ
FEATURE SET SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.4) is cleared to zero, the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit shall be
cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit (see IDENTIFY DEVICE data
word 78 in table 45).
The CURRENT NEGOTIATED SERIAL ATA SIGNAL SPEED field (see table A.47) is a coded value that indicates the
Serial ATA Phy speed at which the device is currently communicating.
Code Description
000b Reporting of current signalling speed is not supported
001b Current signalling speed is Gen1
010b Current signalling speed is Gen2
011b Current signalling speed is Gen3
100b..111b Reserved
NOTE 21 — In the case of system configurations that have more than one Phy link in the data path (eg. port
multiplier), the indicated speed is only relevant for the link between the device Phy and its immediate host Phy. It
is possible for each link in the data path to negotiate a different Serial ATA signaling speed.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the CURRENT NEGOTIATED SERIAL ATA SIGNAL SPEED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 77 in table 45).
If the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS ENABLED bit is set to one, then device support for the use of non-zero buffer
offsets for commands in the NCQ feature set (see 4.14) is enabled. See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the NON-ZERO BUFFER OFFSETS ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION ENABLED bit is set to one, then the device support for use of the DMA Setup
FIS Auto-Activate optimization is enabled. See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DMA SETUP AUTO-ACTIVATION ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit is set to one, then device support for initiating power
management requests to the host is enabled. If the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit is set to
one, then the device may initiate power management transition requests. If the DEVICE INITIATED POWER
MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then the device shall not initiate interface power management
requests to the host. The DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero by default.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the DEVICE INITIATED POWER MANAGEMENT ENABLED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY ENABLED bit is set to one, then device support for guaranteed in-order data delivery
when non-zero buffer offsets are used for commands in the NCQ feature set (see 4.14) is enabled. See SATA 3.1
for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the IN-ORDER DATA DELIVERY ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IS ENABLED bit is set to one, then device support for Hardware Feature Control
(see 4.22) is enabled. If the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IS ENABLED bit is cleared to zero, then Hardware
Feature Control is disabled. See SATA 3.1 for more information.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IS ENABLED bit (see IDENTIFY
DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION ENABLED bit is set to one, then the SSP feature set (see 4.21) is
enabled. If the device supports the SSP feature set, then the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION ENABLED bit
shall be set to one after a power on reset has been processed. If the device does not support the SSP feature
set (i.e., if the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.20) is cleared to zero), then the
SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION ENABLED bit shall be cleared to zero.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the SOFTWARE SETTINGS PRESERVATION ENABLED bit (see
IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS ENABLED bit is set to one, then the device may asynchronously
transition from Partial to Slumber.
The IDENTIFY DEVICE data contains a copy of the AUTOMATIC PARTIAL TO SLUMBER TRANSITIONS ENABLED bit
(see IDENTIFY DEVICE data word 79 in table 45).
If the CURRENT HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IDENTIFIER field is non-zero, then table 110 describes the current
Hardware Feature Control behavior. If the CURRENT HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IDENTIFIER field is cleared to
zero, then the current Hardware Feature Control behavior shall be either disable staggered spin-up (DSS) or
HDD activity indication (DAS).
The SUPPORTED HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IDENTIFIER field (see table 110) indicates the value that is permitted
for the CURRENT HARDWARE FEATURE CONTROL IDENTIFIER field (see A.11.10.4).
A.12.1 Overview
The LBA Status log contains the LBA status for all user accessible LBAs (see 4.1).
The Number of LBA Valid Ranges log page (see table A.49) contains the number of LBA status descriptors that
contain valid LBA status.
The FIRST LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field in all LBA Status log pages, except the first LBA Status log page shall be
set to the sum of:
a) the STARTING LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field in the last LBA Status Descriptor of the previous LBA Status
Log page; and
b) the NUMBER OF LOGICAL BLOCKS field in the last LBA Status Descriptor of the previous LBA Status Log
page.
The STARTING LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field shall contain the starting LBA of the range of LBAs for which this
descriptor reports LBA status.
The NUMBER OF LOGICAL BLOCKS field shall contain the number of logical blocks in the range of LBAs for which
this descriptor reports LBA status.
The TRIM STATUS bit set to one indicates the range of LBAs specified by this descriptor is trimmed (see 7.5.3.2).
The TRIM STATUS bit cleared to zero indicates the range of LBAs specified by this descriptor is not trimmed or the
status is unknown.
The STARTING LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field in the first LBA Status Descriptor returned in this LBA Status log page
shall contain the value specified in the FIRST LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field of this LBA Status log page. For
subsequent LBA Status Descriptors, the contents of the STARTING LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field shall contain
the sum of the values in:
a) the STARTING LOGICAL BLOCK ADDRESS field in the previous LBA Status Descriptor; and
b) the NUMBER OF LOGICAL BLOCKS field in the previous LBA Status Descriptor.
Adjacent LBA Status Descriptors may or may not have different values for the TRIM STATUS bit.
Table A.52 and table A.53 define the format of the LPS Mis-alignment log. The LPS Mis-alignment log contains
the starting LBA of the first write commands for which:
a) the first byte of data did not begin at the first byte of a physical sector; or
b) the last byte of data did not end at the last byte of a physical sector.
If the device receives a command to read the LPS Mis-alignment log, then the device shall:
1) return the log; and
2) clear the number of mis-aligned logical sectors contained in this log to zero.
The LPS Mis-alignment log shall be preserved across all resets.
The LPS Mis-alignment log is not affected by Long Physical Sector Alignment Error Reporting Control
(see 7.45.19).
A.14.1 Overview
The NCQ Command Error log describes the most recent NCQ command failure is one log page in length, and
is defined in table A.54. Devices supporting the NCQ feature set (see 4.14) shall support log address 10h (i.e.,
NCQ Command Error). Multiple commands (see A.11.10.2.11) may be used to read the NCQ Command Error
log.
Offset Description
0 Bit Name
7 NQ bit (see A.14.3)
6 UNL bit (see A.14.4)
5 Reserved
4:0 NCQ TAG field (see A.14.2)
1 Reserved
2 STATUS field (see A.14.5)
3 ERROR field (see A.14.5)
4 LBA field (7:0) (see A.14.5)
5 LBA field (15:8) (see A.14.5)
6 LBA field (23:16) (see A.14.5)
7 DEVICE field (see A.14.5)
8 LBA field (31:24) (see A.14.5)
9 LBA field (39:32) (see A.14.5)
10 LBA field (47:40) (see A.14.5)
11 Reserved
12 COUNT field (7:0) (see A.14.5)
13 COUNT field (15:8) (see A.14.5)
14 SENSE KEY field (see A.14.6)
15 ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE field (see A.14.6)
16 ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE QUALIFIER field (see A.14.6)
17..255 Reserved
256..510 Vendor Specific
511 Checksum (see A.14.7)
If the NQ bit is cleared to zero, then the NCQ TAG field contains the NCQ Tag (see 4.14.1) corresponding to the
NCQ command (see 4.14.1) that failed.
A.14.3 NQ bit
The NQ bit set to one indicates that the NCQ TAG field is not valid as the result of non-NCQ command having been
issued. The NQ bit cleared to zero indicates that the NCQ TAG field is valid and that the error condition applies to
an NCQ command.
The Unload (UNL) bit set to one indicates that the error condition was the result of receiving an IDLE IMMEDIATE
command with the Unload Feature specified (see 4.14.3). The UNL bit cleared to zero indicates the reason for the
error was not the reception of an IDLE IMMEDIATE command with the Unload Feature specified. If the last
command received was an Unload Immediate command, then the device shall not load the heads when reading
the NCQ Command Error log.
If the UNL bit is set to one, the NQ bit shall also be set to one to indicate the failure was due to reception of a
non-NCQ command. If the UNL bit is set to one, the value of the STATUS field, ERROR field, and LBA field (7:0)
in the NCQ Command Error log shall be set as follows:
Status: The BUSY bit (see ATA8-APT) shall be cleared to zero and the ERROR bit (see 6.2.9) shall be set to
one.
Error: The ABORT bit (see 6.3.2) shall be set to one.
LBA (7:0): Shall be set to C4h if the unload is being executed or has returned command completion without an
error.
Shall be set to 4Ch if the unload was not accepted or has failed.
The STATUS field, ERROR field, LBA field and COUNT field indicate the error that caused the device to stop
processing NCQ commands.
The value returned in the ERROR field of the NCQ Command Error log may be different than the value returned in
the ERROR field of the command Error Output structure when the initial error condition is indicated. The ERROR
field in command Error Output structure is used for the purpose of signaling an error for an NCQ command, while
the value in the ERROR field of the NCQ Command Error log provides specific information about the error
condition.
If the device supports NCQ Autosense (i.e., the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.21) is set to one),
then the following fields shall be set to the values defined in SPC-4:
a) the SENSE KEY field;
b) the ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE field; and
c) the ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE QUALIFIER field.
If the device does not support NCQ Autosense (i.e., the NCQ AUTOSENSE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.21) is
cleared to zero), then:
a) the SENSE KEY field shall be cleared to zero;
b) the ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE field shall be cleared to zero; and
c) the ADDITIONAL SENSE CODE QUALIFIER field shall be cleared to zero.
A.14.7 Checksum
The data structure checksum is the two’s complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with eight-bit unsigned arithmetic and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes of
the data structure shall be zero.
Table A.55 defines the format of the Read Stream Error log. Entries are placed into the Read Stream Error log
only when the STREAM ERROR bit is set to one in the STATUS field. The 512 bytes returned shall contain a
maximum of 31 error entries.
The READ STREAM ERROR COUNT field shall contain the total number of Read Stream Errors detected since the
most recent read of the Read Stream Error log that returned command completion without an error. This error
count may be greater than 31. However, only the most recent 31 errors are represented by entries in the log. If
the Read Stream Error Count reaches its maximum value, after the next error is detected the Read Stream Error
Count shall remain at the maximum value.
During processing of a read log command with the LBA field (7:0) set to 22h, a device shall clear the:
a) Read Stream Error log:
b) ERROR LOG INDEX field to zero; and
c) READ STREAM ERROR COUNT field to zero.
If the Error Log Index is zero, there are no error log entries. A device shall clear the content of the Read Stream
Error log during processing of a power-on reset. If the device enters the PM3:Sleep state (see 4.15.4), then the
device may clear the content of the Read Stream Error log. For a PATA device, the log is also cleared during the
processing a hardware reset. For a SATA device, the Read Stream Error log is cleared on a hardware reset if
Software Settings Preservation is disabled (see 7.45.17.7), otherwise it is preserved.
The DATA STRUCTURE VERSION field shall contain a value of 02h indicating the second revision of the structure
format.
The READ STREAM ERROR COUNT field shall contain the number of uncorrected logical sector entries reportable to
the host. This value may exceed 31.
The ERROR LOG INDEX field indicates the error log data structure representing the most recent error. Only values
one through 31 are valid.
Table A.56 defines the format of each entry in the Read Stream Error log.
Offset Description
0 FEATURE field (7:0)
1 FEATURE field (15:8)
2 STATUS field
3 ERROR field
4 LBA field (7:0)
5 LBA field (15:8)
6 LBA field (23:16)
7 LBA field (31:24)
8 LBA field (39:32)
9 LBA field (47:40)
10..11 Reserved
12 COUNT field (7:0)
13 COUNT field (15:8)
14 Reserved
15 Reserved
Byte 0..1 contains the contents of the FEATURE field when the error occurred. In the Write Stream Error log
(see A.22), this value shall be set to FFFFh for a deferred write error.
Byte 2 contains the contents of the STATUS field when the error occurred.
Byte 3 contains the contents of the ERROR field when the error occurred.
Bytes 4..9 indicate the starting LBA of the error.
Bytes 12..13 contain the contents of the COUNT field indicating the length of the error. Each entry may describe a
range of logical sectors starting at the given LBA and spanning the specified number of logical sectors.
A.16.1 Overview
The SATA Phy Event Counters log is one log page in length. The first DWord of the log page contains information
that applies to the rest of the log page. The host should continue to process counters until a counter identifier
with value 0h is found or the entire log page has been read. A counter identifier with value 0h indicates that the
log page contains no more counter values past that point. The SATA Phy Event Counters log is defined in
table A.57.
If the device receives a BIST Activate FIS, then the device shall reset all SATA Phy event counters to their reset
value (see SATA 3.1).
If the SATA Phy Event Counters log is read and the FEATURE field set to 0001h, the device shall return the current
counter values for the command and then reset all Phy event counter values.
SATA Phy event counter identifier that corresponds to Counter n Value. Specifies the particular event counter
that is being reported. Valid identifiers are listed in SATA 3.1.
Value of the SATA Phy event counter that corresponds to Counter x Identifier. The number of significant bits is
determined by Counter x Identifier bits 14:12, see SATA 3.1 for more information. The length of Counter x Value
shall always be a multiple of 16 bits. All counters are one-extended (e.g., if a counter is only physically
implemented as eight bits after it reaches the maximum value of FFh, it shall be one-extended to FFFFh). The
counter shall stop (i.e., not wrap to zero) after reaching its maximum value.
Size of the SATA Phy event counter as defined by bits 14:12 of Counter n Identifier. The size of the SATA Phy
event counter shall be a multiple of 16 bits.
A.16.5 Checksum
The data structure checksum is the two’s complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with unsigned arithmetic and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes of the data
structure is zero when the checksum is correct.
A.17.1 Overview
To determine the supported NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT subcommands and their respective features, hosts
shall read log address 12h. This log shall be supported if the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT command is
supported (i.e., the NCQ QUEUE MANAGEMENT COMMAND SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.13) is set to one).
Table A.58 defines the 512 bytes that make up the SATA NCQ Queue Management log. The value of the
General Purpose Logging Version word shall be 0001h.
Table A.58 — SATA NCQ Queue Management log (log page 00h)
If the SUPPORTS ABORT NCQ QUEUE bit is set to one, the device supports the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command
(see 7.16.8). If the SUPPORTS ABORT NCQ QUEUE bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the ABORT
NCQ QUEUE command.
If the SUPPORTS ABORT ALL AT bit is set to one, the device supports the value of Abort All (see table 58) in the
ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command (see 7.16.8). If the SUPPORTS ABORT ALL AT bit is cleared
to zero, the device does not support the value of Abort All in the ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE
command.
If the SUPPORTS ABORT STREAMING AT bit is set to one, the device supports the value of Abort Streaming
(see table 58) in the ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command (see 7.16.8). If the SUPPORTS ABORT
STREAMING AT bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the value of Abort Streaming in the ABORT TYPE
field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command.
If the SUPPORTS ABORT NON-STREAMING AT bit is set to one, the device supports the value of Abort Non-Streaming
(see table 58) in the ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command (see 7.16.8). If the SUPPORTS ABORT
NON-STREAMING AT bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the value of Abort Non-Streaming in the
ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command.
If the SUPPORTS ABORT SELECTED TTAG AT bit is set to one, the device supports the value of Abort Selected
(see table 58) in the ABORT TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command (see 7.16.8). If the SUPPORTS ABORT
SELECTED TTAG AT bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the value of Abort Selected in the ABORT
TYPE field of the ABORT NCQ QUEUE command.
If the SUPPORTS DEADLINE HANDLING bit is set to one, the device supports the DEADLINE HANDLING command
(see 7.16.9). If the SUPPORTS DEADLINE HANDLING bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the
DEADLINE HANDLING command.
If the SUPPORTS WDNC bit is set to one, the device supports the WDNC bit (see 7.16.9.3.2) of the DEADLINE
HANDLING command (see 7.16.9). If the SUPPORTS WDNC bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the
WDNC bit of the DEADLINE HANDLING command.
If the SUPPORTS RDNC bit is set to one, the device supports the RDNC bit (see 7.16.9.3.3) of the DEADLINE
HANDLING command (see 7.16.9). If the SUPPORTS RDNC bit is cleared to zero, the device does not support the
RDNC bit of the DEADLINE HANDLING command.
A.18 SATA NCQ Send and Receive log (Log Address 13h)
A.18.1 Overview
To determine the supported SEND FPDMA QUEUED subcommands, RECEIVE FPDMA QUEUED
subcommands, and their respective features, the host reads log address 13h. This log shall be supported if the
SEND AND RECEIVE QUEUED COMMANDS SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.10.2.14) is set to one. Table A.59 defines the 512
bytes that make up the SATA NCQ Send and Receive log.
Table A.59 — SATA NCQ Send and Receive log (log page 00h)
If the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit is set to one, the device supports the SFQ DATA SET
MANAGEMENT subcommand (see 7.43.4). If the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT SUPPORTED bit is cleared to zero,
the device does not support the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT command.
If the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT SUPPORTS TRIM bit is set to one, the device supports the TRIM bit in the SFQ
DATA SET MANAGEMENT subcommand (see 7.43.4). If the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT SUPPORTS TRIM bit is
cleared to zero, the device does not support the TRIM bit in the SFQ DATA SET MANAGEMENT subcommand.
A.19.1 Overview
The Selective Self-Test log may be both written and read by the host. The Selective Self-Test log allows the host
to select the parameters for the self-test and to monitor the progress of the self-test. Table A.60 defines the
content of the Selective Self-Test log.
The value of the revision number shall be 01h. This value shall be written by the host and returned unmodified by
the device.
The Selective Self-Test log provides for the definition of up to five test spans. The starting LBA for each test span
is the LBA of the first logical sector tested in the test span and the ending LBA for each test span is the LBA of
the last logical sector tested in the test span. If the starting LBA and ending LBA values for a test span are both
zero, then a test span is not defined and not tested. The Starting LBA and Ending LBA for each test span are
written by the host and shall be returned unmodified by the device.
The device shall modify the value returned in the CURRENT LBA UNDER TEST field to contain the LBA of the logical
sector currently under test at least once every 65 536 logical sectors tested. After the self-test including the
off-line scan between test spans has been completed, a zero the CURRENT LBA UNDER TEST field shall be cleared
to zero.
As the self-test progresses, the device shall modify returned in the CURRENT SPAN UNDER TEST field to contain
the test span number of the current span being tested. If an off-line scan between test spans is selected, the
CURRENT SPAN UNDER TEST field is set to a value greater than five during the off-line scan. After the self-test
including the off-line scan between test spans has been completed, the CURRENT SPAN UNDER TEST field shall
be set to zero.
The FEATURE FLAGS defines the features of Selective self-test to be processed (see table A.61).
The SELECTIVE SELF-TEST PENDING TIME field contains the time in minutes from power-on to the resumption of
the off-line testing if OFF-LINE SCAN PENDING bit (see table A.61) is set to one. At the expiration of this time, the
device sets the OFF-LINE SCAN ACTIVE bit (see table A.61) to one, and resumes the off-line scan that had begun
before power-down.
A.20.1 Overview
Table A.62 defines the content of the SMART Self-Test log. The SMART Self-Test log supports 28-bit addressing
only.
Offset Description
0..1 Self-test log data structure revision number (word)
2..25 First descriptor entry
26..49 Second descriptor entry
… …
482..505 Twenty-first descriptor entry
506..507 Vendor specific
508 Self-test index
509..510 Reserved
511 Data structure checksum
The SMART Self-Test log is a circular buffer. If fewer than 21 self-tests have been performed by the device, the
unused descriptor entries shall be filled with zeroes.
The value of the self-test log data structure revision number shall be 0001h.
Offset Description
n Content of the LBA field (7:0)
n+1 Content of the self-test execution status byte
n+2..n+3 Life timestamp (word)
n+4 Content of the self-test failure checkpoint byte
n+5 Failing LBA (7:0)
n+6 Failing LBA (15:8)
n+7 Failing LBA (23:16)
n+8 Failing LBA (27:24)
n+9..n+23 Vendor specific
Content of the LBA field (7:0) shall be the content of the LBA field (7:0) when the nth self-test subcommand was
issued (see 7.48.5.2).
Content of the self-test execution status byte shall be the content of the self-test execution status byte when the
nth self-test was completed (see 7.48.6.8).
Life timestamp shall contain the power-on lifetime of the device in hours when the nth self-test subcommand was
completed.
Content of the self-test failure checkpoint byte may contain additional information about the self-test that failed.
The failing LBA shall be the LBA of the uncorrectable logical sector that caused the test to fail. If the device
encountered more than one uncorrectable logical sector during the test, this field shall indicate the LBA of the
first unrecoverable error (see 6.8.2). If the test passed or the test failed for some reason other than an
uncorrectable logical sector, the value of this field is undefined.
The self-test index shall point to the most recent entry. If the log is empty, then the index shall be cleared to zero.
It shall be set to one when the first entry is made, two for the second entry, etc., until the 22nd entry, when the
index shall be reset to one.
The data structure checksum is the two's complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with unsigned arithmetic, and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes is zero
when the checksum is correct. The checksum is placed in byte 511.
A.21.1 Overview
Table A.64 defines the log page that makes up the SMART summary error log. Summary SMART Error log data
structures shall include, but are not limited to, Uncorrectable errors, ID Not Found errors for which the LBA
requested was valid, servo errors, and write fault errors. Summary error log data structures shall not include
errors attributed to the receipt of faulty commands (e.g., command codes not implemented by the device or
requests with invalid parameters or invalid LBAs). If the device supports the Comprehensive SMART Error log
(see A.4), then the Summary SMART Error log duplicates the last five error entries in the Comprehensive
SMART Error log. The Summary SMART Error log supports 28-bit addressing only.
Offset Description
0 SMART error log version
1 Error log index
2..91 First error log data structure
92..181 Second error log data structure
182..271 Third error log data structure
272..361 Fourth error log data structure
362..451 Fifth error log data structure
452..453 Device error count (word)
454..510 Reserved
511 Data structure checksum
The value of the SMART error log version byte shall be 01h.
The error log index indicates the error log data structure representing the most recent error. Only values zero
through five are valid. If there are no error log entries, the value of the error log index shall be zero.
A.21.4.1 Overview
An Error log data structure shall contain the last five errors reported by the device. These Error log data structure
entries are a circular buffer. The Error log index indicates the most recent error log structure. If fewer than five
errors have occurred, the unused Error log structure entries shall be zero filled. Table A.65 describes the content
of a valid Error log data structure.
Offset Description
n – n+11 First command data structure
n+12 – n+23 Second command data structure
n+24 – n+35 Third command data structure
n+36 – n+47 Fourth command data structure
n+48 – n+59 Fifth command data structure
n+60 – n+89 Error data structure
content of byte n shall be FFh, the content of bytes n+1 through n+7 are vendor specific, and the content of bytes
n+8 through n+11 shall contain the timestamp.
Offset Description
n Transport specific value when the Command was initiated. See the
appropriate transport standard, reference Device Control field.
n+1 Content of the FEATURE field (7:0) when the Command was initiated
n+2 Content of the COUNT field (7:0) when the Command was initiated
n+3 Content of the LBA field (7:0) when the Command was initiated
n+4 Content of the LBA field (15:8) when the Command was initiated
n+5 Content of the LBA field (23:16) when the Command was initiated
n+6 Content of the DEVICE field when the Command was initiated
n+7 Content written when the Command was initiated
n+8..n+11 Timestamp (DWord)
Timestamp shall be the time since power-on in milliseconds when command acceptance occurred. This
timestamp may wrap around.
The error data structure shall contain the error description of the command for which an error was reported as
described in table A.66. If the error was logged for a hardware reset, the content of bytes n+1 through n+7 shall
be vendor specific and the remaining bytes shall be as defined in table A.67.
Offset Description
n Reserved
n+1 Content of the ERROR field (7:0) after command completion occurred
n+2 Content of the COUNT field (7:0) after command completion occurred
n+3 Content of the LBA field (7:0) after command completion occurred
n+4 Content of the LBA field (15:8) after command completion occurred
n+5 Content of the LBA field (23:16) after command completion occurred
n+6 Content of the DEVICE field after command completion occurred
n+7 Content written to the STATUS field after command completion occurred
n+8..n+26 Extended error information
n+27 State
n+28..n+29 Life timestamp (word)
The State byte shall contain a value indicating the state of the device when the command was initiated or the
reset occurred as described in table A.68.
Value a State
x0h Unknown
x1h Sleep
x2h Standby
x3h Active/Idle
x4h Executing SMART off-line or self-test
x5h..xAh Reserved
xBh..xFh Vendor specific
a The value of x is vendor specific and may be different for each state.
Sleep indicates the reset for which the error being reported was received while the device was in the Sleep mode
(see 4.15.4).
Standby indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported was received while the device was in
the Standby mode (see 4.15.4).
Active/Idle indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported was received while the device was
in the Active mode or Idle mode (see 4.15.4).
Processing SMART off-line or SMART self-test indicates the command or reset for which the error being reported
was received when the device was processing a SMART off-line (see 7.48.5.2.4) or SMART self-test
(see 7.48.5.2.1).
The Life timestamp word shall contain the power-on lifetime of the device in hours when command completion
occurred.
The Device error count word shall contain the total number of errors attributable to the device that have been
reported by the device during the life of the device including: uncorrectable errors, ID not found errors for which
the LBA requested was valid, servo errors, and write fault errors. The device error count shall not include errors
attributed to the receipt of faulty commands (e.g., command codes not implemented by the device or requests
with invalid parameters or invalid LBAs). If the maximum value for this word is reached, the count shall remain at
the maximum value if additional errors are encountered and logged.
The data structure checksum is the two's complement of the sum of the first 511 bytes in the data structure. Each
byte shall be added with unsigned arithmetic, and overflow shall be ignored. The sum of all 512 bytes shall be
zero when the checksum is correct. The checksum is placed in byte 511.
Table A.69 defines the format of the Write Stream Error log. Entries are placed into the Write Stream Error log
only when the STREAM ERROR bit is set to one in the STATUS field. The log page shall contain a maximum of 31
error entries.
The WRITE STREAM ERROR COUNT field shall contain the total number of Write Stream Errors detected since the
most recent read of the Write Stream Error log that returned command completion without an error. This error
count may be greater than 31. However, only the most recent 31 errors are represented by entries in the log. If
the Write Stream Error Count reaches its maximum value, then after the next error is detected the Write Stream
Error Count shall remain at the maximum value.
During processing of a read log command with the LBA field (7:0) set to 21h, a device shall clear the:
a) Write Stream Error log;
b) ERROR LOG INDEX field to zero; and
c) WRITE STREAM ERROR COUNT field to zero.
If the Error Log Index is zero, there are no entries in the Write Stream Error log. A device shall clear the content
of the Write Stream Error log during processing of a power-on reset. If the device enters the PM3:Sleep state
(see 4.15.4), then the device may clear the content of the Write Stream Error log. For a PATA device, the log is
also cleared during the processing a hardware reset. For a SATA device, the log is cleared on a hardware reset if
Software Settings Preservation is disabled (see 7.45.17.7), otherwise it is preserved.
The DATA STRUCTURE VERSION field shall contain a value of 02h indicating the second revision of the structure
format.
The WRITE STREAM ERROR COUNT field shall contain the number of WRITE STREAM EXT command (see 7.70)
entries since the last power-on reset, hardware reset, or since this log was last read.
The ERROR LOG INDEX field indicates the error log data structure representing the most recent error. Only values
one through 31 are valid.
Table A.56 defines the format of each Write Stream Error log Entry.
A.23 Current Device Internal Status Data log (Log Address 24h)
A.23.1 Overview
c) shall be the largest number of pages of Internal Status Data that the device is capable of returning.
The device shall return data for all pages with page numbers less than the log size reported in the General
Purpose Log Directory for this log (i.e., 24h).The data beyond the last page in data area 3 is not specified by
this standard.
The current device internal status data is the data representing the internal state of the device at the time the
Current Device Internal Status Data log was read with the FEATURE field set to 0001h and shall not change until
the device processes:
a) a subsequent read of the Current Device Internal Status Data log with bit 0 in the FEATURE field set to
one;
b) a download microcode activation;
c) a power on reset; or
d) a software reset.
The current device internal status data may be retrieved by one or more reads of log pages within the range of
0..n.
The Current Device Internal Status Data log consists of three areas.
The Current Device Internal Status Data header is described in table A.70.
The IEEE OUI field shall contain a 24-bit canonical form OUI assigned by the IEEE to the organization that is able
to interpret the Current Device Internal Status Data in this log.
A.23.2.4 DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST LOG PAGE field
The DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST LOG PAGE field contains the value of the last log page of
Device Internal Status data area 1 within the Device Internal Status data pages.
If the Device Internal Status data area 1 does not contain data, the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST
LOG PAGE field shall be cleared to zero. If the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST LOG PAGE field is
not cleared to zero, the Device Internal Status data area 1:
a) begins at page one; and
b) ends at the page indicated by the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST LOG PAGE field.
A.23.2.5 DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 2 LAST LOG PAGE field
The DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 2 LAST LOG PAGE field contains the value of the last page of Device
Internal Status data area 2 within the Device Internal Status data pages.
The value in the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 2 LAST LOG PAGE field shall be greater than or equal to
the value in the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 1 LAST LOG PAGE field. If the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS
DATA AREA 2 LAST LOG PAGE field is not cleared to zero, then the Device Internal Status data area 2:
A.23.2.6 DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 3 LAST LOG PAGE field
The DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 3 LAST LOG PAGE field contains the value of the last page of Device
Internal Status data area 3 within the Device Internal Status data pages.
The value in the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 3 LAST LOG PAGE field shall be greater than or equal to
the value in the INTERNAL STATUS DATA AREA 2 LAST LOG PAGE field. If the DEVICE INTERNAL STATUS DATA
AREA 3 LAST LOG PAGE field is not cleared to zero, then the Device Internal Status data area 3:
If the Saved Device Internal Status Data log is supported, the SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field shall contain the value
of the SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field in the Saved Device Internal Status Data log (see A.24.2.3).
If the Saved Device Internal Status Data log is not supported, the SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field shall be reserved.
If the Saved Device Internal Status Data log is supported, the SAVED DATA GENERATION NUMBER field shall
contain the value of the SAVED DATA GENERATION NUMBER field in the Saved Device Internal Status Data log
(see A.24.2.4).
If the Saved Device Internal Status Data log is not supported, the SAVED DATA GENERATION NUMBER field shall be
reserved.
The REASON IDENTIFIER field contains a vendor specific identifier that describes the operating conditions of the
device at the time of capture. The REASON IDENTIFIER field should provide an identification of different unique
operating conditions of the device.
The Current Device Internal Status Data log pages (see table A.71) shall represent the device internal state.
The structure of Device Internal Status log pages is shown in figure A.1.
log page n
Figure A.1 — Example of a Device Internal Status log with data in all three data areas
Device Internal Status data pages (1..n),
where n is the number of pages indicated
log page n
in the General Purpose Log Directory for
this log.
Figure A.3 is an example of a Device Internal Status log with no data in Device Internal Status Data Area 1, data
in Device Internal Status Data Area 2, and no additional data in Device Internal Status Data Area 3.
Figure A.3 — Example of a Device Internal Status log with mixed data areas
A.24 Saved Device Internal Status Data log (Log Address 25h)
A.24.1 Overview
The Saved Device Internal Status Data header is described in table A.72.
If the SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field is cleared to zero, the Saved Device Internal Status Data log does not contain
saved Device Internal Status Data. If the SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field is set to one, the Saved Device Internal
Status Data log contains Saved Device Internal Status Data.
If any page of the Saved Device Internal Status Data in the Saved Device Internal Status Data log is read, the
SAVED DATA AVAILABLE field shall be cleared to zero.
If the device saves Saved Device Internal Status Data in the Saved Device Internal Status Data log, the SAVED
DATA AVAILABLE field shall be set to one.
The SAVED DATA GENERATION NUMBER field shall contain a value that is incremented each time the device initiates
a capture of its internal device state into the Saved Device Internal Status Data.
The Saved Device Internal Status Data log pages (see table A.73) shall represent the device internal state.
The Device Statistics Notifications log pages are used to configure and report changes in conditions on
individually monitored device statistics from the Device Statistics log pages (see A.5).
Notifications take the form of an additional sense code response (see 4.8.2) to a REQUEST SENSE DATA EXT
command (see 7.35). The Summary page (i.e., page 00h) of the Device Statistics Notifications log
(see table A.75) contains a list of the triggered monitor status of all Device Statistics log pages.
If the device processes a WRITE LOG EXT command (see 7.62) or a WRITE LOG DMA EXT command
(see 7.63) that includes the Summary page of the Device Statistics Notifications log, then the device shall return
command aborted.
The Definition pages of the Device Statistics Notifications log, starting at page 01h of the Device Statistics
Notifications log (see table A.77), specify all definition entries. A definition entry consists of:
a) the log page of device statistic;
b) the offset of the device statistic within the log page;
c) a threshold value; and
d) flags specifying the notification condition.
The Definition pages of the Device Statistics Notifications log shall be readable and writable
If an unsupported or reserved Device Statistics Notifications log page is requested, then 512 bytes of all zeros
shall be returned for that page.
Table A.74 contains a list of defined Device Statistics Notifications log pages.
Page Description
00h Summary page (see table A.75)
01h Definition page 1 (see table A.77)
… …
n Definition page n (see table A.77)
n+1..FFh Reserved
Table A.75 defines the Summary page of the Device Statistics Notifications log that consists of a list of the device
statistics whose Device Statistic Conditions have been matched.
The CORRESPONDING PAGE field indicates the page number of the Device Statistics log (see A.5) referred to by
this DSN Match Entry.
The CORRESPONDING OFFSET field indicates the byte offset to the first byte of device statistic within the
corresponding page referred to by this DSN Match Entry.
Table A.77 defines the format for Definition pages of the Device Statistics Notifications log (e.g., pages 01h..07h).
Each Threshold value is specified in the units of the Device Statistic at the equivalent offset.
Table A.78 defines the format for the DSN CONDITION FLAGS field.
Annex B
(Informative)
Table B.1 provides a list of all of the commands in order of command code with the required use for each.
Table B.2 provides a summary of all commands in alphabetical order with the required use for each. Table B.3
provides the assignment history of each opcode by ATA standard. Table B.4 provides the assignment history of
each SET FEATURES code by ATA standard.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
00h NOP C C C C C C C C C C
01h R R R R R R R R R R
02h R R R R R R R R R R
03h Reserved for CFA R R R C C C C C C Aa
04h R R R R R R R R R R
05h R R R R R R R R R R
06h DATA SET
R R R R R R R R C C
MANAGEMENT
07h R R R R R R R R R R
08h ATAPI Soft Reset /
R R C C C C C C C C
DEVICE RESET
09h R R R R R R R R R R
0Ah R R R R R R R R R R
0Bh REQUEST SENSE
R R R R R R R R C C
DATA EXT
0Ch R R R R R R R R R R
0Dh R R R R R R R R R R
0Eh R R R R R R R R R R
0Fh R R R R R R R R R R
10h RECALIBRATE C C C O O O O O O O
11h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
12h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
13h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
14h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
15h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
16h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
17h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
18h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
19h RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
1Ah RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
1Bh RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
1Ch RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
1Dh RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
1Eh RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
1Fh RECALIBRATE C C O E E E E E E E
20h READ SECTORS C C C C C C C C C C
21h READ SECTORS
C C C C O O O O O O
WITHOUT RETRY
22h READ LONG C C C O O O O O O O
23h READ LONG
C C C O O O O O O O
WITHOUT RETRY
24h READ SECTORS EXT R R R R R C C C C C
25h READ DMA EXT R R R R R C C C C C
26h READ DMA QUEUED
R R R R R C C C O O
EXT
27h READ NATIVE MAX
R R R R R C C C C Oa
ADDRESS EXT
28h R R R R R R R R R R
29h READ MULTIPLE EXT R R R R R C C C C C
2Ah READ STREAM DMA R R R R R R C C C C
2Bh READ STREAM R R R R R R C C C C
2Ch R R R R R R R R R R
2Dh R R R R R R R R R R
2Eh R R R R R R R R R R
2Fh READ LOG EXT R R R R R C C C C C
30h WRITE SECTORS C C C C C C C C C C
31h WRITE SECTORS
C C C C O O O O O O
WITHOUT RETRY
32h WRITE LONG C C C O O O O O O O
33h WRITE LONG
C C C O O O O O O O
WITHOUT RETRY
34h WRITE SECTORS
R R R R O C C C C C
EXT
35h WRITE DMA EXT R R R R R C C C C C
36h WRITE DMA
R R R R R C C C O O
QUEUED EXT
37h SET NATIVE MAX
R R R R R C C C C Oa
ADDRESS EXT
38h Reserved for CFA R R R C C C C C C Aa
39h WRITE MULTIPLE
R R R R R C C C C C
EXT
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
3Ah WRITE STREAM DMA R R R R R R C C C C
3Bh WRITE STREAM R R R R R R C C C C
3Ch WRITE VERIFY C C C O O O O O O O
3Dh WRITE DMA FUA EXT R R R R R R C C C C
3Eh WRITE DMA
R R R R R R C C O O
QUEUED FUA EXT
3Fh WRITE LOG EXT R R R R R C C C C C
40h READ VERIFY
C C C C C C C C C C
SECTORS
41h READ VERIFY
SECTORS WITHOUT C C C C O O O O O O
RETRY
42h READ VERIFY
R R R R R C C C C C
SECTORS EXT
43h R R R R R R R R R R
44h R R R R R R R R R R
45h WRITE
UNCORRECTABLE R R R R R R R C C C
EXT
46h R R R R R R R R R R
47h READ LOG DMA EXT R R R R R R R C C C
48h R R R R R R R R R R
49h R R R R R R R R R R
4Ah R R R R R R R R R R
4Bh R R R R R R R R R R
4Ch R R R R R R R R R R
4Dh R R R R R R R R R R
4Eh R R R R R R R R R R
4Fh R R R R R R R R R R
50h FORMAT TRACK C C C O O O O O O O
51h CONFIGURE
R R R R R R C C C C
STREAM
52h R R R R R R R R R R
53h R R R R R R R R R R
54h R R R R R R R R R R
55h R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
56h R R R R R R R R R R
57h WRITE LOG DMA
R R R R R R R C C C
EXT
58h R R R R R R R R R R
59h R R R R R R R R R R
5Ah R R R R R R R R R R
5Bh TRUSTED NON-DATA R R R R R R R C C C
5Ch TRUSTED RECEIVE R R R R R R R C C C
5Dh TRUSTED RECEIVE
R R R R R R R C C C
DMA
5Eh TRUSTED SEND R R R R R R R C C C
5Fh TRUSTED SEND
R R R R R R R C C C
DMA
60h READ FPDMA
R R R R R R S C C C
QUEUED
61h WRITE FPDMA
R R R R R R S C C C
QUEUED
62h SATA (reserved) R R R R R R S S S S
63h NCQ QUEUE
R R R R R R S S S Ca
MANAGEMENT
64h SEND FPDMA
R R R R R R S S S Ca
QUEUED
65h RECEIVE FPDMA
R R R R R R S S S Ca
QUEUED
66h SATA (reserved) R R R R R R S S S S
67h SATA (reserved) R R R R R R S S S S
68h R R R R R R S S S S
69h R R R R R R S S S S
6Ah R R R R R R S S S S
6Bh R R R R R R S S S S
6Ch R R R R R R S S S S
6Dh R R R R R R S S S S
6Eh R R R R R R S S S S
6Fh R R R R R R S S S S
70h SEEK C C C C C C O O O O
71h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
72h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
73h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
74h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
75h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
76h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
77h SET DATE & TIME
C C O E E E E E E Ca
EXT
78h ACCESSIBLE MAX
ADDRESS C C O E E E E E E Ca
CONFIGURATION
79h SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Ah SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Bh SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Ch SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Dh SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Eh SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
7Fh SEEK C C O E E E E E E E
80h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
81h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
82h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
83h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
84h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
85h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
86h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
87h (vendor specific) /
V V V F F F F F F Aa
Reserved for CFA
88h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
89h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Ah (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Bh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Ch (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Dh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Eh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
8Fh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
90h EXECUTE DEVICE
C C C C C C C C C C
DIAGNOSTICS
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
91h INITIALIZE DEVICE
C C C C C O O O O O
PARAMETERS
92h DOWNLOAD
R C C C C C C C C C
MICROCODE
93h DOWNLOAD
R R R R R R R R C C
MICROCODE DMA
94h STANDBY
C C C E E E E E E E
IMMEDIATE
95h IDLE IMMEDIATE C C C E E E E E E E
96h STANDBY C C C E E E E E E E
97h IDLE C C C E E E E E E E
98h CHECK POWER
C C C E E E E E E E
MODE
99h SLEEP C C C E E E E E E E
9Ah (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
9Bh R R R R R R R R R R
9Ch R R R R R R R R R R
9Dh R R R R R R R R R R
9Eh R R R R R R R R R R
9Fh R R R R R R R R R R
A0h PACKET R R C C C C C C C C
A1h IDENTIFY PACKET
R R C C C C C C C C
DEVICE
A2h SERVICE R R C C C C C C O O
A3h R R R R R R R R R R
A4h R R R R R R R R R R
A5h R R R R R R R R R R
A6h R R R R R R R R R R
A7h R R R R R R R R R R
A8h R R R R R R R R R R
A9h R R R R R R R R R R
AAh R R R R R R R R R R
ABh R R R R R R R R R R
ACh R R R R R R R R R R
ADh R R R R R R R R R R
AEh R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
AFh R R R R R R R R R R
B0h SMART R R C C C C C C C C
B1h DEVICE
R R R R R C C C C O
CONFIGURATION
B2h R R R R R R R R R R
B3h R R R R R R R R R R
B4h Sanitize Device R R R R R R R R C C
B5h R R R R R R R R R R
B6h NV CACHE R R R R R R R C C Oa
B7h Reserved for CFA R R R R A A A A A A
B8h Reserved for CFA R R R R A A A A A A
B9h Reserved for CFA R R R R A A A A A A
BAh Reserved for CFA R R R R A A A A A A
BBh Reserved for CFA R R R R A A A A A A
BCh Reserved R R R R A A A R R R
BDh Reserved R R R R A A A R R R
BEh Reserved R R R R A A A R R R
BFh Reserved R R R R A A A R R R
C0h (vendor specific) / CFA
V V V F F F F F F F
ERASE SECTORS
C1h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
C2h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
C3h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
C4h READ MULTIPLE C C C C C C C C C C
C5h WRITE MULTIPLE C C C C C C C C C C
C6h SET MULTIPLE
C C C C C C C C C C
MODE
C7h READ DMA QUEUED R R R C C C C C O O
C8h READ DMA C C C C C C C C C C
C9h READ DMA WITHOUT
C C C C O O O O O O
RETRIES
CAh WRITE DMA C C C C C C C C C C
CBh WRITE DMA
C C C C O O O O O O
WITHOUT RETRIES
CCh WRITE DMA
R R R C C C C C O O
QUEUED
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
CDh Reserved for CFA R R R C C C C C C Aa
CEh WRITE MULTIPLE
R R R R R R C C C C
FUA EXT
CFh R R R R R R R R R R
D0h R R R R R R R R R R
D1h CHECK MEDIA CARD
R R R R R C C C O O
TYPE
D2h Reserved for the
Media Card Pass
R R R R R M M M R R
Through Command
feature set
D3h Reserved for the
Media Card Pass
R R R R R M M M R R
Through Command
feature set
D4h Reserved for the
Media Card Pass
R R R R R M M M R R
Through Command
feature set
D5h R R R R R R R R R R
D6h R R R R R R R R R R
D7h R R R R R R R R R R
D8h R R R R R R R R R R
D9h R R R R R R R R R R
DAh GET MEDIA STATUS R R R C C C C O O O
DBh ACKNOWLEDGE
C C O E E E E E E E
MEDIA CHANGE
DCh BOOT POST BOOT C C O E E E E E E E
DDh BOOT PRE BOOT C C O E E E E E E E
DEh MEDIA LOCK C C C C C C C O O O
DFh MEDIA UNLOCK C C C C C C C O O O
E0h STANDBY
C C C C C C C C C C
IMMEDIATE
E1h IDLE IMMEDIATE C C C C C C C C C C
E2h STANDBY C C C C C C C C C C
E3h IDLE C C C C C C C C C C
E4h READ BUFFER C C C C C C C C C C
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Opcode Command Name ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
E5h CHECK POWER
C C C C C C C C C C
MODE
E6h SLEEP C C C C C C C C C C
E7h FLUSH CACHE R R R C C C C C C C
E8h WRITE BUFFER C C C C C C C C C C
E9h (WRITE SAME)
C C O E E E E E C C
READ BUFFER DMA
EAh FLUSH CACHE EXT R R R R R C C C C C
EBh WRITE BUFFER DMA R R R R R R R R C C
ECh IDENTIFY DEVICE C C C C C C C C C C
EDh MEDIA EJECT R C C C C C C O O O
EEh IDENTIFY DEVICE
R R C O O O O O O O
DMA
EFh SET FEATURES C C C C C C C C C C
F0h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
F1h SECURITY SET
V V C C C C C C C C
PASSWORD
F2h SECURITY UNLOCK V V C C C C C C C C
F3h SECURITY ERASE
V V C C C C C C C C
PREPARE
F4h SECURITY ERASE
V V C C C C C C C C
UNIT
F5h SECURITY FREEZE
V V C C C C C C C C
LOCK
F6h SECURITY DISABLE
V V C C C C C C C C
PASSWORD
F7h (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
F8h READ NATIVE MAX
V V V C C C C C C Oa
ADDRESS
F9h SET MAX ADDRESS V V V C C C C C C Oa
FAh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
FBh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
FCh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
FDh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
FEh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
FFh (vendor specific) V V V V V V V V V V
Key: C – a defined command V – Vendor specific commands
E – a retired command A – Reserved for CFA
O – Obsolete F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see ACS-2),
R – Reserved, this command code is vendor specific
undefined in current M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature set
specifications S – Reserved for Serial ATA
a
This command definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
01h Enable 8-bit data
C C O E F F F F F Aa
transfers
02h Enable write cache V V C C C C C C C C
03h Set transfer mode C C C C C C C C C C
04h Enable all automatic
R R C O O O O O O O
defect reassignment
05h Enable advanced
R R R C C C C C C C
power management
06h Enable Power-Up in
R R R R C C C C C C
Standby feature set
07h Power-up in Standby
feature set device R R R R C C C C C C
spin-up
09h Reserved for Address
offset reserved boot
R R R R C C C C C Oa
area method technical
report
0Ah Enable CFA power
R R R R C C C C C Aa
mode 1
0Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
0Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
0Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
0Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
0Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
10h Enable use of SATA
R R R R R R S C C C
feature
11h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
12h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
13h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
14h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
15h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
16h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
17h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
18h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
19h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Ah Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
1Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
20h Obsolete R R R R R R T T T O
21h Obsolete R R R R R R T T T O
22h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
23h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
24h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
25h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
26h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
27h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
28h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
29h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Ah Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
2Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
30h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
31h Disable Media Status
R R R C C C C O O O
Notification
32h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
33h Disable retry V V C C O O O O O O
34h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
35h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
36h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
37h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
38h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
39h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Ah Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
3Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
40h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
41h Enable Free-fall
R R R R R R R C C C
Control feature set
42h Enable Automatic
Acoustic
R R R R R C C C O O
Management feature
set
43h Set Maximum Host
Interface Sector R R R R R R C C C C
Times
44h Vendor specific length
of ECC on read
C C C O O O O O O O
long/write long
commands
45h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
46h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
47h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
48h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
49h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
4Ah Extended Power
R R R R R R R R C C
Conditions
4Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
4Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
4Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
4Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
4Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
50h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
51h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
52h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
53h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
54h Set cache segments
to the COUNT field V V C O O O O O O O
value
55h Disable read
C C C C C C C C C C
look-ahead feature
56h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
57h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
58h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
59h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
5Ah Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
5Bh Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
5Ch Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
5Dh Enable release
R R R C C C C C O O
interrupt
5Eh Enable SERVICE
R R R C C C C C O O
interrupt
5Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R Oa
60h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
61h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
62h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
63h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
64h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
65h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
66h Disable reverting to
C C C C C C C C C C
power on defaults
67h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
68h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
69h Long Physical Sector
Alignment Error R R R R R R R R C C
Reporting Control
6Ah Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
6Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
6Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
6Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
6Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
6Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
70h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
71h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
72h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
73h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
74h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
75h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
76h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
77h Disable ECC V V C O O O O O O O
78h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
79h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Ah Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
7Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
80h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
81h Disable 8-bit data
C C O E F F F F F F
transfers
82h Disable write cache V V C C C C C C C C
83h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
84h Disable all automatic
R R C O O O O O O O
defect reassignment
85h Disable advanced
R R R C C C C C C C
power management
86h Disable Power-Up in
R R R R C C C C C C
Standby feature set
87h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
88h Enable ECC V V C C C O O O O O
89h Reserved for Address
offset reserved boot
R R R R C C C C C C
area method technical
report
8Ah Disable CFA power
R R R R C C F F F Aa
mode 1
8Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
8Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
8Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
8Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
8Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
90h Disable use of SATA
R R R R R R S C C C
feature
91h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
92h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
93h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
94h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
95h Enable Media Status
R R R C C C C O O O
Notification
96h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
97h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
98h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
99h Enable retries V V C O O O O O O O
9Ah Set device maximum
R R C O O O O O O O
average current
9Bh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
9Ch Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
9Dh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
9Eh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
9Fh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A0h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A1h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A2h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
A3h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A4h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A5h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A6h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A7h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A8h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
A9h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
AAh Enable read
C C C C C C C C C C
look-ahead features
ABh Set maximum
prefetch using the V V C O O O O O O O
COUNT field value
ACh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
ADh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
AEh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
AFh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B0h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B1h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B2h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B3h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B4h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B5h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B6h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B7h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B8h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
B9h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
BAh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
BBh 4 bytes of ECC apply
on read long/write C C C O O O O O O O
long commands
BCh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
BDh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
BEh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
BFh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C0h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C1h Disable Free-fall
R R R R R R R C C C
Control feature set
C2h Disable Automatic
Acoustic
R R R R R C C C O O
Management feature
set
C3h Enabled/Disable the
Sense Data Reporting R R R R R R R R C C
feature set
C4h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C5h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C6h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C7h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C8h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
C9h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
CAh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
CBh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
CCh Enable reverting to
C C C C C C C C C C
power on defaults
CDh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
CEh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
CFh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D0h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D1h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D2h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D3h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D4h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D5h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
D6h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
D7h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
D8h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
D9h Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
DAh Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
DBh Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
DCh Vendor Specific R R R R R R R V V V
DDh Disable release
R R R C C C C C O O
interrupt
DEh Disable SERVICE
R R R C C C C C O O
interrupt
DFh Reserved R R R R R R R R R Oa
E0h Vendor specific R R R R R R O O O O
E1h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E2h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E3h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E4h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E5h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E6h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E7h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E8h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
E9h Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
EAh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
EBh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a
This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Feature
Code Description ATA ATA2 ATA3 ATA4 ATA5 ATA6 ATA7 ATA8 ACS2 ACS3
ECh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
EDh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
EEh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
EFh Reserved R R R R R R R R R R
F0h R R R R A A A A A A
F1h R R R R A A A A A A
F2h R R R R A A A A A A
F3h R R R R A A A A A A
F4h R R R R A A A A A A
F5h R R R R A A A A A A
F6h R R R R A A A A A A
F7h R R R R A A A A A A
F8h R R R R A A A A A A
F9h R R R R A A A A A A
FAh R R R R A A A A A A
FBh R R R R A A A A A A
FCh R R R R A A A A A A
FDh R R R R A A A A A A
FEh R R R R A A A A A A
FFh R R R R A A A A A A
Key: C – a defined command A – Reserved for CFA
E – a retired command F – If the device does not implement the CFA feature set (see 4.7),
O – Obsolete this command code is Reserved
R – Reserved, undefined in M – Reserved for the Media Card Pass Through Command feature
current specifications set
V – Vendor specific command S – Reserved for Serial ATA.
T – Reserved for Technical Report T13/DT1696 (Time-Limited
Commands)
a This feature set definition is new to ACS-3.
Annex C
(Informative)
Figure C.1 is an example flowchart that shows how to process SCT commands using SMART READ LOG
commands and SMART WRITE LOG commands.
Command to
Device
Not B0 Process
Command
command other
Register
than SMART
B0
D6 D5
Feature
Register
Not D5 or D6
Yes Process
SMART
Standard SMART
Enabled
command
No
Error
E0 E1 E1 E0
Log Address Log Address
Not E0 or E1 Not E0 or E1
No No Return SCT
SMART SMART
Enabled Enabled Status
Yes
Device Locked Yes
Yes No No
Transfer to Transfer to
device pending host pending
No
Yes Yes
In these examples, Command Completion is the status returned by a read log command or write log command to
the requested log address. Foreground command examples that do not require data transfer to begin processing
the command, return command completion as a part of the write log command response. The host may request
SCT Status for additional information.
Figure C.2 shows an example of a foreground write same with a repeating write pattern.
Host Device
Figure C.2 — Example sequence for foreground write same with a repeating pattern
Figure C.3 shows an example of a foreground write same with a repeating pattern.
Host Device
Figure C.3 — Example sequence for foreground write same with a repeating pattern
Figure C.4 shows an example command sequence for writing data to a device using an SCT command with no
background activity.
Host Device
Figure C.4 — Example sequence for writing data using an SCT command with no background activity
Figure C.5 shows an example command sequence for reading data from a device using an SCT command with
no background activity.
Host Device
Figure C.5 — Example sequence for reading data using an SCT command with no background activity
Figure C.6 shows an example command sequence for issuing a Log page command that does not transfer data
and has no background activity.
Host Device
Figure C.6 — Example sequence for a Non-Data SCT command with no background activity
Figure C.7 shows an example command sequence for issuing an SCT command that writes data in the
background.
Host Device
Figure C.7 — Example sequence for writing data using an SCT command with background activity
Figure C.8 shows an example command sequence for issuing an SCT command that writes data in the
background. In the example, the key page is first written. The host then checks the SCT Status. After checking
the SCT Status, the host then transfers the data necessary for the device to process the SCT Command. The
SCT Data is transferred in two separate write log commands. The first write log command returns a non-zero
value for number of pages remaining. The second write log command returns zero for number of pages
remaining. After the data is transferred, the SCT Command is processed in the background. During background
processing, the host polls the device for progress by requesting SCT Status. After the SCT Command is
complete, the device returns an SCT Status indicating the success or failure of the SCT Command.
Host Device
Figure C.8 — Example sequence for writing data using multiple write data transfers
Figure C.9 shows an example command sequence for issuing an SCT command that is processed in the
background but does not require the transfer of data to or from the host.
Host Device
Figure C.9 — Example sequence for a Non-Data SCT command with background activity
The host builds the key page in a host buffer for the appropriate action and parameters.
The host issues the SCT command (see table C.1 or table C.2), and sends the key page to the device.
Field Description
FEATURE D6h (e.g., SMART WRITE LOG)
COUNT 01h
LBA
Bit Description
27:24 N/A
23:8 C24Fh
7:0 E0h (e.g., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
Field Description
FEATURE Reserved
COUNT 0001h (e.g., one page for SCT commands)
LBA
Bit Description
47:40 Reserved
39:32 00h
31:16 Reserved
15:8 00h
7:0 E0h (e.g., SCT Command/Status log address)
DEVICE
Bit Description
7 Obsolete
6 N/A
5 Obsolete
4 Transport Dependent – See 6.2.12
3:0 Reserved
If the SCT command returns command completion without an error, then the device responds a shown in
table 173. If the command is aborted, then either the key page format is invalid, the command structure contains
an invalid value or the command encountered a processing error. The host checks the Extended Status Code
field (see table 174) for the error code (see table 175). If the command is a write command, the command is
terminated, there is no data transfer, and the host skips Step 3. However, if the command was a read command,
there may be partial output available (e.g., on a page read command, the data up to and including the page in
error is available) and the host may proceed to Step 3 to get the partial data. In some cases the error is not fatal
and serves only as a warning.
If the status is 50h, then the host checks the LBA field (23:8). If the LBA field (23:8) is cleared to 0000h, then the
command is complete, terminated without error, and the host proceeds to Step 4. If the values are greater than 0,
then the host proceeds to Step 3.
To transfer data from the device to the host, the host issues a SMART READ LOG command, READ LOG DMA
EXT command, or READ LOG EXT command to the SCT Data Transfer log (see table 176 and table 177). To
transfer data from the host to the device, the host issues a SMART WRITE LOG command, WRITE LOG DMA
EXT command, or WRITE LOG EXT command to the SCT Data Transfer log (see table 176 and table 177). The
transfer request is in the range of one data block up to the total number of data blocks not yet transferred. The
number of data blocks remaining was reported in the NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field (see table 178) in the
previous step. If the requested number of data blocks is larger than the value in the most recently reported
NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field, the device reports an error. If the value is less than the value in the most
recently reported NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field, the host may repeat Step 3 until all data blocks have been
transferred.
For SCT commands that access the media, the device advances the data block pointer by the number of data
blocks transferred, and returns the number of data blocks remaining to be transferred in the NUMBER OF PAGES
REMAINING field. If the NUMBER OF PAGES REMAINING field is cleared to zero, then the command is complete, and
the host proceeds to Step 4. The host has complete control over the number of data blocks to transfer at a time.
If the number of data block to be transferred is greater than or equal to FFFFh, the device sets the NUMBER OF
PAGES REMAINING field to FFFFh. The value remains FFFFh until the number of data blocks remaining drops
below FFFFh. The exact number to be transferred is reported by the SCT Status command. Upon receiving the
last data block, the device performs the specified operation. In the case of very large amounts of data (e.g., SCT
Write Same command) some data may be processed (e.g., written to the disk) prior to receiving all of the data
from the host.
The host reads the SCT status response (see table 182, table 183, and table 186) to determine how the
command completed. If the command has not completed (i.e., by reporting FFFFh in table 186 byte 14), then the
host waits a vendor specific period of time and repeats Step 4 until the command is complete. For SCT
commands that require transfer of data to the device (e.g., a write command), the command is not complete until
the last block of data has been transferred to the device.
Annex D
(Informative)
D.1 Scope
This annex provides guidelines for implementing a media format that incorporates logical sector sizes greater
than 512 bytes.
The information provided in this annex enables logical sector sizes that are a binary multiple greater than 512
bytes. This standard also specifies methods to report logical sector sizes that are not a binary multiple. Common
logical sector sizes that are not binary multiples include 520, 524, 528 and 532 byte logical sectors. Non-binary
multiples are beyond the scope of this annex.
D.2 Overview
Figure D.1 shows major system components that are affected by a change in logical sector size.
The following methods may be used to expand the logical sector size:
a) Native Physical Sector Size method (i.e., the physical sector size is seen at the drive interface); or
b) 512-byte Emulation method (i.e., keeps the 512-byte logical sector size at the drive interface). Figure D.2
illustrates these methods.
a
Logical Block
b
See figure D.1. The system dependency chain is evolving and may change to support logical sector sizes
larger than 512 bytes.
Using the 512-byte Logical Block method, the Drive Interface, Host Interface, BIOS, Operating System, and
Applications still function. Optimal performance is achieved if the OS were modified to properly align the disk
accesses. The 512-byte Logical Block method also allows a drive manufacturer to ship a utility with the unit that
optimizes performance. If the Physical Sector Size Logical Block method is employed, the existing Drive
Interface, Host Interface, BIOS, OS, and Applications may not function. The reason they may not function is that
many components in the System Dependency Chain (see figure D.1) only support 512-byte logical blocks. If the
host interface is able to transfer the data, it is likely that the BIOS is only implemented to handle 512-byte logical
blocks. If the BIOS does support the larger logical block size, it is likely the operating system is written to only
handle 512-byte logical sectors. In the case where the BIOS or host interface only supports 512-byte logical
blocks, no code may reasonably be used to fix the problem.
This standard specifies a method of aligning 512-byte logical sectors with larger physical sectors by specifying
LBA alignment requirements using the IDENTIFY DEVICE command (see 7.12), the Long Logical feature set
(see 4.12), and Long Physical Sector feature set (see 4.13). Figure D.3 is an example of the capability specified
in this standard.
Logical Sector
(512 bytes)
In this example, the interface sector size (i.e., logical sector size) is 512 bytes, and the physical sector size is
2 048 bytes. This allows an ATA device to both implement a larger physical sector and maintain compatibility with
existing systems, interfaces, and software. One of the drawbacks of this method is that drive performance may
suffer if the host writes data starting or ending on an LBA that is misaligned with respect to the physical sector
boundaries. If mis-alignment occurs, the drive is forced to perform a RMW operation (i.e., Read-Modify-Write)
(see D.3.3) in order to satisfy the host request.
This standard also allows the ATA device to report that a Logical Sector size is the same as a physical sector
size. This allows an ATA device to implement a native 4 096-byte sector on the media and requires that transfers
be 4 096 bytes of data for each logical block requested. This method avoids RMWs. The main drawback of this
implementation is that existing systems, interfaces, BIOS and system software, OS and otherwise, have to
change in order to accommodate the device.
D.3 Implementation
Although the 4 096-byte physical sector size allows for greater format efficiencies, 4 096-byte physical sectors
cause alignment issues.
The device indicates a 4 096-byte physical sector size to the host by:
a) returning:
A) the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.4.3.1) set to one; and
B) the LOGICAL TO PHYSICAL SECTOR RELATIONSHIP field (see A.11.4.3.4) set to 3h;
This indicates that the device has eight 512-byte logical sectors to compose a 4 096-byte physical
sector. The host may use this information to know that transfers should start with an LBA where the low
order 3 bits are zero and the transfer ends on an LBA where the low order 3 bits are one;
or
b) returning:
A) the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE SUPPORTED bit (see A.11.4.3.2) set to one; and
B) the LOGICAL SECTOR SIZE field (see A.11.4.4) set to 0800h;
This indicates that the device has one 4 096-byte logical sector per 4 096-byte physical sector. The host
may use this information to know that transfers require 4 096 bytes per logical block requested.
This standard defines the ability to report alignment using the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field (see A.11.4.3.5).
If the drive reports a 4 096-byte physical sector and a 512-byte logical sector, the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field
reports the alignment as follows. If the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field is set to:
a) 0000h, then LBA 0 is aligned to the beginning for the first physical sector;
b) 0001h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 512 bytes (i.e., 1 sector);
c) 0002h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 1 024 bytes (i.e., 2 sectors);
d) 0003h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 1 536 bytes (i.e., 3 sectors);
e) 0004h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 2 048 bytes (i.e., 4 sectors);
f) 0005h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 2 560 bytes (i.e., 5 sectors);
g) 0006h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 3 072 bytes (i.e., 6 sectors); and
h) 0007h, then LBA 0 is offset from the start of the first physical sector by 3 584 bytes (i.e., 7 sectors).
For systems that use Windows® XP and earlier, and have devices formatted with a single partition, the optimal
value for the LOGICAL SECTOR OFFSET field is 0001h.
Windows® 7 reads this value and aligns partitions accordingly.
For devices with a logical sector size of 512 bytes, the drive may be forced to perform a RMW operation when
it receives an unaligned transfer. Write commands do not provide a way to return an error other than an Abort
(see 6.3.2) or a Device Fault (see 6.2.7). If there is an uncorrectable error encountered during the initial read
operation, the Write command has no way to report the issue. This error may affect logical sectors not accessed
by the Write command. There are several possible solutions to choose from in providing the information to the
host. Figure D.4 shows the issue.
D.4.1 Overview
Although the implementation described here allows a drive to function in a legacy system without modification,
there are some issues that are critical in allowing the drive to perform at peak efficiency. Figure D.5 describes a
typical device media layout showing the positions of the Master Boot Record (i.e., MBR), BIOS Parameter Block,
and the remainder of a File Allocation Table based file system. This layout varies based on the type of File
Allocation Table file system used, but all the elements described here are generally present. The logical sector
numbers on the left hand side of Figure D.5 show typical and/or legacy locations for the various data structures
on the media.
Reserved Sectors
LBA 65
LBA 63+X
Root Directory
LBA 63+Y
Next Partition
Prior to the year 1994, typical disk partitioning software placed the Master Boot Record at Cylinder 0, Head 0,
and sector 1 (i.e., LBA 0). The Master Boot Record contains a pointer to the first partition. The common practice
was to place first partition at Cylinder 0 Head 1, sector 1 (i.e., the LBA value of the first logical sector in the first
partition varied). Once the logical sectors per track standardized on 63, the LBA value of the first logical sector in
the first partition standardized on LBA 63. In the year 2010, there are some applications that check to make sure
that partitions start on a track boundary, even though there is no meaning for cylinders heads and logical sectors.
As larger sectors occur, partition alignment becomes an important issue that affects applications that check if the
first partition starts on logical sector 63 (e.g., on a 512-byte logical sector device, all the partitions should start on
an LBA that is aligned with the start of a physical sector on the media, on a 1 024-byte logical sector device, the
partitions should start on an even numbered logical sector and end on an odd numbered logical sector, and on a
4 096-byte logical sector device, the partitions should start on an LBA where the low order three bits are zero).
For drives that use 512-byte LBA, all partitions should start on an LBA that is aligned with the start of a physical
sector on the media. This affects some applications that check to make sure the first partition starts on logical
sector 63, but a change is required to implement larger sectors on the media.
There are many file systems that cluster sectors together to create an allocation unit larger than a single
512-byte logical sector. These file systems generally implement a table to associate clusters with files, commonly
called a File Allocation Table. A typical cluster size is 4 096 bytes (i.e., eight 512-byte logical sectors). Even if the
Partition is properly aligned, there is an issue where the size of the File Allocation Table may cause the individual
clusters in the File Data Area to be unaligned relative to the physical sectors on the media resulting in
performance degradation.
If the clusters in the file system are properly aligned, file accesses are naturally aligned resulting in optimum
performance.
Once the clusters in the file system are aligned, the OS memory manager needs to be modified to prevent
unaligned accesses. If a device has alignment requirements, device performance tests may show acceptable
performance, but if the virtual memory activity is not aligned, CPU performance tests may provide unacceptable
results.
D.4.5 Booting
The devices with alignment requirements should not show significant performance degradation on unaligned
reads. Since booting is mainly a reading process, an impact on system boot times in an unaligned environment is
not expected.
Annex E
(Informative)
Bibliography